* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download MM9000-I PRELIM-7 4-20-04.book
Survey
Document related concepts
Transcript
ClearCommand 9000 Series Installation & Troubleshooting Manual MM9000-I Rev.A 4/20/04 PREFACE ClearCommand 9000 Series ZF Mathers ENGINE CLUTCH Processor Part No. Servo Electronic Servo Solenoid Servo 9120 Servo 2 X 9121 Servo 2 X 9122 Servo 2 9210 TROLL Solenoid 9001 Actuator Servo 3 Servo 1 X X Servo 1 9211 X Servo 1 9221 X X Servo 3 Servo 2 X Servo 2 Table Preface-1: ClearCommand Processor List This manual is for the above Processors. Throughout this manual special attention should be paid to the following: NOTE: ONTAINS HELPFUL INFORMATION. C CAUTION: Damage to the equipment may occur if these messages are not followed. WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY MAY RESULT IF THESE MESSAGES ARE NOT FOLLOWED. ATTENTION It is important to keep this Manual in a safe place for future reference. The manual contains answers to questions that may arise during operation or installation of the ZF Mathers Control System and its options. WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. CAUTION: On Control Systems utilizing more than one Processor, ZF Mathers highly recommends that ALL UNITS be upgraded to the most current Processor. CAUTION: Electro-static discharge can damage this equipment. Personnel working on this equipment must be grounded to the chassis with the Anti-static Wrist Strap provided. CAUTION: Disconnect the Power Harness from the Power Pigtail whenever welding is being done on the vessel. Failure to do so can cause permanent damage. CAUTION This equipment is designed to work with other ZF Mathers designed equipment. DO NOT operate this equipment with any other manufacturers equipment unless approved so in writing by ZF Mathers Engineering Department. For the purpose of this manual, the drawings illustrate pluggable systems with two Remote Stations. The Processors described within, may in fact be installed with anywhere from one to five Remote Stations. Preface-1 PREFACE Hard-wired installation is described in Section 4-4, with the exception of the Tachometer Signal and Serial Communication Pigtails, which always come from the factory pre-wired. Preface-2 TABLE OF CONTENTS SW15623.0 Table of Contents Table Preface-1:ClearCommand Processor List ..........................................................................................................Preface-1 Table of Contents ................................................................................................................................TOC-1 Revisions List ....................................................................................................................................TOC-14 1 INTRODUCTION - 1-1 1-2 1-2.1 Figure 1-1: 1-2.2 2-9 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1-1 9120 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid) or 9122 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid, Troll-Solenoid). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 Basic 9120 or 9122 ClearCommand System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 9121 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid, Troll-Servo 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 Basic 9221 ClearCommand System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 9210 Processor (Throttle-Electronic, Shift-Servo 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 9211 Processor (Throttle - Electronic, Shift - Servo 1, Troll - Servo 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5 9221 Processor (Throttle - Electronic, Shift - Solenoid, Troll - Servo 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 Standard Processor Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 9000 Series Additional Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 Optional System Features (Section 2-16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 OPERATION - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 2-1 Figure 2-1: Figure 2-2: Figure 2-3: Figure 2-4: Figure 2-5: Figure 2-6: Figure 2-7: Figure 2-8: Figure 2-9: Figure 2-10: Figure 2-11: 2-10.1 Figure 2-12: 2-10.2 2-11 - Figure 1-5: 2-9.1 2-9.2 2-9.3 2-10 - Basic 9211 ClearCommand System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5 2-3.1 2-7 2-8 - Figure 1-4: 2 2-6 - - Basic 9210 ClearCommand System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 1-3.1 1-3.2 1-3.3 2-4 2-5 - Figure 1-3: 1-2.5 2-3 - Basic 9121 ClearCommand System Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 1-2.4 2-1 2-2 - Figure 1-2: 1-2.3 1-3 - Manual Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 Basic Theory of Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 Figure 2-13: DC Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Taking Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Station taking Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Basic Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Normal Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Control Head Detents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Trolling Valve Operationl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Start Interlock (if used) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Control Head 20 Degree Troll Range - Type 1 Control Head 35 Degree Troll Range - Type 2 Control Head 45 Degree Troll Range - Type 3 Control Head 55 Degree Troll Range - Type 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Station Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Remote Stations Before Transfer of Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Remote Station Transfer after Transfer of Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Proportional Pause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Warm-up Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Control Head Warm-Up Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Control Head Normal Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 High/Low Idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Low Idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 High Idle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Selecting Between High and Low Idle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 High/Low Idle Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 One Lever Mode (Twin Screw) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Turning ON One Lever Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Step A) One Lever Operation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Turning OFF One Lever Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Engine Synchronization (Twin Screw) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Step B) One Lever Operation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 TOC-1 TABLE OF CONTENTS 2-11.1 Synchronization Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 2-11.2 2-11.3 2-11.4 2-11.5 2-11.6 Synchronization Criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Synchronization Indications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Turning Synchronization OFF: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Turning Synchronization ON: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Turning Synchronization ON and OFF when Control Head Levers are not within a 10% (6 degree) Window of One Another: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 2-11.1.1 2-11.1.2 2-12 2-12.1 2-12.2 2-12.2.1 2-12.2.2 2-12.2.3 EQUAL THROTTLE SYNCHRONIZATION (TWIN SCREW) (DEFAULT) ........................................................................... 2-8 ACTIVE SYNCHRONIZATION (TWIN SCREW)(DEFAULT DISABLED) ............................................................................ 2-8 Control System’s Configurability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Processor Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Throttle Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 BASIC THROTTLE FUNCTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 2-10 SERVO THROTTLE FUNCTIONS ........................................................................................................................ 2-11 ELECTRONIC THROTTLE FUNCTIONS ................................................................................................................. 2-11 2-12.3 Clutch Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-12.4 Troll Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12 2-12.5 Troubleshooting Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13 2-12.3.1 2-12.3.2 2-12.3.3 2-12.4.1 2-12.4.2 2-12.4.3 2-12.5.1 2-13 2-13.1 BASIC CLUTCH FUNCTIONS ............................................................................................................................ 2-11 CLUTCH SERVO FUNCTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 2-12 CLUTCH SOLENOID FUNCTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 2-12 BASIC TROLL FUNCTIONS (ALL PROCESSORS WITH TROLL FUNCTION).................................................................. 2-12 TROLL SERVO FUNCTIONS.............................................................................................................................. 2-13 INTEGRATED TROLL SOLENOID FUNCTIONS ....................................................................................................... 2-13 BASIC TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTIONS............................................................................................................. 2-13 Audible Tones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 Basic Processor Tones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 2-13.1.1 Figure 2-14: 2-13.1.2 Figure 2-15: 2-13.1.3 Figure 2-16: 2-13.1.4 Figure 2-17: 2-13.1.5 Figure 2-18: 2-13.1.6 Figure 2-19: SLOW REPETITIVE TONE ................................................................................................................................ 2-14 Slow Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 ONE LONG, THREE SHORT TONES .................................................................................................................. 2-14 One Long, Three Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 STEADY TONE .............................................................................................................................................. 2-14 Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 FIVE (5) SECOND STEADY TONE ..................................................................................................................... 2-14 Five (5) Second Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 THREE (3) SECOND STEADY TONE .................................................................................................................. 2-14 Three (3) Second Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 FIVE SECONDS ON, FIVE SECONDS OFF - HIGH REPETITIVE RATE TONE ................................................................ 2-15 Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 2-13.2.1 Figure 2-20: 2-13.2.2 Figure 2-21: ONE LONG - TWO SHORT TONES ................................................................................................................... 2-15 One Long - Two Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 ONE LONG, TWO SHORT - HIGH REPETITIVE TONE ............................................................................................ 2-15 One Long - Two Short - High Repetitive Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 2-13.3.1 Figure 2-22: 2-13.3.2 Figure 2-23: ONE LONG - ONE SHORT TONE...................................................................................................................... 2-15 One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 ONE LONG, ONE SHORT -HIGH REPETITIVE RATETONE ....................................................................................... 2-15 One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 2-13.4.1 Figure 2-24: ONE LONG - ONE SHORT TONE...................................................................................................................... 2-16 One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 2-13.5.1 Figure 2-25: 2-13.5.2 Figure 2-26: ONE LONG - ONE SHORT TONE...................................................................................................................... 2-16 One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 ONE LONG, ONE SHORT -HIGH REPETITIVE RATETONE ....................................................................................... 2-16 One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 2-13.6.1 Figure 2-27: 2-13.6.2 Figure 2-28: ONE LONG - TWO SHORT TONES ................................................................................................................... 2-16 One Long - Two Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 ONE LONG, TWO SHORT - HIGH REPETITIVE TONE ............................................................................................ 2-16 One Long - Two Short - High Repetitive Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 2-13.7.1 Figure 2-29: 2-13.7.2 ONE LONG, FOUR SHORT TONES.................................................................................................................... 2-17 One Long - Four Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 ONE LONG, FOUR SHORT - HIGH REPETITIVE RATE TONE ................................................................................... 2-17 2-13.2 2-13.3 2-13.4 2-13.5 2-13.6 2-13.7 Throttle (Servo 2) Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 Clutch (Servo 1) Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 Clutch Solenoid Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Troll Integrated Servo (Servo 1) Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Troll Integrated (Servo 2) Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 9001 Trolling Actuator Tones (Servo 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 TOC-2 TABLE OF CONTENTS Figure 2-30: One Long, Four Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 2-13.8.3 Figure 2-31: THREE SECOND STEADY TONE ....................................................................................................................... 2-17 Three Second Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 2-13.8 2-14 2-15 2-16 Figure 2-32: 2-16.1 Figure 2-33: 2-16.2 2-17 2-17.1 2-17.2 2-17.3 2-17.4 2-17.5 3 3-1 Troll Integrated Solenoid Tones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Push Button Set Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Visual System Diagnostics, Set Up And Status Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Circuit Board Shield Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18 Pluggable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18 Standard Pluggable Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18 Standard Processor Pluggable Connections View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18 ClearCommand 9000 Series Pluggable Processors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19 Optional Features Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19 System Failure External Alarm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clutch Pressure Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Station Expander (SE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Multiple Screw Installations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9001 Mechanically Actuated Trolling Valve Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19 2-19 2-19 2-20 2-20 PLAN THE INSTALLATION - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 3-1 Figure 3-1: 3-1.1 3-1.2 3-1.3 3-1.3.1 3-1.3.2 3-1.3.3 3-1.3.4 System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1 Processor Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1 Processor(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2 Control Head(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2 Standard Wire Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 CONTROL HEAD HARNESSES ............................................................................................................................ POWER, START INTERLOCK, CLUTCH PRESSURE, ALARM HARNESS ......................................................................... SERIAL COMMUNICATION HARNESS .................................................................................................................. TACH SENSOR HARNESS ................................................................................................................................. 3-3 3-3 3-3 3-4 3-1.4 Additional Harnesses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 3-1.5 Standard Electric Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 3-1.6 3-1.7 3-1.8 3-1.9 Additional Electric Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Electric Cable Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clutch Electric Cable Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clutch/Troll Electric Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1.10 Tachometer Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 3-1.4.1 3-1.4.2 3-1.4.3 3-1.5.1 3-1.5.2 3-1.5.2.1 3-1.5.2.2 3-1.5.2.3 3-1.5.2.4 3-1.5.3 3-1.5.4 3-1.5.4.1 3-1.5.4.2 3-1.9.5 3-1.9.6 3-1.10.1 3-1.10.2 3-1.10.3 3-1.10.4 3-2 3-2.1 3-2.2 3-2.3 3-2.3.1 3-2.3.2 3-3 3-3.1 THROTTLE HARNESS ....................................................................................................................................... 3-4 CLUTCH HARNESS .......................................................................................................................................... 3-4 CLUTCH /TROLL HARNESS ................................................................................................................................ 3-4 CONTROL HEAD ELECTRIC CABLE...................................................................................................................... POWER, START INTERLOCK, CLUTCH PRESSURE, ALARM ELECTRIC CABLE ............................................................... Power Electric Cable Requirements - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Start Interlock Electric Cable Requirements - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Clutch Pressure Interlock Electric Cable Requirements - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - External Alarm Circuit Electric Cable Requirements - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - SERIAL COMMUNICATION ELECTRIC CABLE REQUIREMENTS ................................................................................... TACH SENSOR ELECTRIC CABLE REQUIREMENTS .................................................................................................. AC Tach Input - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Open Collector (Active) - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 3-5 3-5 3-5 3-5 3-6 3-6 3-6 3-6 3-6 3-6 3-7 3-7 3-7 3-7 CLUTCH SOLENOID ELECTRIC CABLE REQUIREMENTS ............................................................................................ 3-7 TROLL SOLENOID ELECTRIC CABLE REQUIRMENTS ................................................................................................ 3-7 AC COUPLED SENSORS .................................................................................................................................. ALTERNATOR ................................................................................................................................................. POINT SIDE OF THE COIL.................................................................................................................................. ACTIVE SENSORS (OPEN COLLECTOR OUTPUT) ................................................................................................... 3-8 3-8 3-8 3-8 Installer Supplied Tools And Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 Required Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 Optional Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 Required Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 PROCESSOR’S UTILIZING A SERVO ..................................................................................................................... 3-9 ALL REMOTE STATIONS ................................................................................................................................... 3-9 DC Power Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 Processor Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10 TOC-3 TABLE OF CONTENTS 4 INSTALLATION - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-1 4-1 4-2 Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 Control Head(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 4-3 Wire Harness Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 4-2.1 4-2.2 4-2.3 4-3.1 400, MC2000 and 700 Series Control Heads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 500 Series Control Heads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 Handheld Remote Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 Plug Insertion and Extraction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 Figure 4-1: Harness Plug Keying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 4-3.2.1 4-3.2.2 Figure 4-3: 4-3.2.3 4-3.2.4 DC POWER CABLE ......................................................................................................................................... 4-2 START INTERLOCK CABLE ................................................................................................................................. 4-2 Start Interlock Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 EXTERNAL A LARM CIRCUIT CABLE (OPTIONAL) .................................................................................................... 4-2 CLUTCH PRESSURE SWITCH CABLE (OPTIONAL)................................................................................................... 4-2 Figure 4-2: 4-3.3.1 4-3.3.2 Harness Plug Locking Mechanisms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 CONTROL HEAD HARNESS WITH TWO CONNECTORS ........................................................................................... 4-3 CONTROL HEAD HARNESS WITH ONE PLUG ....................................................................................................... 4-3 4-3.6.1 4-3.6.2 4-3.6.3 THROTTLE HARNESS ....................................................................................................................................... 4-4 CLUTCH HARNESS .......................................................................................................................................... 4-4 CLUTCH /TROLL HARNESS ................................................................................................................................ 4-4 4-3.2 4-3.3 4-3.4 4-3.5 4-3.6 4-4 4-4.1 Standard Power/Start Interlock Harness. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 Standard Control Head Harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 Serial Communication Harness (Twin Screw only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 Tach Sensor Harness (required for Active Synchronization). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 Additional 9000 Series Harnesses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 Hard-Wired Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Liquid Tight Connector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Figure 4-4: Liquid Tight Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Figure 4-5: Standard Enclosure Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Figure 4-6: Standard Circuit Board Hard-Wired Termination Points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6 Table 4-1: ClearCommand Processor Optional Hard-Wiring Cable List........................................................................ 4-6 4-4.2 4-4.3 4-4.4 Standard Processor Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 Standard Circuit Board Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 9000 Series Hard-Wired Connection Locations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6 4-4.4.1 Figure 4-7: 4-4.4.2 Figure 4-8: 4-4.4.3 Figure 4-9: 4-4.4.4 Figure 4-10: 9120 AND 9121 (CLUTCH SOLENOID) CABLE HOLE LOCATIONS .......................................................................... 4-7 9120 and 9121 Enclosure Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 9122 (CLUTCH /TROLL SOLENOID) CABLE HOLE LOCATIONS ................................................................................. 4-7 9122 Enclosure Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 9210 AND 9211 (THROTTLE ELECTRONIC) CABLE HOLE LOCATIONS ...................................................................... 4-7 9210 and 9211 Enclosure Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 9221 (THROTTLE ELECTRONIC AND CLUTCH SOLENOID) CABLE HOLE LOCATIONS .................................................... 4-8 9221 Enclosure Cable Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 Figure 4-11: 9000 Series Circuit Board Hard-Wired Termination Points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 4-4.6.1 Figure 4-12: Figure 4-13: Figure 4-14: SEVEN-CONDUCTOR CONTROL HEAD CABLE (LOCATIONS 1, 2, 3, 6, AND 7) .......................................................... 4-9 Seven-Conductor Control Head Cable Shield Wire and Heat-Shrink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 Clamp Views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 Terminal Strip Cable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 4-4.6.2 4-4.6.2.1 4-4.6.2.2 Figure 4-15: 4-4.6.3 Figure 4-16: 4-4.6.4 Figure 4-17: START INTERLOCK CABLE (LOCATION 4)........................................................................................................... 4-10 Connection at the Starter Solenoid - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-10 Connection at the Processor - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-10 Two-Conductor Start Interlock Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11 POWER CABLE (LOCATION 5)......................................................................................................................... 4-11 Two-Conductor Power Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11 SERIAL COMMUNICATION CABLE (LOCATION 8)................................................................................................. 4-12 Four-Conductor Serial Communication Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 4-4.6.5 Figure 4-18: Figure 4-19: TACHOMETER CABLE (LOCATION 9) ................................................................................................................ 4-13 AC Type Tachometer Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 Open Collector Tachometer Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4-4.5 4-4.6 Table 4-2: Table 4-3: Table 4-4: 4-4.7 4-4.7.1 4-4.7.1.1 9000 Series Circuit Board Termination Points. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 Locations 1 - 9 Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Remote Stations ...........................4-10 Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Serial Communication................... 4-12 Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Tachometer................................... 4-14 Locations 10 and 11 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 CLUTCH CABLE (LOCATION 10) ...................................................................................................................... 4-14 Processor Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-14 TOC-4 TABLE OF CONTENTS Figure 4-20: 4-4.7.1.2 Figure 4-21: Clutch Cable Heat Shrink in Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 Plug Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-15 Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15 4-4.7.2 4-4.7.2.3 Figure 4-22: 4-4.7.2.4 Figure 4-23: CLUTCH /TROLL CABLE (LOCATION 10 & 11) .................................................................................................... 4-15 Processor Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-15 Clutch/Troll Cable Heat Shrink in Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15 Plug Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-16 Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16 Table 4-5: Table 4-6: 4-4.8 4-4.8.1 4-4.8.1.1 Figure 4-24: 4-4.8.1.2 Figure 4-25: Table 4-7: 4-4.9 4-4.9.1 Figure 4-26: Table 4-8: Clutch Termination Table........................................................................................................................... 4-15 Clutch/Troll Termination Table................................................................................................................... 4-16 Locations 10 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16 CLUTCH CABLE (LOCATION 10) ...................................................................................................................... 4-16 Processor Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-16 Clutch Cable Heat Shrink in Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 Plug Termination - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 4-17 Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 Clutch Termination Table........................................................................................................................... 4-17 Location 12 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 THROTTLE CABLE (LOCATION 12) ................................................................................................................... 4-17 Engine Shield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 Throttle Termination Table.......................................................................................................................... 4-18 4-5 Engine Stop Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4-6 Push-Pull Cable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4-6.1 Processor Cable Clamp Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Push-Pull Cable Interior Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Figure 4-29: Throttle Push-Pull Idle Orientation to Selector Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Figure 4-30: Shift Push-Pull Cable Neutral Connection at Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 4-6.2 4-6.3 4-6.4 5 5-1 Figure 5-1: Figure 5-2: Figure 5-3: Figure 5-4: 5-1.2 Figure 5-5: 5-1.2.1 5-1.2.2 5-1.2.3 Figure 5-6: 5-1.2.4 Figure 5-7: 5-5 5-6 Throttle Selector Lever. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Shift Selector Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 Trolling Valve Selector Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 SET UP PROCEDURE 5-1.1 5-2 5-3 5-4 Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 Figure 4-27: Figure 4-28: Table 5-1: Table 5-2: Figure 5-8: Table 5-3: 5-6.1 5-6.1.1 Figure 5-9: Figure 5-10: 5-6.1.2 Figure 5-12: 5-6.1.3 Figure 5-13: Figure 5-11: 5-6.1.4 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-1 Processor Components Used In Set Up. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 Typical Processor Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 Processor Shield Push Button and Display LED Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 Processor Display LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Push Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Display LED at Normal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Display LED Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Circuit Board Push Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 UP AND DOWN PUSH BUTTONS ....................................................................................................................... 5-2 LEFT AND RIGHT PUSH BUTTONS ...................................................................................................................... 5-2 LEFT PUSH BUTTON ONLY ............................................................................................................................... 5-3 Display LED Error Menu Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 RIGHT PUSH BUTTON ONLY ............................................................................................................................. 5-3 Display LED Four Digit Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Activating Set Up Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Storing Values To Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Set Up Function Codes And Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4 Function Codes ............................................................................................................................................. 5-4 Processors Function Code Defaults.............................................................................................................. 5-6 Field Service Test Unit (Break-out Box) and Multimeter Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Service Field Test Unit and Multimeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Functions Requiring Service Field Test Unit and Multimeter ....................................................................... 5-7 System Programming And Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Processor Functio ns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 FUNCTION CODE A0 – PROCESSOR IDENTIFICATION ............................................................................................ 5-8 E1, E2, E3, E4, E6, L4 Processor, Test Unit, and Multimeter Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 L2, L3, C6, and C7 Processor, Test Unit, and Multimeter Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 FUNCTION CODE A1 – NUMBER OF ENGINES ..................................................................................................... 5-9 Display LED Function A1 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 FUNCTION CODE A2 – ONE LEVER OPERATION .................................................................................................. 5-9 Display LED Function A2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Display LED Function A0 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 FUNCTION CODE A3 – SE (STATION EXPANDER).............................................................................................. 5-10 TOC-5 TABLE OF CONTENTS Figure 5-14: 5-6.1.5 Figure 5-15: 5-6.2 5-6.2.1 5-6.2.1.1 5-6.2.1.2 Figure 5-17: 5-6.2.1.3 Figure 5-18: 5-6.2.1.4 Figure 5-16: Figure 5-19: 5-6.2.1.5 Figure 5-20: 5-6.2.2 5-6.2.2.1 Figure 5-21: 5-6.2.2.2 Figure 5-24: 5-6.2.2.3 Figure 5-25: Figure 5-22: Figure 5-23: Figure 5-26: 5-6.2.3 5-6.2.3.1 Figure 5-27: 5-6.2.3.2 Figure 5-28: 5-6.2.3.3 Figure 5-29: 5-6.3 5-6.3.1 5-6.3.1.1 Figure 5-30: 5-6.3.1.2 Figure 5-31: 5-6.3.1.3 5-6.3.1.4 Figure 5-33: 5-6.3.1.5 Figure 5-32: Figure 5-34: 5-6.4 5-6.4.1.1 Figure 5-35: 5-6.4.1.2 Figure 5-37: Figure 5-38: 5-6.4.1.3 Figure 5-39: Figure 5-36: 5-6.4.2 5-6.4.2.1 Figure 5-41: Figure 5-40: 5-6.4.2.2 Figure 5-42: 5-6.4.2.3 Figure 5-43: 5-6.5 5-6.5.1 5-6.5.1.4 Figure 5-44: 5-6.5.1.5 Figure 5-49: Figure 5-45: Figure 5-46: Figure 5-47: Display LED Function A3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 FUNCTION CODE A4 – NEUTRAL INDICATION TONE .......................................................................................... 5-10 Display LED Function A4 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Thro ttle Functio ns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Clutch Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15 Clutch Servo Functio ns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18 Troll Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22 THROTTLE BASIC FUNCTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 5-10 Function Code E5 – Throttle Pause Following Shift - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-10 Function Code E6 – High Idle - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-11 Display LED Function E6 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Function Code E1 – Throttle in Neutral - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-11 Display LED Function E1 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Function Code E4 – Throttle Maximum Astern - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-11 Display LED Function E5 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Display LED Function E4 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Function Code E7 – Synchronization - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-12 Display LED Function E7 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 THROTTLE SERVO FUNCTIONS ........................................................................................................................ 5-12 Function Code E0 – Throttle Servo Direction - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-12 Throttle Push-Pull Cable Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Function Code E2 – Throttle Minimum - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-13 Display LED Function E2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Function Code E3 – Throttle Maximum - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-13 Throttle Push-Pull Cable Full Throttle Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Example: Throttle Push-Pull Cable Fully Retracted Position for Idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Display LED Function E0 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Display LED Function E3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14 THROTTLE ELECTRONIC FUNCTIONS ................................................................................................................. 5-14 Function Code E0 – Engine Throttle Profile - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-14 Display LED Function E0 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14 Function Code E2 – Throttle Minimum - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-15 Display LED Function E2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15 Function Code E3 – Throttle Maximum - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-15 Display LED Function E3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15 CLUTCH BASIC FUNCTIONS ............................................................................................................................ 5-15 Function Code C0 – Clutch Pressure Interlock - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-15 Display LED Function C0 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16 Function Code C1 – Clutch Interlock Delay - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-16 Display LED Function C1 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16 Function Code C2 – Proportional Pause - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-16 Function Code C3 – Proportional Pause Time - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-17 Display LED Function C3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17 Function Code C4 – Proportional Pause Ratio - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-17 Display LED Function C2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17 Display LED Function C4 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18 Function Code C5 – Clutch Servo Direction - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-18 Clutch Push-Pull Cable Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18 Function Code C6 – Clutch Ahead Travel - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-19 Clutch Push-Pull Cable Ahead Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19 Display LED Function C6 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19 Function Code C7 – Clutch Astern Travel - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-19 Clutch Push-Pull Cable Astern Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19 Display LED Function C5 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19 CLUTCH SOLENOID FUNCTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 5-20 Function Code C5 – Shift Solenoid Type - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-20 Display LED Function C5 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20 Display LED Function C7 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20 Function Code C6 – ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Ahead - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-21 Display LED Function C6 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21 Function Code C7 – ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Astern - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-21 Display LED Function C7 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21 BASIC TROLL COMMAND FUNCTIONS .............................................................................................................. 5-22 Function Code L0 – Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Troll Range - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-22 Display LED Function L0 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22 Function Code L4 – Troll Throttle Limit - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-23 Display LED Function L4 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Control Head 20 Degree Troll Range - Type 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Control Head 35 Degree Troll Range - Type 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Control Head 45 Degree Troll Range - Type 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 TOC-6 TABLE OF CONTENTS Figure 5-48: 5-6.5.1.6 5-6.5.2 5-6.5.2.1 Figure 5-50: 5-6.5.2.2 Figure 5-51: 5-6.5.2.3 Figure 5-52: 5-6.5.2.4 Figure 5-53: 5-6.5.3 5-6.5.4 5-6.5.4.1 Figure 5-54: 5-6.5.4.2 Figure 5-55: 5-6.5.4.3 Figure 5-56: 5-6.5.4.4 Figure 5-57: 5-6.5.5 5-6.5.1 5-6.5.1.1 5-6.5.1.2 5-6.5.2 5-6.5.2.1 Control Head 55 Degree Troll Range - Type 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Function Code L5 – Troll Pulse Duration - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-24 TROLL SERVO FUNCTIONS.............................................................................................................................. 5-24 Function Code L1 – Troll Servo Direction - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-24 Display LED Function L1 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24 Function Code L2 – Troll Minimum Pressure - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-25 Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25 Function Code L3 – Troll Maximum Pressure - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-25 Display LED Function L3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25 Function Code L6 – Troll Pulse Percentage - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-26 Display LED Function L6 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26 9001 TROLL ACTUATOR FUNCTIONS (SERVO 3)................................................................................................ 5-26 INTEGRATED TROLL SOLENOID FUNCTIONS ...................................................................................................... 5-26 Function Code L1 – Troll Valve Function - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-26 Display LED Function L1 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-27 Function Code L2 – Troll Minimum Pressure - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-27 Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-27 Function Code L3 – Troll Maximum Pressure - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-27 Display LED Function L3 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Function Code L6 – Troll Pulse Percentage - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-28 Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 5-28 BASIC PROCESSOR TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTIONS ........................................................................................... 5-28 Function Code H0 - Diagnostics - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-28 Function Code H1 – Return to Factory Defaults - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-28 ADDITIONAL 9000 SERIES TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTION ................................................................................... 5-29 Function Code H2 - Driver Fault Detection Enable - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 5-29 Table 5-1: Solenoid Error Status Enable ...................................................................................................................... 5-29 6 DOCK TRIALS - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 6-1 6-1 6-2 6-3 6-4 6-5 6-6 6-7 6-8 6-9 6-10 6-10.1 6-10.1.1 Table 6-1: 6-10.2 6-10.2.1 Table 6-2: 7 Control Heads (Engines Stopped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1 Start Interlock (Engines Stopped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1 Engine Stop Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1 Push-Pull Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 High Idle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Control Head Servo Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Control Head Solenoid Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Throttle Pause Following Servo Shift. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Throttle Pause Following Solenoid Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Trolling Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Troll Servo Adjustments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT AT THE DOCK ...................................................................................... 6-4 Shaft RPM at Idle .......................................................................................................................................... 6-4 Troll Solenoid Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT AT THE DOCK ...................................................................................... 6-4 Shaft RPM at Idle .......................................................................................................................................... 6-5 SEA TRIALS - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 7-1 7-11 7-12 7-13 Full Speed Setting - Servo Throttle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1 Full Speed Setting - Electronic Throttle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1 Proportional Pause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 7-14 Synchronization Test (Twin Screw Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 7-15 Trolling Valve Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 7-13.1 7-13.2 7-13.3 7-13.4 7-13.5 7-14.1 7-14.2 7-15.1 7-15.1.1 7-15.1.2 In-Gear Delay [C200] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Neutral Delay [C201] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed Neutral Delay [C202] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Calculating Proportional Pause Time C3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing The Proportional Pause. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 7-2 7-2 7-3 7-3 Equal Throttle Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Active Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Integrated Servo Trolling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 ENABLING TROLL ............................................................................................................................................ 7-5 TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS (FUNCTION CODE L2) ......................................................................... 7-5 TOC-7 TABLE OF CONTENTS Table 7-1: 7-15.1.3 7-15.2 Table 7-2: 7-15.2.1 7-15.2.2 7-15.2.3 7-15.3 7-15.4 7-15.5 7-15.5.1 7-15.5.2 7-16 7-16.1 7-16.2 7-16.3 Table 7-3: 7-16.4 7-16.4.1 7-16.4.2 8 8-1 Shaft RPM at Idle .......................................................................................................................................... 7-6 TROLL MAXIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS (FUNCTION CODE L3) ........................................................................ 7-6 Integrated Solenoid Trolling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 Troll Valve Adjustments ................................................................................................................................ 7-7 ENABLING TROLL ............................................................................................................................................ 7-7 TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT (FUNCTION CODE L2)........................................................................... 7-8 TROLL MAXIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT (FUNCTION CODE L3).......................................................................... 7-8 Troll Throttle Limit Adjustment (Function Code L4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 Troll Pulse Duration (Function Code L5) & Troll Pulse Percentage (Function Code L6) Adjustments 7-9 Integrated ZF-Hurth Solenoid Trolling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 ENABLING ZF-HURTH TROLL .......................................................................................................................... 7-10 TROLL MAXIMUM CURRENT ADJUSTMENT ........................................................................................................ 7-10 Sea Trial Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 Vessel Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 Control System Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 Record Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12 Processor Parameters Record .................................................................................................................... 7-13 Comments (Please use additional paper as necessary):. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14 GENERAL INSTALLATION CONDITION ................................................................................................................ 7-14 ANY IRREGULARITIES:.................................................................................................................................... 7-14 CONTROL OPTIONS - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 8-1 Figure 8-1: Figure 8-2: 8-1.1 8-2 8-2.1 8-2.1.1 8-2.1.2 Figure 8-3: Figure 8-4: External Alarm Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1 External Alarm Connections with Processor Harness Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1 External Alarm Connections Processor Hard-Wired Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Clutch Pressure Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 C0 Methods of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 01 - INSTALLED ............................................................................................................................................. 8-2 02 - THROTTLE CLUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK.................................................................................................... 8-3 Clutch Pressure Switch with Processor Harness Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3 Clutch Pressure Switch with Processor Hard-Wired Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3 8-3 Station Expander (SE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3 8-4 9001 Actuator Trolling Valve Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4 8-3.1 9 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3 PERIODIC CHECKS AND MAINTENANCE - - - - - - - - - - - - - 9-1 9-1 9-2 Control Heads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 9-3 Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 9-2.1 9-2.2 9-2.3 9-3.1 9-3.1.1 Table 9-1: 9-3.1.2 9-3.1.3 9-3.2 Throttle Servo Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 Clutch Servo Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 Troll Integrated Servo Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 QUARTERLY (EVERY 3 MONTHS)....................................................................................................................... 9-2 Fully Charged Battery ................................................................................................................................... 9-2 SEMI-ANNUALLY (EVERY 6 MONTHS)................................................................................................................ 9-2 ANNUALLY (EVERY 12 MONTHS)...................................................................................................................... 9-2 Power Cables, Distribution Panels, etc.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2 Appendix A PARTS LIST.............................................................................................................................................. A-1 MMC-280 Rev.K 8/03............................................................................................................................ A-3 400 Series Standard Control Head Variations TOC-8 TABLE OF CONTENTS MMC-329 Rev.C 8/03............................................................................................................................. A-9 MC2000 Series Standard Control Head Variations MMC-307 Rev.G 8/03 ......................................................................................................................... A-15 700 Series Standard Control Head Variations MMC-279 Rev.B 7/02........................................................................................................................... A-21 400 Series Weather Mount Enclosure Deutsch Connector Assembly............................................................................................................... A-23 S-214 Rev.E 5/03................................................................................................................................. A-25 Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505 Drawing 11488D-1 Twin Screw Single APS Connection & Alternate Remote Switch ......................... A-27 Drawing 11488D-2 Twin Screw Dual APS Connections ....................................................................... A-29 Drawing 11488D-3 APS Notes Page..................................................................................................... A-31 MMC-287 Rev.D 8/03.......................................................................................................................... A-33 Bonding: A.B.Y.C. E-11, 46 CFR 111.05 MMC-288 Rev.E 8-03 .......................................................................................................................... A-35 References and Parts Source SER-161 Rev.B 5/03 ............................................................................................................................. A-37 Engine Tachometer Sender Requirements MMC-289 Rev.- 6/01 ........................................................................................................................... A-39 Morse Clutch and Throttle Kit Selection MMC-290 Rev.- 6/01............................................................................................................................ A-41 Universal Mounting Kit MM13821 Rev.A 8/03 .......................................................................................................................... A-43 43C Cable Conversion Kit Revisions List ........................................................................................................................................ A-43 MMC-165 Rev.D 3/02........................................................................................................................... A-45 Electronic Propulsion Control Systems Three Year Limited Warranty MMC-163 Rev.B 1-01........................................................................................................................... C-47 Warranty Registration Appendix B B1 B1-1 B1-1.1 TROUBLESHOOTING GENERAL - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B1-1 Control Systems Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-1 9120 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid) Processor and 9122 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid, Troll Solenoid) Processor B1-1 Figure B1-1: 9120 and 9122 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-1 Figure B1-2: 9121 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-2 Figure B1-3: 9210 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-2 Figure B1-4: 9211 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-3 Figure B1-5: 9221 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-3 B1-1.2 B1-1.3 B1-1.4 B1-1.5 B1-2 B1-2.1 B1-2.2 B1-2.3 B1-2.4 9121 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid, Troll Servo 1) Processor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-2 9210 (Throttle Electronic, Shift Servo 1) Processor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-2 9211 (Throttle Electronic, Shift Servo 1, Troll Servo 2) Processor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-3 9221 (Throttle Electronic, Clutch Solenoid, Troll Servo 2) Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-3 Typical System Main Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-4 Control Head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Source. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrical Cables and Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TOC-9 B1-4 B1-4 B1-4 B1-4 TABLE OF CONTENTS B1-2.5 Table B1-1: B2 Push-Pull Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B1-4 ClearCommand Processor Push-Pull Reference.........................................................................................B1-5 TROUBLESHOOTING QUESTIONS - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B2-1 B3 TROUBLESHOOTING PROBLEM RESOLUTION - - - - - - - - - - B3-1 B3-1 B3-2 DC Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-1 Component Location. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-1 B3-3 Component Condition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-2 B3-4 Interconnecting Wiring and Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-2 B3-2.1 B3-2.2 B3-3.1 B3-3.2 Table B3-2: B4 Figure B4-6: Figure B4-7: Figure B4-8: Figure B4-9: Figure B4-10: Figure B4-11: Figure B4-12: Figure B4-13: B5 B5-1 B5-1.1 Control Heads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-1 Processors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-1 Control Heads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-2 Processors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B3-2 Examples of Components (Internal/External) .............................................................................................B3-2 TROUBLESHOOTING DIAGNOSTIC MENU - - - - - - - - - - - - B4-1 Display Function Code List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-1 Display Troubleshooting Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-1 Display Troubleshooting Function Blinking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-1 Example Display of Applied Battery Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-1 Example Display of Tach Sensor Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-2 Example Display Control Head Lever Current Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-2 Example Display Control Head Transfer Button Status View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-3 Example Display Software Revision Level View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B4-3 TROUBLESHOOTING AUDIBLE TONES - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B5-1 Basic Control System Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-1 Slow Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-1 Figure B5-14: Slow Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-1 B5-1.2 One Long - Three Short Tones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-2 B5-1.3 Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-4 B5-1.4 Three Second Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-4 B5-1.5 Three Second Steady Tone, followed by a Slow Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 B5-1.6 Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 B5-1.7 Five Second Steady Tone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 Figure B5-15: One Long - Three Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-2 Figure B5-16: Display Examples of Remote Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-3 Figure B5-17: Display Examples of Remote Stations A/D Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-3 Figure B5-18: Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-4 Figure B5-19: Three Second Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-4 Figure B5-20: Three Second Tone, followed by a Slow Repetitive Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 Figure B5-21: Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 Figure B5-22: Five Second Steady Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 B5-2 B5-2.1 Servo 1 Control System Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 Figure B5-23: One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-5 B5-2.2 One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-6 Figure B5-24: One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-6 B5-3 B5-3.1 Servo 2 Control System Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-7 One Long - Two Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-7 Figure B5-25: One Long - Two Short Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-7 B5-3.2 One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-7 Figure B5-26: One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-7 B5-4 B5-4.1 Clutch Solenoid Control System Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-8 One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-8 Figure B5-27: One Long - One Short Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5-8 B6 B6-1 B6-2 TROUBLESHOOTING STATION TRANSFER - - - - - - - - - - - - B6-1 Command Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-1 A to D Counts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-1 TOC-10 TABLE OF CONTENTS Table B6-3: B6-3 Control Head Lever A/D Counts..................................................................................................................B6-2 Remote Station Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-3 Figure B6-28: Display Station A/D’s No Station Transfer Button Depressed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-3 Figure B6-29: Example Display Station A/D’s Transfer Button Depressed for Stations 1 - 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-3 Figure B6-30: Display Station A/D/s Transfer Button Depressed for Station 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B6-3 B7 TROUBLESHOOTING Stuck Transfer Button - - - - - - - - - - - B7-1 B8 Error Codes - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B8-1 B8-4 Clutch Solenoid Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B8-1 B8-5 Troll Solenoid Error Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B8-1 B8-6 Basic Control System Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B8-1 B8-7 Servo 1 Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B8-3 B8-8 Servo 2 Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B8-3 Table B8-4: Table B8-5: Table B8-6: Table B8-7: Table B8-8: B9 Clutch Solenoid Control System Error Codes .............................................................................................B8-1 Troll Solenoid Control System Error Codes.................................................................................................B8-1 Basic Control System Error Codes..............................................................................................................B8-1 Servo 1 Error Codes....................................................................................................................................B8-3 Servo 2 Error Codes....................................................................................................................................B8-3 Basic PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS - - - - - - - - - - - B9-1 B9-1 Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-1 B9-2 Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-6 B9-3 Servo 1 Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-6 B9-4 Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-7 B9-5 Servo 1 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-7 B9-6 Servo 2 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B9-8 Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions................................................................................B9-1 Table B9-10: Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions.........................................................................................B9-6 Table B9-11: Servo 1 Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions...........................................................................................B9-6 Table B9-12: Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions.........................................................................................B9-7 Table B9-13: Servo 1 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions..............................................................................................B9-7 Table B9-14: Servo 2 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions..............................................................................................B9-8 B10 B10-1 B10-2 B10-3 B10-4 B10-5 B11 B11-1 B11-1.1 PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B10-1 Basic Control System Problems Without Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Servo Clutch Control System Problems Without Error Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Servo Throttle Control System Problems Without Error Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solenoid Clutch Control System Problems Without Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electronic Throttle Control System Problems Without Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . B10-1 B10-2 B10-2 B10-3 B10-3 Synchronization Troubleshooting - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B11-1 Equal Throttle Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-1 Basic Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-1 Table B11-15: Basic Problem Causes and Solutions........................................................................................................B11-1 B11-1.2 Servo Throttle Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-1 B11-1.3 Servo Clutch Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-2 Table B11-16: Servo Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions..........................................................................................B11-1 Table B11-17: Servo Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions............................................................................................B11-2 B11-2 B11-2.1 Active Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-2 Basic Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-2 Table B11-18: Basic Problem Causes and Solutions........................................................................................................B11-2 B11-2.2 Servo Throttle Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-3 B11-2.3 Servo Clutch Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-3 Table B11-19: Servo Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions..........................................................................................B11-3 Table B11-20: Servo Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions............................................................................................B11-3 B11-3 Electronic Equal Throttle Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B11-4 Table B11-21: Electronic Throttle - Equal Throttle Synch Problem Causes and Solutions ..............................................B11-4 TOC-11 TABLE OF CONTENTS B12 B12-1 TROUBLESHOOTING Cable Harnesses - - - - - - - - - - - - - B12-1 Basic Control System Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-1 Table B12-1: Power, Start Interlock Harness Pin-Out....................................................................................................B12-1 Figure B12-1: Power, Start Interlock Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-1 Table B12-2: Power, Start Interlock, and Pressure Switch Harness Pin-Out.................................................................B12-1 Figure B12-2: Power, Start Interlock, Pressure Switch Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-1 Table B12-3: Power, Start Interlock, Pressure Switch, and Alarm Harness Pin-Out .....................................................B12-2 Figure B12-3: Power, Start Interlock, Pressure Switch, Alarm Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-2 Table B12-4: Serial Communication Harness Pin-Out....................................................................................................B12-2 Figure B12-4: Serial Communication Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-2 Table B12-5: Control Head Harness Pin-Out and Hard-Wire.........................................................................................B12-2 Figure B12-5: Control Head Harness Plug Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-2 Table B12-6: Tachometer Sensor Harness Pin-Out........................................................................................................B12-3 Figure B12-8: Tachometer Sensor Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 B12-2 B12-2.1 Clutch Harnesses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 Ahead and Astern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 Table B12-7: Ahead and Astern Clutch Harness Pin-Out...............................................................................................B12-3 Figure B12-9: Clutch Ahead, and Astern Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 Figure B12-6: Control Head Port Terminal Strip Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 Figure B12-7: Control Head Starboard Terminal Strip Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-3 B12-2.2 Ahead, Neutral, and Astern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 Table B12-8: Ahead, Neutral, and Astern Clutch Harness Pin-Out................................................................................B12-4 Figure B12-10: Clutch, Ahead, Astern, and Neutral Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 B12-3 B12-3.1 Clutch/Troll Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 Ahead, Astern, Troll On/Off & Troll Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 Table B12-9: Ahead, Astern, Troll On/Off and Troll Command Clutch/Troll Harness Pin-Out .......................................B12-4 Figure B12-11: Clutch/Troll Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 B12-4 B12-4.1 Throttle Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 PWM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 Table B12-10: PWM Throttle Harness Pin-Out.................................................................................................................B12-4 Figure B12-12: PWM Throttle Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-4 B12-4.2 Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 Table B12-11: Voltage Throttle Harness Pin-Out .............................................................................................................B12-5 Figure B12-13: Voltage Throttle Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 B12-4.3 Current, MAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 Table B12-12: Current, MAN, Throttle Harness Pin-Out ..................................................................................................B12-5 Figure B12-14: Current Throttle Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 B12-4.4 Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 Table B12-13: Frequency Throttle Harness Pin-Out.........................................................................................................B12-5 Figure B12-15: Frequency Throttle Harness Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B12-5 B13 B13-1 Processor Pigtails - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - B13-1 Basic Processor Pigtails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-1 Table B13-1: Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Oil Pressure Switch, and Alarm Pigtail Pin-Out........................................B13-1 Figure B13-1: Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Oil Pressure, and Alarm Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-1 Table B13-2: Serial Communication Pigtail Pin-Out.......................................................................................................B13-1 Figure B13-2: Serial Communication Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-1 Table B13-3: Control Head Pigtail Pin-Out (Up to 5 Stations)........................................................................................B13-1 Figure B13-3: Control Head Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-1 B13-2 Clutch Pigtail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 Table B13-4: Clutch Pigtail Pin-Out................................................................................................................................B13-2 Figure B13-4: Clutch Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 B13-3 Clutch/Troll Pigtail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 Table B13-5: Clutch/Troll Pigtail Pin-Out........................................................................................................................B13-2 Figure B13-5: Clutch/Troll Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 B13-4 Throttle Pigtail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 Table B13-6: Throttle Pigtail Pin-Out..............................................................................................................................B13-2 Figure B13-6: Throttle Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 Table B13-7: Tachometer Sensor Pigtail Pin-Out...........................................................................................................B13-2 Figure B13-7: Tachometer Sensor No.1 Pigtail Pin Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B13-2 ENG-143 Ver 1.0 4-04 ............................................................................................................................ B-3 ClearCommand 9000 Elect-Thr Sol-Shift Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure ENG-144 Ver 1.0 4-04 ............................................................................................................................ B-7 ClearCommand 9000 Elect-Thr Ser-Cl Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure TOC-12 TABLE OF CONTENTS ENG-145 Ver 1.0 4-04 .......................................................................................................................... B-11 ClearCommand 9000 Ser-Thr Sol-Cl Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure MMC-172 Rev.Z-O 11/03 ..................................................................................................................... B-15 Factory Authorized Sales & Service Centers - International MM13927 Table of Contents ..............................................................................................................TOC-1 Revision List .......................................................................................................................................TOC-2 1 INTRODUCTION - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1-1 Figure 1-1: Figure 1-2: Figure 1-3: Service Field Test Unit (Break-out Box) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 CruiseCommand Connector Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Example of ClearCommand Pigtail Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Table 1-1: Connector/Pigtail Descriptions ..................................................................................................................... 1-2 2 PROCEDURE 2-1 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 2-1 Throttle Signal Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 2-1.1 DC Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Figure 2-4: Throttle Connection (DC Voltage) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Figure 2-5: Throttle Connection (Current mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Figure 2-6: Throttle Connection (PWM with DC Voltmeter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Figure 2-7: Throttle Connection (PWM with Duty Cycle Meter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Figure 2-8: Throttle Connection (Frequency Hz) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 2-1.2 2-1.3 2-1.4 2-1.5 2-2 2-2.1 Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with DC Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with Duty Cycle Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Frequency (Hz.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 CLUTCH TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Neutral Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Figure 2-9: Clutch Connection (Neutral Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Figure 2-10: Clutch Connection (Ahead Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Figure 2-11: Clutch Connection (Astern Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 2-2.2 2-2.3 2-3 2-3.1 Ahead Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Astern Solenoid Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 TROLL TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Troll On/Off Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Figure 2-12: Troll Connection (ON/OFF Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Figure 2-13: Troll Connection (Proportional Solenoid with Amp Meter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 2-3.2 3 Troll Command (Proportional Solenoid) Testing with Amp Meter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Parts List Table 3-2: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 3-1 Parts List ....................................................................................................................................................... 3-1 Appendix C Drawing 12284A-1 ClearCommand Diagram (all options) .................................................................... C-1 Drawing 12284A-2 ClearCommand Circuit Board Connections ............................................................ C-3 Drawing 12284A-3 ClearCommand Drawing Notes Page ..................................................................... C-5 TOC-13 REVISIONS LIST Revisions List Rev Date Revision Description PageTOC-14 INTRODUCTION 1 INTRODUCTION This manual is written to document every possible system option. Your system may not include every available option for single or twin screw reverse reduction gear applications. Only those sections that apply to your specific installation are relevant to your vessel. If additional options described within this manual are desired, contact your dealer for availability/compatibility with your system. 1-1 MANUAL CONTENTS 1-2 B This manual is divided into 12 Sections which cover, in detail, the features and operation of your system: • Introduction (Section 1) • Operation (Section 2) • Plan the Installation (Section 3) • Installation (Section 4) • Set Up Procedures (Section 5) • Dock Trials (Section 6) • Sea Trials (Section 7) • Control Options (Section 8) • Periodic Checks and Maintenance (Section 9) • ZF Mathers Service Sheets (Appendix A) • Troubleshooting (Appendix B) • General System Drawings (Appendix C) ASIC THEORY OF OPERATION The ClearCommand Marine Propulsion Control System (hereafter referred to as ClearCommand or System) is electronic and requires a 12 or 24 VDC power supply, one Processor per engine/clutch and one Control Head per remote station. The ClearCommand commands the vessel’s throttle and shift using a single Control Head lever. One electric cable per Control Head lever connects the remote station(s) to the Processor(s). Only one remote station will have command at a given time and the Station-in-Command is indicated by a red light located on the Control Head. Station transfer is accomplished by pressing the Control Head mounted transfer button 1-2.1 9120 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid) or 9122 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid, Troll-Solenoid) The or System is designed for pleasure and light commercial marine vessels that require remote control of: 9120 9122 9120 • mechanically actuated engines • solenoid activated clutches. Page 1-1 INTRODUCTION 9122 • mechanically actuated engines • solenoid activated clutches • solenoid activated trolling valves. The 9120 or 9122 Processor is typically mounted in the engine room area and is connected mechanically to the vessel’s main engine throttle selector lever with standard 33C type push-pull cables. The 9120 Processor controls the electrical Ahead and Astern Shift Solenoids at the transmission, via electric cable. The 9122 Processor controls the electrical Transmission and Trolling Valve Solenoids for shift and trolling functions, via electric cable. STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION TACH 1 PORT FULL IDLE TACH 1 AHEAD/ASTERN TROLL COMMAND TROLL ON/OFF STBD 12296A THROTTLE THROTTLE 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKER (BY OTHERS) COMMON GROUND FULL IDLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. APS + + COMMON GROUND 30A 30A FUSE FUSE Figure 1-1: Basic 9120 or 9122 ClearCommand System Diagram - AHEAD/ASTERN TROLL COMMAND TROLL ON/OFF Page 1-2 INTRODUCTION 1-2.2 9121 Processor (Throttle-Servo 2, Shift-Solenoid, Troll-Servo 1) The System is designed for pleasure and light commercial marine vessels that require remote control of: 9121 • mechanically actuated engines • solenoid activated clutches • mechanical trolling valves. The Processor is typically mounted in the engine room area and is connected mechanically to the vessel’s main engine throttle selector lever and trolling valve with standard 33C type push-pull cables. The transmission is controlled via electrical cables connected to the Ahead and Astern Shift Solenoids. STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION TACH 1 MAX MIN SLIP SLIP AHEAD/ ASTERN PORT FULL IDLE THROTTLE TROLL 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) COMMON GROUND TACH 1 - MAX MIN SLIP SLIP STBD 12295A FULL IDLE TROLL THROTTLE 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. APS + + - COMMON GROUND 30A 30A FUSE FUSE Figure 1-2: Basic 9121 ClearCommand System Diagram Page 1-3 AHEAD/ ASTERN INTRODUCTION 1-2.3 9210 Processor (Throttle-Electronic, Shift-Servo 1) The System is designed for pleasure and light commercial marine vessels that require remote control of: 9210 • electronic engine governors • mechanically actuated clutches The Processor is typically mounted in the engine room area and is connected to the electronic governor with a two-conductor, shielded, electric cable. The transmission is controlled mechanically using standard 33C type push-pull cable. STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION THROTTLE TACH 1 THROTTLE TACH 1 PORT STBD RNF R NF SHIFT 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) COMMON GROUND - + 12294A SHIFT 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. APS 30A FUSE 30A FUSE + - COMMON GROUND Figure 1-3: Basic 9210 ClearCommand System Diagram Page 1-4 INTRODUCTION 1-2.4 9211 Processor (Throttle - Electronic, Shift - Servo 1, Troll - Servo 2) The System is designed for pleasure and light commercial marine vessels that require remote control of: 9211 • electronic engine governors • mechanically actuated clutches • mechanically actuated trolling valves. The Processor is typically mounted in the engine room area and is connected to the electronic governor with a two-conductor, shielded, electric cable. The transmission and trolling valve are controlled mechanically using a standard 33C type push-pull cable. STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION THROTTLE TACH 1 RNF PORT - STBD MIN MAX SLIP SLIP SHIFT TROLL 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) COMMON GROUND THROTTLE TACH 1 + 30A FUSE 12293A R NF MIN MAX SLIP SLIP SHIFT TROLL 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. APS 30A FUSE + - COMMON GROUND Figure 1-4: Basic 9211 ClearCommand System Diagram Page 1-5 INTRODUCTION 1-2.5 9221 Processor (Throttle - Electronic, Shift - Solenoid, Troll - Servo 2) System is designed for pleasure and light commercial marine vessels that require remote control of: The 9221 • electronic engine governors • solenoid activated clutches • mechanically actuated trolling valves The Processor is typically mounted in the engine room area and is connected to the electronic governor with a two-conductor, shielded, electric cable. The transmission’s Ahead and Astern solenoids are connected via 2 two-conductor cables, and the trolling valve is controlled mechanically using a standard 33C type push-pull cable. STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION THROTTLE TACH 1 PORT MIN MAX SLIP SLIP THROTTLE TACH 1 AHEAD/ ASTERN STBD 12297A MIN MAX SLIP SLIP AHEAD/ ASTERN TROLL TROLL 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK ALARM CLUTCH PRES. START INTERLOCK 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS CLUTCH PRES. (BY OTHERS) APS COMMON COMMON GROUND GROUND - + + 30A 30A FUSE FUSE Figure 1-5: Basic 9221 ClearCommand System Diagram Page 1-6 INTRODUCTION 1-3 YSTEM FEATURES S 1-3.1 Standard Processor Features • Station-in-Command indication. (Section 2-2) • Up to five Remote Stations. (Section 2-2) • Single Control Head lever command of speed and direction. (Section 2-3) • Start Interlock. (Section 2-5) • Push Button Station Transfer. (Section 2-6) • Proportional Pause on through Neutral Shifts. (Section 2-7) • Warm-up Mode. (Section 2-8) • High/Low Idle Selection. (Section 2-9) • One Lever Mode. (Section 2-10) • Engine Synchronization. (Section 2-11) • Easily configured to a vessel’s control requirements.(Section 211.7) • Audible system diagnostics and status indications. (Section 2-12) • Push Button Set Up. (Section 2-13) • Visual system diagnostics, set up, and status indication. (Section 2-14) • Pluggable Connections. (Section 2-15) 1-3.2 9000 Series Additional Features • Integrated Solenoid Trolling Valve ( ) • Integrated Mechanical Trolling Valve( ) 1-3.3 Optional System Features (Section 2-16) • System failure external alarm contact. (Section 2-16.1) • Clutch pressure interlock. (Section 2-16.2) • Station Expander (SE). (Sections 2-16.3) • Multiple Screw installations. (Section 2-16.4) • 9001 Trolling Valve Control (MM9001 Trolling Actuator Manual) 9122 Processor Only 9121, 9211, and 9221 Processors Only Page 1-7 OPERATION 2 OPERATION OWER ON 2-1 DC P When DC power is turned ON to the Processor: • A short steady tone, followed by an intermittent tone, will sound at all Remote Stations indicating that no station has command. • The Start Interlock relay contact will remain open, preventing engine start. • Throttle: Servo: The throttle servo will drive to Idle. Electric: The throttle signal will be commanded to Idle. • Shift: Servo: The Shift servo will drive to Neutral. Solenoid: The Ahead and Astern shift solenoids will be de-energized, commanding Neutral. • Troll: Servo: The trolling valve servo will drive to lock-up. Solenoid: The trolling valve solenoids are commanding lock-up. AKING COMMAND 2-2 T To take command at any one of the up to five Remote Stations: • Ensure all Control Head’s lever(s) at that Station are in the Neutral detent (vertical position) Figure 2-1: Station taking Command • Depress the transfer button for 1/2 second. The Slow Repetitive tone will stop at all Stations, and the red LED indicator light will turn ON at the Control Head of the Station that had assumed command of the Control System. F START INTERLOCK IS USED: ONCE A STATION IS IN COMMAND THE START INTERLOCK RELAY CONTACT WILL CLOSE, ALLOWING THE ENGINE TO START. NOTE: I NOTE: O NLY ONE STATION CAN HAVE COMMAND AT A TIME. Page 2-1 OPERATION 2-3 ASIC OPERATION B 2-3.1 Normal Operating Mode Figure 2-2: Control Head Detents A) The Control Head has three detents; Ahead, Astern and Neutral. B) With the Control Head lever positioned in the Neutral (vertical) detent, the Processor will command Neutral and the throttle at Idle revolutions per minute (RPM). C) Movement of the Control Head’s lever 15 degrees to the Ahead or Astern detent will command Ahead or Astern clutch engagement, while the engine RPM remains at Idle. D) Further movement of the Control Head lever through the next 65 degrees, will increase the engine RPM in proportion to the Control Head’s lever position. 2-4 ROLLING VALVE OPERATIONL T WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. On Control System’s equipped to control trolling valves, the operation is quite different. Troll Mode is a feature that must be turned On and Off at the Control Head. A) The Control Head has three detents; Ahead, Astern and Neutral. To turn ON Troll Mode, place the Control Head lever in any of the above mentioned detents. • With the Control Head lever positioned in the Neutral (vertical) detent, the Processor will command Neutral, the trolling valve will be at lock-up and the throttle at Idle rpm. B) Depress and hold the transfer button for two (2) seconds. • The solid red indicator light on the Control Head will begin blinking rapidly, indicating the system is now in Troll Mode. NOTE: IF SYSTEM IS SET FOR TWIN SCREW OPERATION, ENSURE ALL CONTROL HEAD LEVERS ARE IN THE SAME DETENT (NEUTRAL, AHEAD OR ASTERN). Page 2-2 OPERATION Figure 2-3: Control Head 20 Degree Troll Range - Type 1 Figure 2-4: Control Head 35 Degree Troll Range - Type 2 Figure 2-5: Control Head 45 Degree Troll Range - Type 3 Figure 2-6: Control Head 55 Degree Troll Range - Type 4 2-5 C) Once the system has been placed in Troll Mode, movement of the Control Head’s lever 15 degrees to the Ahead or Astern detent will command Ahead or Astern clutch engagement and the trolling valve commanded to minimum pressure, while the engine RPM remains at Idle. D) Further movement through the selectable 25, 35, 45, or 55 degrees, will increase the clutch pressure to maximum while the throttle remains at Idle. E) Further movement through the next 40, 30, 20, or 10 degrees will increase throttle to full, except when 45 degrees is selected where throttle is limited to 75% of full and 55 degrees is selected where throttle is limited to 10% of full. F) To turn Troll Mode OFF, place the Station-in-Command into a detent (Neutral, Ahead, or Astern). G) Depress and hold the Transfer Button until the red indicator light on the Control Head becomes lit steady (approximately 2 seconds) then release the button. When the red indicator light is a steady red, the control system has Troll Mode OFF. TART INTERLOCK (IF USED) S The engine start signal is blocked unless all of the following are true: • DC power has been turned ON to the Control System. • A Remote Station is in command. • The Control System is commanding Neutral. (Reference Sec- tion 2-1, page 2-1) (Reference Section 2-2, page 2-1) Page 2-3 OPERATION 2-6 TATION TRANSFER S WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. Command can be transferred as follows: A) The Station-in-Command’s lever(s) may be left in any position. B) Place the Control Head’s lever(s) of the receiving Station in the Neutral/Idle detent position (refer to Figure 2-7:). C) At the Station taking command (receiving Station), depress and hold the transFigure 2-7: Remote Stations Before Transfer of Command fer button for 1/2 second (refer to Figure 2-8:). • The red LED indicator light at the receiving Station’s Control Head will illuminate, indicating that the Station has taken command. • The red LED indicator light will go OFF at the transferring Station’s Control Head, indicating that the Station Figure 2-8: Remote Station Transfer after Transfer of no longer is in command. Command D) The commanded positions of the Throttle and Clutch will remain unchanged for one second after the red LED lights. This allows the operator time to move the Control Head’s lever(s) to a position approximately matching the last Station, which will allow the vessel to maintain present speed and direction. 2-7 2-8 ROPORTIONAL PAUSE P The proportional pause provides a means of safely reversing the vessel’s direction. A variable pause is introduced into the clutch command signal to allow time for the engine RPM’s to drop to Idle and for the vessel’s speed through the water to slow. ARM-UP MODE W This feature allows the operator to increase the engine’s RPM, while the Clutch remains in Neutral. Warm-Up Mode is operational only when the Control Head lever is moved in the Ahead direction. WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. Page 2-4 OPERATION The system is placed into Warm-Up Mode as follows: A) At the Station-in-Command, ensure that the Control Head’s lever is in the Neutral detent position (refer to Figure 2-9:). B) Depress and hold the transfer button. C) After one second, move the Control Head’s lever to the Ahead detent, while continuing to hold the transfer button. Figure 2-9: Control Head Warm-Up Mode D) Now release the transfer button. •The red LED indicator light will blink slowly, indicating Warm-Up Mode is activated and the Clutch has remained at Neutral. E) The operator can start the engine, if required, and increase the RPM through the entire throttle range by moving the Control Head’s lever forward through the Figure 2-10: Control Head Normal Operating next 65 degrees. Mode F) When the Control Head’s lever is returned to the Neutral detent, the red LED will discontinue blinking and remain lit steady. After one second in Neutral, the Processor will automatically reset to normal operation with full control of the clutches and engine. G) The next movement of the Control Head’s lever will engage the Ahead or Astern clutch (Normal Operation). 2-9 IGH/LOW IDLE H The Control System provides the input to the engine, so that it may run at the standard Idle speed (typically adjusted at the governor or carburetor), or it can provide a second elevated Idle speed. 2-9.1 Low Idle 2-9.2 High Idle 2-9.3 Selecting Between High and Low Idle • The factory default setting is for Low Idle Only. • When the System is initially powered-up, it will always command Low Idle, even when High Idle is selected. • If High Idle is desired, it may be programmed during Dock Trials. • High Idle is programmable up to a maximum setting of 20% of Full Throttle. • High Idle is automatically selected when in Warm-Up Mode. WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. Page 2-5 OPERATION Refer to Figure 2-11: when selecting between Low and High Idle (or vice versa) at the Station-in-Command. A) The Control Head’s lever(s) may be in the Neutral, Ahead or Astern detents Control Head when making a selection. levers may be in Neutral, Ahead, B) Depress and hold the transfer button or Astern Detent for 1/2 second and then release. • If the System was in Low Idle it will toggle to High Idle, and vice versa. Depress and Hold Transfer Button for ½ second to toggle between High and Low Idle 10238 Figure 2-11: NOTE: High/Low Idle Mode Selection C) To return to the previous Idle setting, depress and hold the transfer button again for 1/2 second and then release. N TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, ALWAYS PROGRAM BOTH PROCESSORS FOR THE SAME AMOUNT OF HIGH IDLE. IN TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, BOTH THE PORT AND STARBOARD PROCESSORS WILL ALWAYS BE IN HIGH OR LOW IDLE AT THE SAME TIME. I 2-10 NE LEVER MODE (TWIN SCREW) O NE LEVER OPERATION MAY BE USED IN TROLL MODE OR IN NON-TROLL MODE. NOTE: O NOTE: T HE GREEN LED WILL ALWAYS BE LIT WHILE IN ONE LEVER OPERATION, NO MATTER WHAT POSITION THE MASTER CONTROL HEAD LEVER IS IN. The system supports a mode of operation referred to as One Lever Mode, which allows the operator to control both engines and clutches with a single Control Head lever. The Port or the Starboard lever at any Remote Station can be designated by the operator as the Master lever. The designation can be changed by the operator at any time. Most of the features (synchronization, troll, etc.) available in normal operation are available while operating in One Lever Mode. • The Processor defaults to One Lever Mode disabled. • One Lever Mode can be disabled or enabled in the Set Up Procedures. • When One Lever Mode is enabled, the operation must be turned ON and OFF as described below. WARNING: PERSONAL INJURY COULD OCCUR IF THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE NOT FOLLOWED EXACTLY. 2-10.1 Turning ON One Lever Operation A) At the Station-in-Command, move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to the Ahead detent. B) Depress and Hold the transfer button while moving the Port or Starboard Control Head’s lever out of the Ahead detent. until the green LED turns ON, indicating One Lever Operation is now active. Do Not Release the Transfer Button Figure 2-12: Step A) One Lever Operation Mode Page 2-6 OPERATION •The Control Head lever which the operator chose to move out of the Ahead detent, becomes the Master lever. •The Control Head lever which was left in the Ahead detent is now inactive. Figure 2-13: Step B) One Lever Operation Mode NOTE: HE CONTROL HEAD LEVER DESIGNATED BY THE OPERATOR TO BE INACTIVE IN ONE LEVER OPERATION, MAY BE LEFT IN THE AHEAD DETENT OR MOVED FULLY FORWARD. MOVING THE LEVER FULLY FORWARD IS RECOMMENDED, BECAUSE IT MOVES IT OUT OF THE WAY AND PREVENTS ACCIDENTAL BUMPS WHILE OPERATING. T 2-10.2 Turning OFF One Lever Operation A)Place the Master lever into the Neutral detent. B)Place the inactive Control Head lever into the Neutral detent. • Whenever the inactive lever is moved to the Neutral detent, One Lever operation is turned OFF. The green LED will turn OFF, indicating that the control system is now in normal operating mode. WARNING: IT IS STRONGLY RECOMMENDED THAT THE MASTER LEVER IS RETURNED TO THE NEUTRAL/IDLE POSITION PRIOR TO TURNING OFF ONE LEVER OPERATION . DO NOT ATTEMPT TO TRANSFER COMMAND FROM ONE REMOTE STATION TO ANOTHER WHILE IN ONE LEVER OPERATION. ALWAYS TURN ONE LEVER OPERATION OFF PRIOR TO TRANSFERRING. FAILURE TO OBSERVE THESE RECOMMENDATIONS MAY RESULT IN A SUDDEN CHANGE IN THE VESSEL’S DIRECTION . 2-11 ENGINE SYNCHRONIZATION (TWIN SCREW) Engine Synchronization must be selected during Set Up to have automatic synchronization. NOTE: THE CONTROL SYSTEM OFFERS TWO TYPES OF SYNCHRONIZATION, ACTIVE OR EQUAL THROTTLE. Synchronization is automatic and only operates when the Ahead clutch is engaged, consequently it can be left ON full time. When synchronization has been selected during set up, the Control System will always power-up with synchronization ON. In order for synchronization to become active and work toward synchronizing the engines' RPM's, the Synchronization Criteria described in Section 2-11.2 must be met. Page 2-7 OPERATION NOTE: THE USE OF VALUE 03 FOR FUNCTION CODE E7 SHOULD BE AVOIDED IN THE 9000 SERIES PROCESSORS WITH MECHANICAL THROTTLE CONTROL. .SYMPTOM: WHEN SELECTED, VALUE 03 (ACTIVE SYNCHRONIZATION, NO SYNCH IF TACH SIGNAL LOST) FOR FUNCTION CODE E7 (SYNCHRONIZATION) MAY GIVE THE OPERATOR THE APPEARANCE THAT SYNCHRONIZA- T HIS IS DUE TO THE FACT THAT THE CONTROL HEAD ’S GREEN SYNCH INDICATION LED DOES NOT LIGHT UNTIL BOTH ENGINE RPM’S ARE WITHIN THE “ACTIVE SYNCH DEAD-BAND”. “ACTIVE SYNCH DEADBAND” IS THE MAXIMUM ALLOWABLE DIFFERENCE IN ENGINE RPM, WHERE THE PROCESSORS CONSIDER THE SYSTEM SYNCHRONIZED ADEQUATELY. ONCE OBTAINED, THE CONTROL SYSTEM DOES NOT ATTEMPT TO MATCH THE RPM’S ANY CLOSER. WHEN IN THIS MODE OF OPERATION, THERE IS NO INDICATION TO THE OPERATOR THAT THE CONTROL HEAD LEVERS ARE MATCHED CLOSE ENOUGH TO START THE SYNCHRONIZATION PROCESS. ADDITIONALLY, THE GREEN INDICATION LED DOES NOT BLINK WHILE WORKING TOWARD SYNCHRONIZATION. C AUSE: TION IS NOT FUNCTIONING. FUNCTION CODE E7, VALUE 03, IS OPERATING AS DESIGNED. DUE TO THE IMPRECISE POSITIONING OF MECHANICAL PUSH-PULL CABLES, THE ABILITY TO POSITION THE CABLES WITHIN THE “ACTIVE SYNCH DEADBAND” IS SEVERELY IMPAIRED. SOLUTION : ALL PROCESSORS WITH MECHANICAL THROTTLE CONTROL, WHERE SYNCHRONIZATION IS DESIRED, MUST SET THE VALUE OF FUNCTION CODE E7 TO VALUE 01 (ACTIVE SYNCHRONIZATION REVERTS TO EQUAL THROTTLE SYNCHRONIZATION IF TACH SIGNAL IS LOST) 2-11.1 Synchronization Types The following types of synchronization use the same criteria, indications, and are turned ON and OFF as described in following Sections. 2-11.1.1 Equal Throttle Synchronization (Twin Screw) (default) Equal Throttle synchronization simply commands the same throttle to both engines (i.e. push-pull cables travel the same distance; electronic signals are the same). With Equal Throttle Synchronization the Processors do not receive tachometer signals representative of the engines RPM's. CAUTION: The Control System will remain synchronized as long as the Control Head's levers are in close proximity to one another. If a lever is moved to a point where the 10% throttle window is exceeded, a 10% increase or decrease in engine RPM would occur with one engine, resulting in a sudden change in the vessel's direction. NOTE: IN ORDER FOR EQUAL THROTTLE SYNCHRONIZATION TO WORK PROPERLY IN SYSTEMS WITH MECHANICAL THROTTLES, THE BENDS IN THE PUSH-PULL CABLES MUST BE KEPT TO A MINIMUM. THERE CAN BE NO BACK-LASH IN THE LINKAGE OR CABLES. BOTH GOVERNORS OR CARBURETORS MUST PROVIDE EQUAL ENGINE RPM WITH EQUAL MOVEMENT OF THEIR SELECTOR LEVERS. IF THESE CONDITIONS CAN NOT BE MET, ACTIVE SYNCHRONIZATION IS RECOMMENDED. 2-11.1.2 Active Synchronization (Twin Screw)(default Disabled) Active Synchronization must be enabled during Set Up and a Tach Sensor Wire Harness must be used. The Processors each receive a tachometer signal representing engine RPM from their respective engines. These sigPage 2-8 OPERATION nals are compared with one another over a serial communication line. If the Synchronization Criteria (described in Section 2-11.2) is met, the throttle command signal of the engine running at the higher RPM is lowered, until the RPM's of both engines match. 2-11.2 Synchronization Criteria Synchronization Criteria is met when all of the following are true: • Both Control Head levers are commanding at least 5% of the throttle range. • The commanded throttles are within a 10% window of one another (approximately 6 degrees). • Both Control Head levers are commanding Ahead clutch engagement. 2-11.3 Synchronization Indications The green LED located on the Control Head indicates the status of synchronization. • In Active Synchronization the green LED every time there is a change in the commanded throttle. • When the green LED is lit , the engines are synchronized. • When the green LED is , the engines are not synchronized and the Control System is not attempting to do so. blinks steady not lit 2-11.4 Turning Synchronization OFF: A)Ensure that the Control Head's levers are positioned to a point where Synchronization Criteria are met. B)Press and hold the transfer button until the green LED blinks and then goes out (approximately 2 seconds). C)Synchronization is now OFF. 2-11.5 Turning Synchronization ON: A)Ensure that the Control Head's levers are positioned to a point where Synchronization Criteria are met. B)Press and hold the transfer button until the green LED lights (approximately 2 seconds). •The green LED will blink as the system is working toward synchronization. •The green LED will become solid when the engines are synchronized. 2-11.6 Turning Synchronization ON and OFF when Control Head Levers are not within a 10% (6 degree) Window of One Another: The actual synchronizing of the engines occurs when the Control Head levers are within the 10% (approximately 6 degrees) window of one another. However, synchronization can be turned ON or OFF when the Control Head levers are apart more than the 10% (approximately 6 degrees) window of one another. Page 2-9 OPERATION 2-12 • When synchronization is turned ON by pressing the transfer button, the green LED will light after two seconds and stay lighted as long as the transfer button is depressed. • When turning OFF synchronization by pressing the transfer button for two seconds, the green LED will blink twice indicating that synchronization is turned OFF. ONTROL SYSTEM’S CONFIGURABILITY C The Processor is designed in a way which allows it to be easily configured by the installer to meet the varying needs of a wide variety of vessels. Below you will find a list and a brief description of the groups of these functions. 2-12.1 2-12.2 Processor Functions Within this section of adjustable parameters, there are up to five different adjustments: A0 Processor Identification - Assigns each Processor in multi-screw application a unique identifying number. This function must be the second function set during Set Up. A1 Number of Engines - Lets the Processor know how many other Processors need to be communicated with. This function must be the first function set during Set Up. A2 One Lever Operation - Allows the installer to disable or enable One Lever Mode capability. A3 Station Expander - Allows the Processor to communicate with the Station Expander (SE). A4 Neutral Indication Tone - When turned ON, produces a short 50 Hz tone to indicate Neutral. Detail information on each function is found in Section 5-6.1, page 5-8. Throttle Functions 2-12.2.1 Basic Throttle Functions This section allows the adjustment of the Throttle: E1 Throttle in Neutral - Adjusts the position of the Throttle while in Neutral E5 Throttle Pause following Shift - Allows a pause prior to applying speed above Idle. E6 High Idle - Programs a second elevated Idle RPM. E7 Synchronization - Allows the installer to select synchronization and select the type of synchronization. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.2.1, page 5-10. Page 2-10 OPERATION 2-12.2.2 Servo Throttle Functions This section along with Section 2-12.2.1 Basic Throttle Functions, page 2-10, allows the adjustment of the Servo Throttle: E0 Engine Throttle Profile - Select whether the Throttle Servo pushes or pulls to increase speed. E2 Throttle Minimum - Adjusts the position of the Throttle Servo at Idle. E3 Throttle Maximum - Adjusts the position of the Throttle Servo at Full Throttle. E4 Throttle Maximum Astern - Limits the amount of the Astern Throttle Servo movement. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.2.2, page 5-12. 2-12.2.3 Electronic Throttle Functions This section along with Section 2-11.9.3 Basic Throttle Functions, page 2-9, allows the adjustment of the Electronic Throttle: E0 Engine Throttle Profile - Selects the type of Throt- tle Command signal. E2 Throttle Minimum - Adjusts the Throttle Command signal at Idle. E3 Throttle Maximum - Adjusts the Throttle Command signal at Full Throttle. E4 Throttle Maximum Astern - Limits the amount of the Astern Throttle Command signal. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.2.1, page 5-10. 2-12.3 Clutch Functions 2-12.3.1 Basic Clutch Functions The following functions are available for all types of clutches. C0 Clutch Pressure Interlock - Selects the Clutch Pressure Interlock option. C1 Clutch Interlock Delay - Determines when the Clutch Pressure Interlock becomes active. C2 Proportional Pause - Selects between an In-Gear, Neutral, or Fixed Neutral delay. C3 Proportional Pause Time - Selects the maximum delay during a full speed reversal. C4 Proportional Pause Ratio - Determines if the Ahead and Astern reversal times are the same or if Astern is one half of Ahead. Page 2-11 OPERATION Detail information on each function is found in Section 55.3, page 5-12. 2-12.3.2 Clutch Servo Functions This section along with Section 2-12.3.1 Basic Clutch Functions, page 2-11, allows the adjustment of Clutch servo related items: C5 Clutch Servo Direction-Determines if the servo pushes or pulls for Ahead and Astern. C6 Clutch Ahead-Adjusts the amount of clutch servo travel in Ahead. C7 Clutch Astern -Adjusts the amount of clutch servo travel in Astern. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.3.1, page 5-15. 2-12.3.3 Clutch Solenoid Functions This section along with Section 2-11.10.1 Basic Clutch Functions, page 2-9, allows the adjustment of Clutch Solenoid related items: C5 Shift Solenoid Type - Selects the approximate cur- rent levels for the 12 or 24 VDC ZF Hurth Solenoids. C6 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Ahead - Fine tunes the maximum current level to the Ahead Proportional Solenoid. C7 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Astern - Fine tunes the maximum current lever to the Astern Proportional Solenoid. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.4.2, page 5-20. 2-12.4 Troll Functions 2-12.4.1 Basic Troll Functions (All Processors with Troll Function) The following functions are available for all Processors with the option of Trolling Valve Control feature. L4 Troll Throttle Limit - Allows an increase in Throttle while slipping the Clutch. L5 Troll Pulse Duration - Selects the amount of time for Troll Pulse Percentage. L6 Troll Pulse Percentage - Selects the percentage of Troll Minimum when first engaging the Clutch with Troll. Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.5, page 5-22. Page 2-12 OPERATION 2-12.4.2 Troll Servo Functions NOTE: THE FOLLOWING TROLL FUNCTIONS ARE AVAILABLE FOR THE 9001 TROLL ACTUATOR OR INTEGRATED SERVO TROLL COMMAND. The following functions are available along with Section 211.4 page 2-20 for servo Trolling Valves. L0 Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Range - Turns Troll ON (Integrated) and sets the degrees of Control Head lever movement dedicated to Troll. L1 Troll Servo Direction - Determines if the Troll push-pull cable is retracted or extended at Lock-up. L2 Troll Minimum Pressure - Adjusts the Troll pushpull cables position at minimum Shaft rotation. L3 Troll Maximum Pressure - Adjusts the Troll pushpull cable’s position at maximum Shaft rotation (not maximum pressure). Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.5.2, page 5-24. 2-12.4.3 Integrated Troll Solenoid Functions The following functions are available along with Section 211.4 page 2-20 for solenoid Trolling Valves. L0 Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Range -Turns Troll ON and sets the degrees of Control Head lever movement dedicated to Troll. L1 Troll Valve Function - Selects the proper current range for a particular gear. This Function must be the 3rd function set if ZF Hurth Gears are used. L2 Troll Minimum Pressure - Adjusts the amount of current at minimum Shaft rotation. L3 Troll Maximum Pressure - Adjusts the amount of current at maximum Shaft rotation (not maximum pressure). Detail information on each function is found in Section 56.5.4, page 5-26. 2-12.5 Troubleshooting Functions 2-12.5.1 Basic Troubleshooting Functions H0 Diagnostics - Allows the installer/technician to look at various inputs to the Processor. H1 Return to Factory Defaults - Returns all settings to the factory default values. Detail information on this function is found in Section 56.5.1, page 5-28. Page 2-13 OPERATION 2-13 AUDIBLE TONES 2-13.1 Basic Processor Tones The Processor can produce numerous tones which inform the operator of the status of the system or if any faults were to occur. These tones are emitted from all Remote Stations regardless of whether they are in command or not. 2-13.1.1 Slow Repetitive Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B Figure 2-14: . Slow Repetitive Tone This tone is normal when DC power is first applied to the System. This tone indicates that system initialization has occurred, no Remote Station has command, the operator can accept command at any Remote Station. 2-13.1.2 One Long, Three Short Tones Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-15: One Long, Three Short Tones This tone indicates that the command signal from a Control Head’s potentiometer has gone out of range. 2-13.1.3 Steady Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-16: Steady Tone This tone indicates that the software program within the Processor has quit running, due to low voltage or component failure. 2-13.1.4 Five (5) Second Steady Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-17: Five (5) Second Steady Tone This tone indicates that there has been a loss of Serial Communication. 2-13.1.5 Three (3) Second Steady Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-18: Three (3) Second Steady Tone This tone is heard if there is a stuck transfer button, or when entering Back-up Mode, or if a Troll Solenoid error occurs. (Back-up Mode and Troll Solenoid is not available for all Processors.) Page 2-14 OPERATION 2-13.1.6 Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-19: Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Tone This tone indicates that Function Code A3 Station Expander (SE) has had the value 01 Enabled entered, but the Processor and Station Expander cannot communicate. 2-13.2 Throttle (Servo 2) Tones The following Tones are in addition to the Basic Tones listed in Section 2-12.1, page 2-40. 2-13.2.1 One Long - Two Short Tones Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-3.1, page B5-7. Figure 2-20: One Long - Two Short Tones This tone indicates that the feedback potentiometer signal from Servo 2 (Throttle) has gone out of range. 2-13.2.2 One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Tone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-3.2, page B5-8. Figure 2-21: One Long - Two Short - High Repetitive Tones This tone indicates that Servo 2 (Throttle) cannot reach the commanded position. This tone is also referred to as Servo 2 Jam Tone. 2-13.3 Clutch (Servo 1) Tones The following Tones are in addition to the Basic Tones listed in Section 5-6.3.1, page 5-21 2-13.3.1 One Long - One Short Tone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-2.1, page B5-6. Figure 2-22: One Long - One Short Tone This tone indicates that the feedback potentiometer signal from Servo 1 (Clutch) has gone out of range. 2-13.3.2 One Long, One Short -High Repetitive RateTone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-2.2, page B5-6. Figure 2-23: One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone This tone indicates that Servo 1 (Clutch) cannot reach the commanded position. This tone is also referred to as Servo 1 Jam Tone. Page 2-15 OPERATION 2-13.4 Clutch Solenoid Tones 2-13.4.1 One Long - One Short Tone Detail information on this tone is in Appendix B. Figure 2-24: One Long - One Short Tone This tone indicates that a fault was detected with either the Ahead or Astern Clutch Solenoid. 2-13.5 Troll Integrated Servo (Servo 1) Tones The following Tones are in addition to the Basic Tones listed in Section 5-6.4.1, page 5-29 2-13.5.1 One Long - One Short Tone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-2.1, page B5-6. Figure 2-25: One Long - One Short Tone This tone indicates that the feedback potentiometer signal from Servo 1 (Troll) has gone out of range. 2-13.5.2 One Long, One Short -High Repetitive RateTone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-2.2, page B5-6. Figure 2-26: One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone This tone indicates that Servo 1 (Troll) cannot reach the commanded position. This tone is also referred to as Servo 1 Jam Tone. 2-13.6 Troll Integrated (Servo 2) Tones The following Tones are in addition to the Basic Tones listed in Section 2-12.1, page 2-40 2-13.6.1 One Long - Two Short Tones Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-3.1, page B5-7. Figure 2-27: One Long - Two Short Tones This tone indicates that the feedback potentiometer signal from Servo 2 (Troll) has gone out of range. 2-13.6.2 One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Tone Detail information on this tone is in Section B5-3.2, page B5-8 Figure 2-28: One Long - Two Short - High Repetitive Tones This tone indicates that Servo 2 (Troll) cannot reach the commanded position. This tone is also referred to as Servo 2 Jam Tone. Page 2-16 OPERATION 2-13.7 9001 Trolling Actuator Tones (Servo 3) The following Tones are in addition to the Basic Tones listed in Section 5-6.4.1, page 5-29. 2-13.7.1 One Long, Four Short Tones Detail information on this tone is in the Manual supplied with the 9001 Trolling Actuator. Figure 2-29: One Long - Four Short Tones This tone indicates that there is a feedback error in the Trolling Actuator. 2-13.7.2 One Long, Four Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone Detail information on this tone is in the Manual supplied with the 9001 Trolling Actuator. Figure 2-30: One Long, Four Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone This tone indicates that Trolling Actuator Servo cannot reach the commanded position. 2-13.8 Troll Integrated Solenoid Tones 2-13.8.3 Three Second Steady Tone Figure 2-31: Three Second Steady Tone This tone indicates that the Troll Solenoid is OPEN or shorted. Refer to the Error Code displayed for further information. 2-14 PUSH BUTTON SET UP There are four push buttons mounted to the Processor’s circuit board. These push buttons allow the installer/technician access to all of the Functions required for programming and troubleshooting the Processor. A full description of their usage is provided in Section 5-1.2, page 5-2. 2-15 VISUAL SYSTEM DIAGNOSTICS, SET UP AND STATUS INDICATION There are four, seven segment LED’s (hereafter referred to as the Display LED) mounted to the Processor’s circuit board. The Display LED is visible through a transparent window in the Processor’s cover. The information displayed on the Display LED is used in conjunction with the push buttons to program the Processor. The Display LED also displays Error Codes in the event that an anomaly is detected. For a full description of the Display LED, its capability and usage, refer to Section 5-1.1, page 5-2. Page 2-17 OPERATION Push Button Location LED Location 12255 Figure 2-32: Circuit Board Shield Layout 2-16 PLUGGABLE CONNECTIONS 2-16.1 Standard Pluggable Processor The standard Processor comes from the factory with five Pigtail Connectors for easy, mistake free pluggable installations. Not all Processors are supplied with all of these pigtails. The following is a list of the pigtail connectors used in the standard Processor: • Two Remote Station pigtails. Three additional Stations can be connected directly to the standard Processor. • One pigtail connector provides the connections for DC Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Pressure Interlock and External Alarm. • One pigtail connector is provided for serial communication between multiple Processors. • One pigtail connector is provided for the Tach Sensor input used in synchronization. Figure 2-33: Standard Processor Pluggable Connections View Page 2-18 OPERATION 2-16.2 ClearCommand 9000 Series Pluggable Processors The 9000 Series Processors come from the factory with standard five Pigtail Connectors listed in Section 2-15.1, page 2-48, and additional Pigtails depending on the Processor’s features. Refer below to the Processor being used on this System for the list of additional pigtails. 9120 and 9121 Processors • One pigtail connector is provided for clutch Ahead and Astern Solenoid signals. 9122 Processor • One pigtail connector is provided for clutch Ahead and Astern Solenoid signals, the troll solenoids. 9210 and 9211 Processors • One pigtail connector is provided for electronic connection to the engine governor. 9221 Processor • One pigtail connector is provided for electronic connection to the engine governor. • One pigtail connector is provided for clutch Ahead and Astern Solenoid signals. 2-17 PTIONAL FEATURES OPERATION O 2-17.1 System Failure External Alarm • This optional feature is designed to provide a status signal to an external alarm circuit. • The status signal is in the form of an open or closed contact. When the contact is closed, the Processor is functioning normally. When the contact opens, this indicates the software program has quit running due to a component failure or loss of DC power. • A full explanation is provided in Section 8-1, page 8-1. 2-17.2 Clutch Pressure Interlock • The purpose of the Clutch Pressure Interlock is to prevent high engine RPM when the Clutch is not fully engaged. • A full explanation of the Clutch Pressure Interlock is provided in Section 8-2, page 8-2. 2-17.3 Station Expander (SE) • The SE is a separate Processor housed in an enclosure that allows the connection of up to five additional Remote Control Stations. • The SE communicates with the Processor over the serial communication line. • A full explanation of the installation, operation and adjustment of the SE is provided in the Installation Manual provided with the SE. • Additional information can be found in Section 8-3, page 8-4. Page 2-19 OPERATION 2-17.4 Multiple Screw Installations This Manual, as written, is intended for Single and Twin Screw applications only. The Processor has the capability of controlling Triple, Quad and Quint Screw vessels. In order to do so, contact your ZF Mathers representative for the required information and materials. 2-17.5 9001 Mechanically Actuated Trolling Valve Control • The purpose of a Trolling Valve is to lower the Clutch pressure, which allows the Clutch Plate to slip. • A full explanation is provided in the Installation Manual provided with the 9001 Trolling Actuator. • Further information on Trolling Valve Control can be found in Section 8-4, page 8-4. Page 2-20 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3 PLAN THE INSTALLATION NOTE: ZF MATHERS RECOMMENDS THAT THE SYSTEM BE INSTALLED IN ACCORDANCE WITH ABYC, E11 AND P24. 3-1 YSTEM S EQUIREMENTS R The first step when installing a System is to carefully plan the installation. This includes finding proper mounting locations for the Processor(s) and Control Heads. The decision must be made on where power is going to be sourced and how the power will be routed to the Processor(s). Once the locations have been decided, lengths of electrical wiring, Harnesses and push-pull cables must be determined. 10.71 (272mm) 6.70 (170,2mm) 2.69 (68,3mm) 2.70 (68,6mm) 12256- 3.20 (81,3mm) 10.40 (264,2mm) 4.75 (120,7mm) 10.25 (260,4mm) Figure 3-1: Processor Dimensions • Bonding is required for maximum electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) performance. Refer to Bonding: A.B.Y.C. E-11, 46 CFR 111.05, page A-33 • Locate the Processor such that the push-pull cables have the shortest, most direct path to the selector lever. The push-pull cable length should not exceed 20 feet (6,0m), the bend radius should not be less than 10 inches (254mm) and the total degrees of bends must be less than 270 degrees. Only when the previous items have been completed, should you start the actual installation. The following sections describe the requirements for installing the components and selecting mounting locations. Page3-1 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3-1.1 Processor(s) 3-1.2 Control Head(s) Processors required per engine: Single Screw: One (1) Processor Twin Screw: Two (2) Processors Mounting Hardware is installer supplied. Installation/Troubleshooting Manual is included with the Processor. The following items must be taken into account when selecting the location for the Processor(s): • The Processor is spray proof, but not water proof. Therefore, an area must be selected that typically stays dry. • The engine room is the preferred location for mounting the Processor. • If the engine room is too small, locate in any area where it is easily accessible, as long as all of the criteria listed are met. • Bulkhead mounting is the preferred method due to ease of access for wiring and adjustments. However, the Processor can be mounted in any attitude as long as the Display LED window and push buttons are accessible. • Do not mount the Processor on the engine, transmission, or in any location that will subject it to excessive vibration. • Do not mount the Processor to the transom when the vessel is equipped with a surface piercing drive system, due to vibration concerns. • Locate the Processor(s) away from sources of high heat, such as an engine exhaust manifolds or turbochargers. Allow 4 feet (1,2m) of clearance or more. • Do not mount the Processor(s) in close proximity to gas engine ignition systems, alternators, generators or any equipment producing strong magnetic fields. Allow 4 feet (1,2m) clearance or more. CAUTION: Strong magnetic fields can influence the Processor’s electronic circuits and void your warranty. Refer to Appendix A - Control Head Variations Service Sheets for information on the various Control Heads available and their dimensions. • The 400 and MC2000 Series Control Heads are spray proof from the top, but must be protected from the weather on the underside. • The 700 Series Control Heads are fully water proof. • Control Heads are available with pluggable pigtails or may be hard-wired (no pigtails). • When a 400 or MC2000 Series Control Head must be mounted in a location where the underside may be exposed to the Page3-2 PLAN THE INSTALLATION weather, consider using a Weather Mount Enclosure. Refer to the 400 Series Weather Mount Enclosure, page A-21, for specific information. • Ensure that the clearance is sufficient for the Control Head’s lever to reach full Ahead and full Astern. • Retrofit applications may require an Adapter Pad to cover the old Control Head cutout. A variety of Adapters and Cover Pads are available. Refer to PARTS LIST, page A-1 for details. • The Control Head can be mounted at any location on the vessel, as long as all of the criteria listed above are met. 3-1.3 Standard Wire Harnesses (Refer to the PARTS LIST, page A-1) The following lists the various Harnesses that plug into the Standard Processor: 3-1.3.1 Control Head Harnesses • One Control Head Harness is required for every Control Head lever at every Remote Station. • The Control Head Harnesses are available in various lengths. • Harnesses are available with plugs on both ends or a plug on the Processor side only. • The Harness from the Port side of a Control Head is always routed to the Port Processor. • The Harness from the Starboard side of a Control Head is always routed to the Starboard Processor. 3-1.3.2 Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Pressure, Alarm Harness • One Harness required per Processor. • The Harness is plugged at one end only. • In addition to the DC power and Start Interlock, the Harness also contains cables if required: Clutch Oil Pressure Switch and External Alarm Circuit. • All of the cables in the Harness are the same length. Therefore, order a length that will reach all of the previously mentioned items, if required. • The Harness is available in lengths up to 30 feet (9,14m). 3-1.3.3 Serial Communication Harness The Serial Communication Harness is only required in Twin Screw applications or when an external trolling valve actuator (9001) is utilized. The Harness connects the Port Processor to the Starboard Processor. • One Harness required per two Processors. • The Harness is plugged at both ends. • Refer to PARTS LIST, page A-1 for available harnesses Page3-3 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3-1.3.4 Tach Sensor Harness There are two Tach Sensor Harnesses available: 1. The first is the AC Coupled Sensor Harness, which is designed for inputs from items such as Mechanical Senders, Magnetic Pickup Sensors, the Alternator AC Stator Terminal or the negative Coil Terminal. 2. The second Harness is designed for Active Sensors with an Open Collector output, such as Hall Effect Sensors. • This Harness is only required when Active Synchronization is required. • One Harness per Processor is required. • The Harness is plugged on one end only. Determine the source of the tachometer signal, which can be provided by a mechanical tachometer sender, magnetic pickup, alternator’s pre-rectified output, the negative side of the coil (gasoline engine) or an engine’s electronically produced signal. Refer to Engine Tachometer Sender Requirements, page A-37. 3-1.4 Additional Harnesses (Refer to the Parts List in Appendix A) The following lists the various Harnesses that plug into the Processor: 3-1.4.1 Throttle Harness • One Harness required per Processor. • There are 4 types of Throttle Harnesses: Voltage, Current, PWM (Pulse Width Modulation), and Frequency. • Most Throttle Harnesses are plugged at the Processor side only. • Some Throttle harness types are available with plugs on both ends. 3-1.4.2 Clutch Harness • One Harness required per Processor. • The Harness consists of 2 two-conductor cables. • The cables supply power to the Ahead and Astern Clutch Solenoids • All of the cables in the Harness are the same length. Therefore, order a length that will reach all of the previously mentioned items, if required. 3-1.4.3 Clutch/Troll Harness • One Harness required per Processor. • The Harness consists of: 2 TWO-CONDUCTOR CABLES FOR AHEAD AND ASTERN CLUTCH SOLENOIDS. Page3-4 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 2 TWO-CONDUCTOR CABLES FOR TROLL ON/OFF AND TROLL PROPORTIONAL SOLENOIDS. NOTE: SOME TRANSMISSIONS ONLY UTILIZE ONE SOLENOID FOR TROLL, THEREFORE, THE HARNESS WOULD CONSIST OF ONLY THREE CABLES. • The Power for the clutches and troll are supplied by the Processor’s power source. • All of the cables in the Harness are the same length. Therefore, order a length that will reach all of the previously mentioned items, if required. 3-1.5 Standard Electric Cables (Refer to the PARTS LIST, page A-1) The following lists the various equivalent electric cables for the basic connections to the Standard Processor: 3-1.5.1 Control Head Electric Cable If the Control Head is hard-wired (no plugs) the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Seven-conductor with shield, twisted. • Color Code – black, brown, red, orange, green, blue, and violet. • 18 AWG (nearest metric equivalent - #1). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm) 3-1.5.2 Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Pressure, Alarm Electric Cable 3-1.5.2.1 Power Electric Cable Requirements If Power is hard-wired, (no plugs) the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, black and red with violet stripe, twisted. • 14 AWG (#2,5 metric) or 12 AWG (#4 metric) may be used to crimp directly to the Processor terminals. Refer to S-214 Rev.E 5/03 Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505 in Appendix A for cable length and additional wire size requirements. • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.5.2.2 Start Interlock Electric Cable Requirements If Start Interlock is hard-wired (no plugs) the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, both yellow with red stripe, twisted. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). Page3-5 PLAN THE INSTALLATION • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.5.2.3 Clutch Pressure Interlock Electric Cable Requirements When the Clutch Pressure Interlock option is utilized, a pressure switch with a normally open contact must be installed on the transmission, along with a Shuttle Valve If the Clutch Pressure Switch is hard-wired (no plugs) the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, both light blue. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.5.2.4 External Alarm Circuit Electric Cable Requirements If the External Alarm Circuit is hard-wired (no plugs) the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, red and black, twisted. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.5.3 Serial Communication Electric Cable Requirements The Serial Communication Harness is only required in Twin Screw applications or when an external trolling actuator (9001) is utilized. The electric cable connects the Port Processor to the Starboard Processor. • Required only when hard-wiring the Processor. • Refer to PARTS LIST, page A-1. 3-1.5.4 Tach Sensor Electric Cable Requirements The cable selected depends on what type of Sensor is being used: 3-1.5.4.1 AC Tach Input • Two-conductor, twisted, shielded. • 20 AWG (#0,5 metric) • 300 V, 165 C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inches (9,9mm) 3-1.5.4.2 Open Collector (Active) • Three-conductor, twisted, shielded • 20 AWG (#0,5 metric) • 300 V, 165 C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inches (9,9mm) Page3-6 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3-1.6 Additional Electric Cables (Refer to the Parts List in Appendix A) Depending on the requirements of the installer, the installation may use Harnesses, Electric Cables or a combination of both. The various 9000 Series Processors may use all or a combination of the below listed harnesses or cables. Refer to Table PREFACE-1 Processor List located after the cover sheet of this manual to determine which harnesses are required. The following lists the various equivalent electric cables: 3-1.7 Throttle Electric Cable Requirements If Throttle is hard-wired, (no plugs) to the Processor, the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, red and black, twisted, shielded. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.8 Clutch Electric Cable Requirements If Clutch Solenoids are hard-wired, (no plugs) to the Processor, the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, red and black, twisted. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.9 Clutch/Troll Electric Cable 3-1.9.5 Clutch Solenoid Electric Cable Requirements If are hard-wired, (no plugs) to the Processor, the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, red and black, twisted. • 16 AWG (#1,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). 3-1.9.6 Troll Solenoid Electric Cable Requirments If are hard-wired, (no plugs) to the Processor, the electric cable must meet the following specifications or may be ordered from ZF Mathers: • Two-conductor, red with violet stripe and black, twisted. • 14 AWG (#2,5 metric). • 300V, 105 degrees C, UL VW1, stranded tinned copper wire. • Maximum outside diameter: 0.390 inch (9,9mm). Clutch Solenoids Troll Solenoids Page3-7 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3-1.10 Tachometer Sensors There are two types of Tachometer Sensors available through ZF Mathers, Mechanical (p/n 8902) and Magnetic Pickup (p/n 8912). Both types provide two separate outputs, one for the tachometer(s) and the second output provides the Processor’s tachometer signal requirement. If a sensor other than one supplied by ZF Mathers is used, it must meet the criteria provided below for each type: 3-1.10.1 AC Coupled Sensors • The signal must have a minimum amplitude of +/- 1.5 V (3.0 V P-P). • The signal’s maximum amplitude must not exceed +/- 100 V (200 V P-P). • The frequency of the signal must be no lower than 30 Hz at Idle. • The signal’s frequency may not exceed 8 KHz at Full Throttle. 3-1.10.2 Alternator • The pre-rectified stator AC terminal may be used as the tach source. • The signal is inputted to the AC Coupled Sensor input. • The signal must meet the same criteria as any AC Coupled Sensor Signal (refer to Section 3-1.10.1). 3-1.10.3 Point side of the Coil • When the signal is sourced from the coil or an electronically produced tach signal (used on some gasoline engines) the signal is connected to the AC Coupled Sensor input. • The signal must meet the same criteria as any AC Coupled Sensor Signal (refer to Section 3-1.10.1). 3-1.10.4 Active Sensors (Open Collector Output) • The sink current ability of the Sensor may be no lower than 2 mA. • The operational current may not exceed 50 mA. • The Sensor must have a maximum saturation voltage of 0.8 V. • An operational voltage requirement of 9- 10 VDC. • A minimum frequency of 5 Hz at Idle. • A maximum frequency of 8 KHz at Full Throttle. 3-2 INSTALLER SUPPLIED TOOLS AND PARTS 3-2.1 Required Tools Anti-static wrist strap (included with Processor). Screwdriver – medium Phillips, #2. Wire cutter, stripper & crimper (Thomas & Betts model WT-2000 or equivalent). 7/16 inch Nut Driver or Socket with ratchet & medium extension. 5/16 inch Wrench – open end. Page3-8 PLAN THE INSTALLATION Screwdriver – small straight slot. Saw with blade suitable for Console Top Panel. Drill Motor with 9/32 inch and 7/32 inch drill bits. 3-2.2 Optional Tools 3-2.3 Required Parts Calibrated Digital Multimeter (Fluke 80 Series or equivalent). Service Field Test Unit (P/N 13927, available through ZF Mathers) Field Test Control Head - Dual (P/N 14000) 3-2.3.1 Processor’s Utilizing a Servo • 33C type push-pull cables. The cables are measured from the end of the threads to the end of the threads. Available in 1 foot (0,3m) increments. (If 43C type push-pull cables are required, a 43C Conversion Kit is available from ZF Mathers. Refer to MM13821 Rev.A 8/03, page A-43) • Many engines, transmissions and inboard/outboard (I/O) drives are delivered with mounting kits. If not, contact the engine of gear dealer or manufacture for a factory Cable Connection Kit. Refer to Universal Mounting Kit, page A-41, to show other connection options. 3-2.3.2 All Remote Stations • An engine STOP switch must be located at each Remote Station. WARNING: AN ENGINE STOP SWITCH MUST BE INSTALLED AT EVERY REMOTE OPERATING STATION. REFER TO CFR 46, SECTION 62.35-5 (US COAST GUARD ) AND ABYC P24.5.8. 3-3 OWER SOURCE DC P One of the most important (and often overlooked) items for proper operation of your control system is a clean, dedicated, and reliable source of DC Power. The wiring used to supply power from the power source (battery) through the various components (fuses, distribution panel, relays, etc.) to the Processors must be sized for a voltage drop of 10% or less using 10 amps as the maximum current draw. Refer to ABYC Standard E-11, Table X to determine the appropriate wire gauge for the necessary conductor length. When using ZF Mathers supplied 14 gauge power cable, and in accordance with ABYC Standard E-11, the distance from a 12 volt power source (battery or DC Distribution Panel) shall not exceed 15 feet (4,6m). In 24 volt systems, the maximum cable length is 20 feet (6,1m). It is recommended by ZF Mathers that an Automatic Power Selector (APS) and a second power source (battery) be used. Refer to Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505, page A-25 for examples of power supplies. Page3-9 PLAN THE INSTALLATION 3-3.1 Processor Power The items listed below will help ensure optimum performance from your control system. • The Processor requires a battery source of 12 or 24 VDC. • Two 5 ampere (when isolated power supplies are required) or one 10 ampere trip-free thermal circuit breaker(s) with manual On/ Off actuation • The use of an APS (Automatic Power Selector) is strongly recommended. • Power should come from the vessel’s DC Distribution Panel. • Do not use engine starting batteries on a 12 VDC system, unless an APS is installed. • The cables feeding power from the battery to the Processor must be sized large enough to keep voltage drop, due to current flow, below 10%. See Reference Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505, page A-25. The Processor’s power cable(s) maximum lengths are listed in PARTS LIST, page A-1 and examples of the various wiring options are shown in Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505, page A-25. Ultimately, it is the boat builder or installer’s responsibility to ensure that the vessel’s wiring meets the requirements of American Boating & Yachting Councel standard E-11, for AC and DC Electrical Systems on Boats. Page3-10 INSTALLATION 4 INSTALLATION NOTE: EFORE STARTING THE ACTUAL INSTALLATION OF THE CONTROL SYSTEM, MAKE SURE YOU HAVE THE CORRECT PARTS AND TOOLS ON HAND. SEE SECTION 3. READ ALL THE INSTRUCTIONS PERTINENT TO EACH PART BEFORE BEGINNING THE INSTALLATION OF THE PART. B CAUTION: Static electricity can destroy electronic components. Connect the wrist strap provided, to the Processor frame whenever working on the Processor with the enclosure cover open. This will drain any static charge you may have on your person. 4-1 PROCESSOR 4-2 C A) Secure the Processor to the mounting surface with three 1/4 inch or M6 fasteners, leaving the fourth fastener unused at this time. B) Connect the Processor to the Hull or Bonding Bus by running a 12 AWG or larger wire between the Processor’s fourth mounting fastener and the Bonding Bus. (The Processor is bonded if mounted directly to a metallic surface that is connected to a metal hull) (Refer to Bonding: A.B.Y.C. E-11, 46 CFR 111.05, page A-33) ONTROL HEAD(S) 4-2.1 400, MC2000 and 700 Series Control Heads Refer to the appropriate Control Head Dimensions and Variations Service Sheet in Appendix A for installation. 4-2.2 500 Series Control Heads Refer to the Installation Manual supplied with the 500 Series Control Head Assembly for installation instructions. 4-2.3 Handheld Remote Controls Refer to the Installation Manual supplied with the Handheld Remote for installation instructions. 4-3 IRE HARNESS INSTALLATION W The standard Off-the-Shelf Processor has five Pigtails with plugs on the ends. Two of the plugs are for Remote Stations and one each for Power/ Start Interlock, Serial Communication, and Tach Sensor. Additional Harnesses required will depend on the actual installation. Four different styles of plugs are utilized but are inserted in an identical fashion as follows: 4-3.1 Plug Insertion and Extraction A) Prior to inserting the plug, pay close attention to the number of pins and the keying of the plug. The plug is designed to be inserted one way only, but can be forced together in the opposite orientation. Refer to Figure 4-1: to insert plug correctly. Processor Pigtail Figure 4-1: Harness Connector Harness Plug Keying Page4-1 INSTALLATION B) When connecting the plugs, ensure that the locking mechanisms are depressed and held until the plug is fully connected or disconnected. Refer to Figure 4-2: Figure 4-2: Harness Plug Locking Mechanisms 4-3.2 Standard Power/Start Interlock Harness The Power Harness has a minimum of two cables (DC Power and Start Interlock) and may have two more optional cables (Clutch Pressure Interlock and External Alarm Circuit). 4-3.2.1 DC Power Cable (Refer to Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505, page A-25) A) Insert the black, twelve pin plug into the Processor’s Power/Start Interlock Pigtail’s Socket. B) Run the cable to the DC Distribution Panel or the optional Power Relay. C) Strip back the appropriate amount of PVC jacketing and conductor insulation. D) Crimp the appropriate connectors to the conductors. E) Terminate the conductors to the DC Power Source. 4-3.2.2 Start Interlock Cable Figure 4-3: Start Interlock Connections A) Run the cable to the Engine’s Starter Solenoid. B) Disconnect the Starter Switch wire from the Solenoid. C) Strip back the appropriate amount of PVC jacketing and conductor insulation. D) Connect one of the conductors to the Solenoid’s Starter Switch terminal. E) Butt splice the second wire to Starter Switch wire. 4-3.2.3 External Alarm Circuit Cable (optional) Refer to Section 8-1, page 8-1, for installation information. 4-3.2.4 Clutch Pressure Switch Cable (optional) Refer to Section 8-2, page 8-2, for installation information. 4-3.3 Standard Control Head Harness Depending on whether a pluggable or hard-wired (not pluggable) Control Head(s) is selected, will determine the procedure for terminating the Harness at the Remote Station. Page4-2 INSTALLATION • The first installation procedure (Section 4-3.3.1) below is written for the pluggable Control Head. • If a hard-wired Control Head(s) is selected, follow the information provided in the second procedure (Section 4-3.3.2, page 4-3) : NOTE: OR TWIN SCREW, DUAL LEVER CONTROL HEADS MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE SAME NUMBERED STATION ON BOTH PROCESSORS. F 4-3.3.1 4-3.3.2 Control Head Harness with Two Connectors A) At the Port Processor, insert the grey, eight pin plug into the Station 1 pigtail plug. B) Run the cable to the Control Head located at Station 1. C) Insert the grey, eight pin plug into the Control Head’s Port pigtail plug. D) Ensure that the cable has a strain relief close to the Control Head to relieve the strain on the connections. E) Repeat Steps A) thru D) for the Starboard Processor. F) Repeat Steps A) thru E) with Station 2. G) When Stations 3, 4 and 5 are to be installed, they each require the removal of the watertight seal located on the Processor enclosure in the Station cable entry holes. Control Head Harness with One Plug A) At the Port Processor, insert the grey, eight pin plug into the Station 1 pigtail plug. B) Run the cable to the Port side of the Control Head located at Station 1. C) Connect the conductors to the Control Head as described in the appropriate Control Head Dimensions and Variations Service Sheet in Appendix A. D) Provide a strain relief in close proximity to the Control Head’s terminal block. E) Repeat Steps A) thru D) for the Starboard Processor. F) Repeat steps A) thru E) with Station 2. G) When Stations 3, 4 and 5 are to be installed, they each require the removal of the watertight seal located on the Processor enclosure in the Station cable entry holes. 4-3.4 Serial Communication Harness (Twin Screw only) A) At the Processors, remove the watertight seals from the Serial pigtail plugs. B) At the Port Processor, insert the grey, six pin plug into the Serial pigtail plug. C) Run the cable to the Starboard Processor. D) At the Starboard Processor, insert the grey, six pin plug into the Serial pigtail plug. Page4-3 INSTALLATION 4-3.5 Tach Sensor Harness (required for Active Synchronization) A) At the Processors, remove the watertight seals from the Tach Sender pigtail plugs. B) At the Port Processor, insert the grey, four pin plug into the Tach Sender pigtail plug. C) Run the cable to the source of the Tach signal. D) Connect the conductors to the Tach source in the appropriate manner, keeping in mind that some sources are polarity sensitive. (black- negative, red- positive) E) Repeat steps A) thru C) on the Starboard side. CAUTION: Electro-static discharge can damage this equipment. Whenever the Cover is removed, you must be grounded to the chassis with the Anti-static Wrist Strap provided. Failure to do so may cause permanent damage to the electronic circuits. 4-3.6 Additional 9000 Series Harnesses 4-3.6.1 4-3.6.2 NOTE: Throttle Harness The appropriate Throttle Harness should have been selected in Section 3-1.4.1, page 3-6. The Processors Throttle pigtail connects directly to the engine interface using this Throttle Wire Harness. A) Connect the plug end of the Harness into the Throttle pigtail connector at the Processor. B) Run the cable to the engine interface. C) Refer to the engine documentation for termination points at the engine interface. D) If Twin Screw, repeat steps A) thru C) on the opposite side. Clutch Harness NSURE PORT PROCESSOR CONNECTS TO THE PORT SOLENOID AND THE STARBOARD PROCESSOR CONNECTS TO THE STARBOARD PROCESSOR. E A) Plug the grey, 12 pin plug into the Clutch pigtail connector at the Processor. B) Run the cables to the Ahead and Astern solenoids at the transmission. C) Plug the DIN connector into the Ahead and Astern Solenoids. D) If Twin Screw, repeat steps A) thru C) on the opposite side. 4-3.6.3 NOTE: Clutch/Troll Harness NSURE PORT PROCESSOR CONNECTS TO THE PORT SOLENOID AND THE STARBOARD PROCESSOR CONNECTS TO THE STARBOARD PROCESSOR. E A) Plug the grey, 12 pin plug into the Clutch pigtail connector at the Processor. Page4-4 INSTALLATION 4-4 B) Run the cables to the transmission. C) Plug the DIN connector into the Ahead and Astern Solenoids. D) Plug the DIN connector into the Troll proportional solenoid, and if installed the Troll ON/OFF solenoid. E) If Twin Screw, repeat steps A) thru D) on the opposite side. HARD-WIRED CABLE 4-4.1 Liquid Tight Connector Processor Enclosure Securing Nut Cable Body Nut Grommet All cables that enter the Enclosure must go through a Liquid Tight Connector in order to maintain the moisture resistant integrity of the Processor. These connectors must be assembled as shown in Figure 4-4: 12278 Figure 4-4: Liquid Tight Installation 4-4.2 Figure 4-5: Standard Processor Cable Holes When hard-wiring a Processor or installing additional Station pigtails, the cables must enter the enclosure through Liquid Tight Connectors in the appropriate holes as shown in Figure 4-5:. Standard Enclosure Cable Holes 4-4.3 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Station 5 Station 3 Station 1 Alarm, Clutch Pressure, and Start Interlock Power Station 4 Station 2 Serial Communication Tachometer Standard Circuit Board Connections On a Standard Processor, in lieu of using Harnesses for Control Heads, Power, Serial Communication and Tachometer, the Processor can be ordered with no pigtails installed. The above connections then must be hard-wired directly to the circuit board On Standard Processors using pigtails, additional Stations may also be connected to the Processor by connecting pigtails or hardwiring directly to the circuit board. Refer to Figure 4-6: for specific termination points. Page4-5 1 SOLENOIDS INSTALLATION PB2 RED (START INTERLOCK) YELLOW (START INTERLOCK) 1 2 START 5 6 7 TB11 3 8 8 ALARM VIOLET BLUE GREEN BLACK POWER RED + PB1 6 J3 7 STATION 1 1 OPI 2 ALARM, CLUTCH PRESSURE, AND START INTERLOCK 4 POWER IN BROWN (ALARM -) BLACK (ALARM +) GREEN (CLU TCH PRES SURE -) BLUE (CLUTCH PRES SURE +) ORANGE (GROUND) WHITE (BACKUP INPUT) 5 4. 6 5. TB6 7 4 8 3 2 INTER LO CK 1 4 AUTOTR OLL 1 2 3 2 CLUTCH 3 4 TB1 STATION 1 TB2 5 ORANGE RED BROWN BLACK UP 5 P2 BLACK BROWN RED ORANGE LEFT 7 8 STATION 3 7 6 STATION 2 R IGH T 8 3. 6 TB3 VIOLET BLUE GREEN GREEN BLUE VIOLET STATION 2 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 D S4 BLACK 1 3 2 TB10 P1 1 STATION 5 5. 8. 9. RED 6. DIGITAL INPUT S 12284-2 TACHOMETER SERIAL COMMUNICATION Figure 4-6: Standard Circuit Board Hard-Wired Termination Points Station 5: TB5 Black - 1, 4. Alarm: TB6 Station 3: TB3 Brown - 2, Red - 3, Station 1: TB1 Station 4: TB4 Orange - 4, Clutch Pressure: TB6 Station 2: TB2 Green - 6 Blue - 7 Violet - 8 Start Interlock: PB2 Power In: PB1 Black - Negative Red - Positive Ground: TB6 Serial Communication: TB7 White - 6 Backup Input: TB6 Green - 7 Red - 8 Black - 9 Drain - 10 Tachometer: TB9 Red - 1 Green - 2 Black - 4 4-4.4 STATION 4 3 2 TB5 8. 1. 2. 3. 6. 7. GREEN BLUE VIOLET 4 GREEN 8 TB9 P3 DS3 7 D S2 2 3 TB7 D S1 TACH 4 DRAIN B LA CK R ED GREEN WHITE 1 SERIAL 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 6 1. JMP1 1 2 7 STATION 5 ORANGE RED BROWN BLACK STATION 4 8 2. 7. BLACK BROWN RED ORANGE 4 1 3 4 5 6 7 TB8 2 ELEC-THR 3 STATION 3 VIOLET BLUE GREEN P4 THROTTLE D OWN TB4 J1 4 ORANGE RED BROWN BLACK 9. Brown - 6 Black - 5 Green - 4 Blue - 3 Red - 1 Yellow - 2 Orange - 2 White - 1 9000 Series Hard-Wired Connection Locations ZF Mathers ENGINE CLUTCH TROLL Processor Part No. Electronic Solenoid Solenoid 9120 (Figure 4-7:) 9121 (Figure 4-7:) 9122 (Figure 4-8:) 9210 (Figure 4-9:) 9211 (Figure 4-9:) 9221 (Figure 4-10:) 12 12 12 10 10 10 10 11 Table 4-1: ClearCommand Processor Optional Hard-Wiring Cable List Page4-6 INSTALLATION All cables that enter the Enclosure must go through a Liquid Tight Connector in order to maintain the moisture resistant integrity of the Processor. These connectors must be assembled as shown in Figure 4-4:, page 4-10. When hard-wiring a Processor or installing additional Station pigtails, the cables must enter the enclosure through Liquid Tight Connectors in the appropriate holes. Refer to the appropriate Section for the Cable Hole designations for the Processor being used on this application. 4-4.4.1 9120 and 9121 (Clutch Solenoid) Cable Hole Locations 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Station 5 Station 3 Station 1 Alarm, Clutch Pressure, and Start Interlock Power Station 4 Station 2 Serial Communication Tachometer 10. Clutch Solenoids Figure 4-7: 9120 and 9121 Enclosure Cable Holes 4-4.4.2 9122 (Clutch/Troll Solenoid) Cable Hole Locations 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Station 5 Station 3 Station 1 Alarm, Clutch Pressure, and Start Interlock Power Station 4 Station 2 Serial Communication Tachometer 10. Clutch Solenoid 11. Troll Solenoid Figure 4-8: 9122 Enclosure Cable Holes 4-4.4.3 9210 and 9211 (Throttle Electronic) Cable Hole Locations 1. Station 5 2. Station 3 3. Station 1 4. Alarm, Clutch Pressure, and Start Interlock 5. Power 6. Station 4 7. Station 2 8. Serial Communication 9. Tachometer 10. Not Used 11. Not Used 12. Throttle Signal Figure 4-9: 9210 and 9211 Enclosure Cable Holes Page4-7 INSTALLATION 4-4.4.4 9221 (Throttle Electronic and Clutch Solenoid) Cable Hole Locations 1. Station 5 2. Station 3 3. Station 1 4. Alarm, Clutch Pressure, and Start Interlock 5. Power 6. Station 4 7. Station 2 8. Serial Communication 9. Tachometer 11. Not Used 10. Clutch Solenoids Figure 4-10: 9221 Enclosure Cable Holes 4-4.5 1 2279 12. Throttle Signal 9000 Series Circuit Board Termination Points On the 9000 Series Processors, in lieu of using Harnesses for engine, clutch, or troll connections the Processors can be ordered with no pigtails installed or the pigtails be removed. The above connections must then be hard-wired directly to the circuit board. Refer to Table 4-1: for the Processor being used in this application. Locations 1 - 9 circuit board termination points are the same for all Processors and are shown on Figure 4-6:, page 4-11. Refer to Figure 4-6:, page 4-6, for specific termination points for the engine, clutch or troll connections required for the Processor being used in this application. Figure 4-11: 9000 Series Circuit Board Hard-Wired Termination Points Page4-8 INSTALLATION 12. Throttle: TB8 Brown - 3, 10 Clutch: TB11 Black - 1 Red - 4, Brown Orange - 5, Yellow - 5 - 2 White - 6, Green - 6 Black - 7 10 & 11. Clutch/Troll: TB11 Black - 1 Brown - 2 Red - 3 Orange - 4 Yellow - 5 Green - 6 Blue - 7 White - 8 4-4.6 Locations 1 - 9 Installation 4-4.6.1 Seven-Conductor Control Head Cable (Locations 1, 2, 3, 6, and 7) A) Run the seven-conductor cable from the Remote Station to the Processor. B) Support the cables using clamps or straps not more than 18 inches (0,5m) apart if not contained in a conduit. Verify cable location protects the cable from physical damage. C) Label each seven-conductor cable at both ends with the station it connects, and Port or Starboard. D) Place on your wrist the anti-static wrist strap provided, attach the strap to ground, and then remove the cover from the Processor. E) Run the seven-conductor cable for each remote station through the corresponding liquid tight cable grip on the Processor to the appropriate Station terminal block. Do not tighten cable grip at this time. F) Strip the PVC jacket and shielding back approximately 4 1/2 inches (114,3mm) on the seven-conductor cable. G) Strip the wire 3/8 inch (9,5mm) on each lead. H) Pull the Shield wire back against the PVC jacket and slide and shrink a piece of 3/8 inch W. X 1 inch L. heatshrink over the cable as shown in Figure 4-12: . Figure 4-12: Seven-Conductor Control Head Cable Shield Wire and Heat-Shrink I) Secure the seven-conductor cable to the frame using a conductive Clamp. Ensure that the Clamp and Shield wire come in contact with one another. Refer to Figure 4-13:. Top View Side View (CLAMP) (FRAME) (CLAMP) Figure 4-13: Clamp Views Page4-9 (FRAME) 12266A INSTALLATION J) Clip the Shield wire so that it is flush with the Clamp. K) Connect the conductors to the appropriate pins as shown on Table 4-2:, using a small slotted screwdriver as shown in Figure 4-14: 12261 Figure 4-14: Terminal Strip Cable Connections L) Connect the other station's seven-conductor cables to the appropriate station terminal strips in the same way. Table 4-2: Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Remote Stations Conductor Color Black Brown Red Orange Green Blue Violet Processor Termination Station 1 thru 5, Pin 1 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 2 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 3 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 4 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 6 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 7 Station 1 thru 5, Pin 8 4-4.6.2 Left Hand Control Head Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 6 Pin 5 N/C Jumper between Pins 3 and 7. Right Hand Control Head Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 6 Pin 7 Pin 8 Jumper between Pins 3 and 5. Start Interlock Cable (Location 4) 4-4.6.2.1 Connection at the Starter Solenoid A) Run the length of two-conductor cable between the Engine’s Starter Solenoid and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Starter Switch wire from the Solenoid. C) Strip back the appropriate amount of PVC jacketing and conductor insulation. D) Connect one of the conductors to the Solenoid’s Starter Switch terminal. E) Butt splice the second wire to Starter Switch wire. 4-4.6.2.2 Connection at the Processor A) Install a liquid tight connector into entry hole (No. 4). ( .) B) Run enough of the two-conductor power cable through the liquid tight cable grip so that it can Refer to Figure 4-5:, page 4-10, for entry hole location and Figure 4-4:, page 4- 10, for cable grip installation Page4-10 INSTALLATION be routed to PB2 on the Circuit Board as shown in Figure 4-11:, page 4-14. C) Strip back 2 inches (50,8mm) of the PVC jacketing. Refer to Figure 4-15: D) Strip each wire 3/8-inch (9,5mm). E) Place a 3/8 inch (9,5mm) section of shrink tubing over the cable and heat. Figure 4-15: Two-Conductor Start Interlock Cable F) Crimp fork or ring terminals to the wires. G) Connect the two-conductor cable to PB2, red lead to the terminal labeled (1) and yellow lead to the terminal labeled (2), as indicated on Figure 4-6:, page 4-11. H) Tie wrap the start interlock cable to the Processor’s frame. 4-4.6.3 Power Cable (Location 5) A) Run the length of two-conductor power cable between the DC Power Source and the Processor. B) Make the connections at the vessel’s DC Power Source, but do not turn power ON. C) Install a liquid tight connector into the DC POWER entry hole (No. 5). (Refer to Figure 4-5:, page 4-10, for entry hole location and Figure 4-4:, page 4-10, for cable grip installation.) D) Run enough of the two-conductor power cable through the liquid tight cable grip so that it can be routed as shown in Figure 4-6:, page 4-11. E) Strip back 3 inches (76,2mm) of the PVC jacketing. Refer to Figure 4-16: F) Strip each wire 3/8-inch (9,5mm). G) Place a 3/8 inch (9,5mm) section of shrink tubing over the cable and heat. 3/8 inch (9,5mm) 3 inches (76,2mm) Heat Shrink Figure 4-16: Two-Conductor Power Cable H) Crimp fork or ring terminals to the wires. Page4-11 INSTALLATION I) Connect the two-conductor cable to PB1, red lead to the terminal labeled (+) and black lead to the terminal labeled (-), as indicated on Figure 4-11:, page 4-14. J) Tie wrap the power cable to the Processor’s frame. 4-4.6.4 Serial Communication Cable (Location 8) A) Install 1/2 inch (12,7mm) liquid tight cable grips into hole (No.8) of the Port and Starboard Processors. (Refer to Figure 4-5:, page 4-10, for entry hole location and Figure 4-4:, page 4-10, for cable grip installation.) B) Run a four-conductor, shielded cable from the Port to the Starboard Processors. C) Strip back 3 inches (76,2mm) of PVC jacketing from both ends of the cable. D) Strip each wire 3/8 inch (9,5mm). E) Clip the drain wire flush with the PVC jacketing on the Starboard Processor only. F) Place a 1 inch (25,4mm) section of shrink tubing over each end of the cable G) On the Port end of the cable, bend the drain wire back and tuck it under the shrink tubing so that the drain wire end is exposed past the shrink tubing. (Refer to Figure 4-17:) PORT PROCESSOR 3/8 inch (9,53mm) 3 inches (76,2mm) 1 inch (25,4mm) STARBOARD PROCESSOR Drain Wire Heat Shrink 1 inch (25,4mm) 3 inches (76,2mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) Clip Drain Wire Figure 4-17: Four-Conductor Serial Communication Cable H) Shrink the Tubing with a heat gun. I) Insert the four-conductor cable through the liquid tight connectors and tighten the nuts J) Secure the cables internally using a Clamp as shown in Figure 4-13:, page 4-9. Make certain that the drain wire makes contact with the Clamp’s metallic surface. K) Clip the exposed drain wires flush with the Clamps. L) Connect the conductors to the terminal block as listed in Table 4-3: Table 4-3: Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Serial Communication PORT PROCESSOR Termination A STARBOARD PROCESSOR Termination B Conductor Color TB7-6 White TB7-6 TB7-7 Green TB7-7 TB7-8 Red TB7-8 Page4-12 INSTALLATION Table 4-3: Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Serial Communication TB7-9 Clamp PORT PROCESSOR Termination A STARBOARD PROCESSOR Termination B Conductor Color Black Silver (Drain Wire) TB7-9 No Connection 4-4.6.5 Tachometer Cable (Location 9) A) Run a two- or three-conductor shielded cable from the Port Processor to the Port engine’s tachometer source. (Refer to Section 3-1.5, page 3-6) NOTE: HREE-CONDUCTOR CABLE IS REQUIRED WITH OPEN COLLECTOR TYPE (HALL EFFECT) TACHOMETER SENDERS ONLY. T B) Run a two- or three-conductor shielded cable from the Starboard Processor to the Starboard engine’s tachometer source. C) Install a 1/2 inch (12,7mm) liquid tight cable grip into hole (No. 9) of the Port and Starboard Processors. (Refer to Figure 4-5:, page 4-10, for entry hole location and Figure 4-4:, page 4-10, for cable grip installation) D) Strip back 2 inches (50,8mm) of PVC jacketing from both ends of the cable. E) Strip the ends of each conductor back 3/8 inch (9,5mm). F) Clip off the drain wire flush with the PVC jacketing at the Tachometer source side only. G) Place a 7/8 inch (22,23mm) section of shrink tubing over each end of the cable. H) At the Processor side, bend the drain wire back and tuck it under the shrink tubing so that the grain wire end is exposed past the shrink tubing. (Refer to Figure 418: and Figure 4-19:). . PROCESSOR 3/8 inch (9,53mm) 3.5 inches (88,9mm) 1 inch (25,4mm) TACHOMETER SENDER Wrapped Drain Wire Heat Shrink 1 inch (25,4mm) 3.5 inches (88,9mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) Clip Drain Wire Figure 4-18: AC Type Tachometer Cable PROCESSOR 3/8 inch (9,53mm) 3.5 inches (88,9mm) 1 inch (25,4mm) TACHOMETER SENDER Wrapped Drain Wire Heat Shrink 1 inch (25,4mm) Clip Drain Wire Figure 4-19: Open Collector Tachometer Cable I) Shrink the tubing with a heat gun. Page4-13 3.5 inches (88,9mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) INSTALLATION J) Insert the cable ends through the liquid tight connectors and tighten the nuts. K) Secure the cables internally using a Clamp as shown in Figure 4-13:, page 4-9. Make certain that the drain wire makes contact with the Clamp’s metallic surface. L) Clip the exposed drain wires flush with the Clamps. M)Connect the conductors to the terminal block as listed in Table 4-4:. Table 4-4: Processor Circuit Board Terminal Strip Color Coded Connections for Tachometer Termination Conductor Color TB9-1 Red TB9-2 Green TB9-3 Green TB9-4 Black Clamp Silver 4-4.7 Description Notes Sensor Supply (+9VDC) Required when Open Collector (i.e., Hall Effect Sensors) only AC Type Tachometer Input The green wire connects here when AC Type Tach Sensors (i.e., Mechanical Senders, Magnetic Pickup, Alternator AC, etc.) are being used. Open Collector Tachometer The green wire connects here when an Open ColInput lector Type Tach Sender is used. Return for Tachometer Negative connection for both types of Senders. Input Drain wire (Shield) connec- Connection made at Processor side only. tion. Locations 10 and 11 Installation 4-4.7.1 Clutch Cable (Location 10) A single four-conductor cable must connect the two Shift cables to the Processor through a 12 pin plug. 4-4.7.1.1 Processor Termination A) Install a liquid tight connector into hole no.10. B) Run a 32 inch (0,82m) piece of four-conductor cable through the liquid tight connector and tighten, leaving 16 inches (0,41m) outside of the Processor. C) Strip back 4 inches (101,6mm) of the PVC jacket inside the Processor. D) Slide a 1 inch (24,5mm) piece of heat shrink over the end of the cable as shown in Figure 4-20:. 1 inch (25,4mm) 4 inches (101,6mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) Heat Shrink Figure 4-20: Clutch Cable Heat Shrink in Processor E) Strip back 3/8 inch (9,53mm) from the four conductors and connect to the Processor as shown in Table 4-5:., page 4-15 Page4-14 INSTALLATION 4-4.7.1.2 Plug Termination A) Strip back 2 1/4 inches (57,15mm) of PVC jacketing. Figure 4-21: Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections B) C) D) E) F) G) Slide the boot onto the cable. Strip back 1/4 inch (6,35mm) from the four conductors. Crimp Pins onto the eight conductors. Insert the pins into the appropriate terminations as shown in Table 4-5:. Slide the boot over the connector. Tie-wrap the boot in place. Table 4-5: Clutch Termination Table Description Ahead Clutch Solenoid (+) Ahead Clutch Solenoid (-) Astern Clutch Solenoid (+) Astern Clutch Solenoid (-) Conductor Color Brown Green Black Yellow 4-4.7.2 Processor Termination TB11-2 TB11-6 TB11-1 TB11-5 Plug Termination Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Clutch/Troll Cable (Location 10 & 11) A single eight-conductor cable must connect the two Shift and two Troll cables to the Processor through a 12 pin plug. 4-4.7.2.3 Processor Termination A) Install a liquid tight connector into hole no.10. B) Run a 32 inch (0,82m) piece of eight-conductor cable through the liquid tight connector and tighten, leaving 16 inches (0,41m) outside of the Processor. C) Strip back 4 inches (101,6mm) of the PVC jacket inside the Processor. D) Slide a 1 inch (24,5mm) piece of heat shrink over the end of the cable as shown in Figure X. 1 inch (25,4mm) 4 inches (101,6mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) Heat Shrink Figure 4-22: Clutch/Troll Cable Heat Shrink in Processor E) Strip back 3/8 inch (9,53mm) from the eight conductors and connect to the Processor as shown in the Table 4-6:. Page4-15 INSTALLATION 4-4.7.2.4 Plug Termination A) Strip back 2 1/4 inches (57,15mm) of PVC jacketing. Figure 4-23: Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections B) C) D) E) F) G) Table 4-6: Clutch/Troll Termination Table Description Ahead Clutch Solenoid (+) Ahead Clutch Solenoid (-) Astern Clutch Solenoid (+) Astern Clutch Solenoid (-) Troll On/Off Solenoid (+) Troll On/Off Solenoid (-) Troll Proportional Solenoid (+) Troll Proportional Solenoid (-) 4-4.8 Slide the boot onto the cable. Strip back 1/4 inch (6,35mm) from the eight conductors. Crimp Pins onto the eight conductors. Insert the pins into the appropriate terminations as shown in Table 4-6:. Slide the boot over the connector. Tie-wrap the boot in place. Conductor Color Processor Termination Brown Green Black Yellow Orange White Red Blue TB11-2 TB11-6 TB11-1 TB11-5 TB11-4 TB11-8 TB11-3 TB11-7 Plug Termination Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Pin 9 Pin 10 Pin 11 Pin 12 Locations 10 Installation 4-4.8.1 Clutch Cable (Location 10) A single four-conductor cable must connect the two Shift cables to the Processor through a 12 pin plug. 4-4.8.1.1 Processor Termination A) Install a liquid tight connector into hole no.10. B) Run a 32 inch (0,82m) piece of four-conductor cable through the liquid tight connector and tighten, leaving 16 inches (0,41m) outside of the Processor. C) Strip back 4 inches (101,6mm) of the PVC jacket inside the Processor. Page4-16 INSTALLATION D) Slide a 1 inch (24,5mm) piece of heat shrink over the end of the cable as shown in Figure 4-20:. 4 inches (101,6mm) 1 inch (25,4mm) 3/8 inch (9,53mm) Heat Shrink Figure 4-24: Clutch Cable Heat Shrink in Processor E) Strip back 3/8 inch (9,53mm) from the four conductors and connect to the Processor as shown in Table 4-5:., page 4-15 4-4.8.1.2 Plug Termination A) Strip back 2 1/4 inches (57,15mm) of PVC jacketing. Figure 4-25: Clutch Cable Plug Termination Connections B) C) D) E) F) G) Table 4-7: Clutch Termination Table Description Ahead Clutch Solenoid (+) Ahead Clutch Solenoid (-) Astern Clutch Solenoid (+) Astern Clutch Solenoid (-) 4-4.9 Slide the boot onto the cable. Strip back 1/4 inch (6,35mm) from the four conductors. Crimp Pins onto the eight conductors. Insert the pins into the appropriate terminations as shown in Table 4-5:. Slide the boot over the connector. Tie-wrap the boot in place. Conductor Color Brown Green Black Yellow Processor Termination TB11-2 TB11-6 TB11-1 TB11-5 Plug Termination Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Location 12 Installation 4-4.9.1 Throttle Cable (Location 12) A 2-conductor shielded cable is required when hard-wiring the engine to the Processor. A) Install a 1/2 inch Liquid Tight Connector into hole no.12 of the Processor. B) Run the throttle cable through the connector so that 4 inches (101,6mm) of the cable is pulled through. C) Tighten the Liquid Tight Connector nut. Page4-17 INSTALLATION D) Strip back the PVC jacket to within 1/2 inch (12,7mm) of the enclosure. E) Clip the shield wire to 3/4 inch (19,1mm) of length. F) Pull back the shield wire and solder to a 2 1/2 inch (63,5mm), 18 AWG, green/yellow wire as shown in Figure 4-26:. Heat Shrink .75 inch (19,1mm) of Cable Shield Cable Solder Wire to Shield 12286 .38 2.5 inch (63,5mm) of inch (9,65mm) 18 AWG, Green/Yellow Wire Figure 4-26: Engine Shield G) Slide a 1 inch (25,4mm) section of heat-shrink over the soldered connection and shrink. H) The termination point on TB8 depends on the type of engine to which the Processor is interfacing. The following table lists the termination points. Table 4-8: Throttle Termination Table Throttle Type DC Voltage (0 to 5.0 VDC) Current (4.0 to 20.0 mA.) PWM (0 to 99%) Frequency ( Idle Validation 4-5 Termination Signal- TB8-5, Return- TB8-7 Signal- TB8-4, Return- TB8-7 Signal- TB8-3, Return- TB8-7 Signal- TB8-6, Return- TB8-8 (+)- TB8-1, (-)- TB8-2 NGINE STOP SWITCHES E An engine stop switch(s) must be located at all Remote Stations and capable of stopping the engine at any RPM. Refer to the installation instruction supplied with the switch and the engine installation instructions for manufactures recommendations. WARNING: AN ENGINE STOP SWITCH AT EACH REMOTE STATION IS AN ABSOLUTE REQUIREMENT. REFER TO CFR 46, SEC. 62.35-5 AND ABYC P-24.5.8. 4-6 USH-PULL CABLE CONNECTIONS P 4-6.1 Processor A) Remove the #10-32 jam nut and the two rubber seals from the end of each push-pull cable that is to connect to the Processor(s) only; discard the seals, but save the nuts. Page4-18 INSTALLATION B) Remove one screw from each Cable Anchor Clip and loosen the other screw. Swing the two Clips clear. Refer to Figure 427:. Figure 4-27: Processor Cable Clamp Rotation C) Insert the appropriate push-pull cable into the Processor according to the labels located above the cable clips on the Processor enclosure. D) When the push-pull cable end is visible within the Processor interior, reinstall the #10-32 jam nut. E) Connect the push-pull cables to the hex nuts (See Figure 428:). Use a 7/16 inch socket to turn the hex nut onto the cable rod end until there is approximately 5/16 inch (7,9mm) of thread showing beyond the jam nut. Lead Screw Snap Ring Push-Pull Cable Jam Nut 7/16 inch (11,11mm) Hex Nut 5/16 inch (7,9mm) Cross-bar Lead Screw 12280 Figure 4-28: Push-Pull Cable Interior Connection F) Use a 7/16 inch socket wrench and a 5/16-inch open end wrench to tighten the jam nuts. G) Position the Cable Anchor Clips to secure the cables to the Processor housing. H) Install the screws removed in step B). I) Tighten all Cable Anchor Clip screws. 4-6.2 Throttle Selector Lever A) Ensure that the Throttle push-pull cable and the engine’s throttle lever are in close proximity to one another at Idle. If so, proceed to step C) and if not continue with step B). 8 7/8 inch Maximum (225,3mm) Throttle Selector Lever at IDLE 8 7/8 inch Maximum (225,3mm) 12267 Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Extended (Default Setting) ORIENTATION DOES NOT MATCH CHANGE FUNCTION E0 Throttle Selector Lever at IDLE 12267 Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Extended (Default Setting) ORIENTATION MATCHES DO NOT CHANGE FUNCTION E0 Figure 4-29: Throttle Push-Pull Idle Orientation to Selector Lever Page4-19 INSTALLATION B) If the throttle lever is at the opposite side from the push-pull cable, change the Throttle Servo Direction E0 as described in Section 5-5.2.7.6, page 5-10. C) Adjust the ball joint on the Throttle cable to match the throttle lever at the Idle stop position. D) Ensure that adequate cable threads are showing. E) Tighten the jam nut. 4-6.3 Shift Selector Lever CAUTION: Misadjusted Shift Push-Pull Cables can cause damage to the Transmission’s Clutch Pack. Ensure adjustments are made correctly and completely. A) Check the engine and transmission to see if the push-pull cable anchor brackets have been installed. If the brackets are not on the transmission, select from Morse Clutch and Throttle Kit Selection, page A-39, or fabricate brackets as shown in Universal Mounting Kit, page A-41. B) Turn power ON to the Control System, to ensure that Neutral/ Idle is commanded. C) With the Shift Push-Pull cable disconnected at the clutch selector lever, adjust the Shift cable’s ball joint at the transmission to align with the clutch selector lever at Neutral. The push-pull cable must form a 90 degree angle to the clutch selector lever. (Refer to Figure 4-30:) 90 7 3/8 inches (187mm) Anchor Bracket 12267 Transmission Selector Lever in Neutral Position Figure 4-30: Shift Push-Pull Cable Neutral Connection at Transmission D) Connect the ball joint to the clutch selector lever. 4-6.4 Trolling Valve Selector Lever CAUTION: Misadjusted Troll Push-Pull Cables can cause damage to the Transmission’s Clutch Pack. Ensure adjustments are made correctly and completely. A) Check the trolling valve to see if the push-pull cable anchor brackets have been installed. If the bracket are not on the trolling valve, select from Appendix A - Morse Standard Kits or fabricate brackets as shown in Appendix A - Universal Mounting Kit. B) Observe the present position of the trolling valve push-pull cable in relation to the trolling valve selector lever in the full pressure (lock-up) position. Depending on the installation, the Troll push-pull cable may be fully extended or fully retracted when at maximum pressure. Page4-20 INSTALLATION • If the push-pull cable end and the troll selector lever are in close proximity to one another, no adjustment is required at this time. • If the push-pull cable end is at the opposite side from the selector lever, the cable’s polarity must be changed with Function Code , as described in Section 5-6.4.2.1, page 5-33 C) Secure the Trolling Valve selector lever at the full pressure position with wire, tie-wrap, etc. D) Further adjustments of the Trolling Valve are performed during Sea Trials as described in Section 7-5, page 7-10 L1 . . NOTE: HE TROLLING VALVE PUSH-PULL CABLE POLARITY (FUNCTION CODE L1) CANNOT BE CHANGED IF THE TROLLING FUNCTION IS NOT TURNED ON WITH FUNCTION CODE L0 AS DESCRIBED IN SECTION 5-6.4.1.4, PAGE 5-29. T Page4-21 SET UP 5 SET UP PROCEDURE The Processor utilizes push buttons in conjunction with Display LED’s to program, adjust, calibrate and set up the various features. The push buttons also allow you to access and display information regarding the health of the System. The following paragraphs explain how to locate and use the push buttons and Display LEDs: 5-1 ROCESSOR COMPONENTS USED IN SET UP P • Each Processor has a Display LED and Push Buttons. • The Display LED can be viewed through a window on the Processor’s cover as shown in Figure 5-1: LED Display Window 12268 Figure 5-1: Typical Processor Cover • The Processor enclosure cover must be removed to access the Push Buttons as shown in Figure 5-2: Push Button Location • The LED Location Display LED is used to view the Function Codes and the Values for those Functions (Section 5-1.1, page 5-2). • The Push Buttons are used to scroll through Function Codes, select Function Codes and set the Values of the Function Codes. (Section 5-1.2, page 5-2) 12255 Figure 5-2: Processor Shield Push Button and Display LED Locations Page5-1 SET UP 5-1.1 Processor Display LED Starts the Processor Part Number again, one number at a time. 12309 EXAMPLE: Running Processor Part Number during Normal Operation (9210) Figure 5-3: Display LED at Normal Operation Figure 5-4: Display LED Designations 5-1.2 • The Processor’s Display LED has four 7-segment LED’s, which light up to show either letters or numbers. • The Display LED will have the Processor Part Number showing in a running pattern during Normal operation (Figure 5-3:) • The first two digit Display LED’s to the left, indicate the Function Code, which is alphanumeric. • The second two digit Display LED’s indicate the numeric Value that is programmed into the Processor for the Function Code displayed to the left. • A decimal point indicator is located on the bottom right corner of each Display LED. Push Buttons The Processor has four Push Buttons located on the Circuit Board. They are identified by the words LEFT, RIGHT, UP and DOWN silk-screened on the Shield covering the Circuit Figure 5-5: Circuit Board Push Buttons Board. 5-1.2.1 Up and Down Push Buttons Pressing the Up or Down Push Buttons once has the following functions: Stops Normal Operation Display (running Processor Part Number) and activates the Function Menu. • While in the Function Menu, scrolls through the Function Codes one at a time. • When an Error Code (Refer to Section B-1.9, page B-21) is displayed, scrolls through the error messages one at a time. • When in Set Up Mode, increases (Up) or decreases (Down) the Value one digit at a time. • 5-1.2.2 Left and Right Push Buttons Pressing and holding the Left and Right Push Buttons simultaneously has the following functions: • Activates Set Up Mode as indicated by the blinking Display LED. (must hold the buttons until the blinking begins) Page5-2 SET UP • 5-1.2.3 While in Set Up Mode, deactivates Set Up Mode, saves the displayed Value to memory and returns to the Function Menu. (must hold the button until the blinking stops) Left Push Button Only Pressing the Left Push Button once has the following functions: Figure 5-6: Display LED Error Menu Example 5-1.2.4 • Deactivates Set Up Mode without any changes to the Value being stored to memory. The Left Push Button must be held down until function code stops blinking. The default value will then be displayed. • While in Function Menu, changes the Display LED to the Error Menu, if any errors are present. (has no effect if there are no errors stored) • While in the Error Menu, changes the Display LED back to the Function Menu. Right Push Button Only Pressing the Right Push Button once has the following functions: • While in the Error Menu, clears inactive errors. (Active errors blink, inactive do not) • While in Set Up Mode or Function Menu, allows the Value of the current Function Code to be displayed Figure 5-7: Display LED Four Digit with all four Display LEDs. Value 5-2 ACTIVATING SET UP MODE NOTE: TO E SCAPE FROM THE SET UP PROCEDURE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT SAVING THE CHANGED VALUE TO MEMORY, DEPRESS THE L EFT PUSH BUTTON. THE FUNCTION CODE WILL STOP FLASHING AND THE FUNCTION WILL BE SAVED WITH THE ORIGINAL VALUE. A) The Display LED is in Normal operating condition with the red running Processor Part Number. B) Depressing either the Up or Down Push Button will activate the Function Menu. C) Depressing the Up or Down Push Button will scroll through the Function Codes one at a time. D) Once the desired Function Code is visible on the Display LED, press and hold down the Left and Right Push Buttons simultaneously, until the Function Code begins to blink. E) Depressing the Up Push Button will increase the Value of the Function, while pressing the Down Push Button will decrease the Value of the Function. (Pressing and holding the Up or Down Push Button will increase or decrease the Value rapidly) 5-3 TORING VALUES TO MEMORY S Once the desired Value has been reached in Set Up Mode, the Value is stored to memory as follows: Page5-3 SET UP A) Depress and hold the right push button first. Then while still depressing the right button, depress and hold the Left push button until the Function Code stops blinking. • The new Value is now programmed into memory. • Set Up Mode is exited. B) Depress the Up or Down Push Button until the next required Function Code is reached. C) Reactivate Set Up Mode. I F NO PUSH BUTTONS ARE PRESSED FOR FIVE MINUTES , THE SELECTED MODE OF OPERATION IS AUTOMATICALLY EXITED AND THE SYSTEM RETURNS TO NORMAL MODE. IF NO PUSH BUTTONS ARE PRESSED FOR FIVE MINUTES WHILE IN SET UP MODE, IT WILL BE EXITED WITHOUT THE CHANGES STORED TO MEMORY. NOTE: 5-4 SET UP FUNCTION CODES AND VALUES The following tables list the Function Codes’ Name, Default Value and Range or available Options. Each of the Function Codes are explained in further detail in the referenced sections. NOTE: SINGLE SCREW APPLICATIONS: HE UNCTION ALUES MAY BE ENTERED AND STORED IN AND THE A0 UNC TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS: HE A1 UNCTION MUST BE SET T ANY ORDER. TION MUST BE SET SECOND. IN ANY ORDER. T T F V F FIRST, Table 5-1: Function Codes Function Code F - HE REST OF THE FUNCTION VALUES MAY BE ENTERED AND STORED Function Name Value Range or Options PROCESSOR FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.1, page 5-8) A0 Processor Identification 01, 02, 03, 04, 05 A1 Number of Engines 01, 02, 03, 04, 05 A2 One Lever Operation 00 – Disabled 01 – Enabled A3 SE (Station Expander) 00 – Disabled 01 – Enabled A4 Neutral Indication Tone 00 – No Tone 01 – Tone upon engaging Neutral Detent 02 – Tone upon shifting to Neutral THROTTLE FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.2, page 5-14) E0 Engine Throttle Profile OR 01 - Caterpillar (PWM) (* to 92%) Throttle Servo Direction 02 - Cummins Centry (Voltage) (0.9 to 4.5 VDC) 03 - Cummins Quantum (Voltage) (0.9 to 1.2 - 4.0 VDC) 04 - Detroit Diesel (Voltage) (0.64 to 4.65 VDC) 05 - MTU or MAN (Current) (4.0 to 20.0 mA) 06 - Scania (Voltage (0.42 to 2.95 VDC) 07 - John Deere (Voltage) (0.5 to 4.5 VDC) 08 - Volvo (Voltage) (0.6 to 3.6 VDC) 09 - Detroit Diesel (Frequency) (120.64 to 360.9 Hz) 10 - Detroit Diesel (Frequency) (120.64 to 463.5 Hz) 20 – Pull [Retracted] for Throttle Increase 21 – Push [Extended] for Throttle Increase E1 Throttle in Neutral 00.0 to 25.0% of Throttle Range E2 Throttle Minimum 00.0 to 20.0% Will always be 10% or more below Maximum. E3 Throttle Maximum 10.0 to 100.0% Will always be 10% or more above Minimum. E4 Throttle Maximum Astern 00.0 to 100.0% of Throttle Maximum Page5-4 SET UP Table 5-1: Function Codes Function Code Function Name Value Range or Options THROTTLE FUNCTIONS continued (Section 5-6.2, page 5-14) E5 Throttle Pause Following 00.0 to 05.0 Seconds Shift E6 High Idle 00.0 to 20.0% of Throttle Maximum E7 Synchronization 00 – Equal Throttle (Open Loop) Synchronization 01 - Active (Closed Loop) Synchronization (reverts to Equal if Tach Signal lost) 02 - No Synchronization 03 - Active (Closed Loop) Synchronization (no synchronization if Tach Signal is lost) CLUTCH FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.3, page 5-21) C0 Clutch Pressure Interlock 00 – Not Installed 01 – Installed 02 – Throttle Clutch Pressure Interlock Mode C1 Clutch Interlock Delay 00.5 to 10.0 Seconds C2 Proportional Pause 00 – In-Gear 01 – Neutral 02 – Fixed Neutral Delay Enabled (NOTE: If C2 is set to 02, C3 will set Fixed Neutral Delay duration.) C3 Proportional Pause Time 00 to 99 Seconds C4 Proportional Pause Ratio 00 – 2:1 Ahead to Astern vs. Astern to Ahead 01 – 1:1 Ahead to Astern vs. Astern to Ahead C5 Shift Solenoid Type OR 00 - All Shift Solenoids except ZF-Hurth Clutch Servo Direction 01 - ZF-Hurth Proportional Solenoids with 12V Power 02 - ZF-Hurth Proportional Solenoids with 24V Power 20 – Pull [Retracted] for Ahead 21 – Push [Extended] for Ahead C6 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle 00 to 100% Ahead OR Clutch Ahead ZF-Hurth Ahead Lockup Percentage PWM C7 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle 00 to 100% Astern OR Clutch Astern ZF-Hurth Astern Lockup Percentage PWM TROLL FUNCTIONS (Only Available and Displayed When Troll is Enabled) (Section 5-6.4, page 5-29) L0 Troll Enable and Control 00 – No Troll Head Troll Lever Range 01 – 20 Degrees- Type 1 02 – 35 Degrees- Type 2 03 – 45 Degrees- Type 3 (Throttle limited to 75%) 04 – 55 Degrees- Type 4 (Throttle limited to 10%)) L1 Troll Valve Function or 0 - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up Troll Servo Direction 01 - Inverse, No Current when at Lock-up 02 - Normal, Maximum Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF220-550, 12VDC Systems. 03 - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF220-550, 24VDC Systems. 04 - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF2000, 24 VDC Systems. 05 - Inverse, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF6000, 1900 or 2500, 24VDC Systems. 06 - Preset for 12VDC ZF Hurth Systems. 07 - Preset for 24VDC ZF Hurth Systems20 – Cable Fully Retracted at Lock-up. 21 – Cable Fully Extended at Lock-up. L2 Troll Minimum Pressure 01.0 to 80.0% Will always be at least 10% below Maximum. L3 Troll Maximum Pressure 20.0 to 100.0% Will always be at least 10% above Minimum. L4 Troll Throttle Limit 00 to 20% of Maximum Throttle. L5 Troll Pulse Duration 00.0 to 09.9 Seconds. L6 Troll Pulse Percentage 00.1 to 100.0% of available Troll Servo range. Page5-5 SET UP Table 5-1: Function Codes Function Function Name Value Range or Options Code TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.5, page 5-40) H0 Diagnostic Input Voltage (+/- 0.5VDC) H1 H2 Tachometer Sensor Frequency Station No.1 Lever A/D Station No.2 Lever A/D Station No.3 Lever A/D Station No.4 Lever A/D Station No.5 Lever A/D Servo 1 Feedback A/D Servo 2 Feedback A/D Transfer Button, Stations 1, 2, 3, 4, & 5 Software Revision Level Return to Factory Defaults Store to Return to Factory Defaults (For Authorized Personnel Only) Driver Fault Detection Allows the Processor to monitor the clutch and/or troll solenoids. Enable Table 5-2: Processors Function Code Defaults Function Code Default Values 9120 9121 9122 9210 9211 9221 PROCESSOR FUNCTIONS A0 00 A1 01 A2 00 A3 00 A4 00 00 01 00 00 00 00 01 00 00 00 00 01 00 00 00 00 01 00 00 00 00 01 00 00 00 THROTTLE FUNCTIONS E0 20 E1 00.0 E2 00.0 E3 33.0 E4 100.0 E5 00.5 E6 00.0 E7 02 20 00.0 00.0 00.0 100.0 00.5 00.0 02 20 00.0 00.0 33.0 100.0 00.5 00.0 02 06 00.0 08.0 59.0 100.0 00.5 00.0 00 06 00.0 08.0 59.0 100.0 00.5 00.0 00 06 00.0 08.0 59.0 100.0 00.5 00.0 00 CLUTCH FUNCTIONS C0 00 C1 01.0 C2 00 C3 03 C4 00 C5 00 C6 100 C7 100 00 01.0 00 03 00 00 100 100 00 01.0 00 03 00 00 100 100 00 01.0 00 03 00 20 80 80 00 01.0 00 03 00 20 80 80 00 01.0 00 03 00 00 100 100 Page5-6 SET UP Table 5-2: Processors Function Code Defaults Default Values Function Code 9120 9121 9122 9210 9211 9221 TROLL FUNCTIONS L0 00 00 00 00 00 00 L1 20 20 00 20 20 20 L2 70.0 70.0 100 70.0 70.0 70.0 L3 90.0 90.0 25.0 90.0 90.0 90.0 L4 00 00 00 00 00 00 L5 00.6 00.6 00.6 00.6 00.6 00.6 L6 90.0 90.0 25.0 90.0 90.0 90.0 TROUBLESHOOTING FUNCTIONS H0 00 00 00 00 00 00 H1 00 00 00 00 00 00 H2 00 00 00 -- -- 00 5-5 IELD SERVICE TEST UNIT (BREAK-OUT BOX) AND MULTIMETER USE F Refer to Appendix A - MM13927 Manual for more information on the use of the Field Service Test Unit (Break-out Box). To aid in adjusting Table 5-3: list of Processor signals, ZF Mathers recommends the use of ZF Mathers Field Service Test Unit (P/N 13927) (Breakout Box) and a calibrated Multimeter. Figure 5-8: Service Field Test Unit and Multimeter Table 5-3: Functions Requiring Service Field Test Unit and Multimeter E1 E2 E3 E4 E6 L2 L3 L4 C6 C7 Throttle in Neutral (Section 5-6.2.1.3) Throttle Minimum (Section 5-6.2.3.2) Throttle Maximum (Section 5-6.2.3.3) Throttle Maximum Astern (Section 5-6.2.1.4) High Idle (Section 5-6.2.1.2) Trolling Minimum (Section 5-6.4.4.2) Trolling Maximum (Section 5-6.4.4.3) Troll Throttle Limit (Section 5-6.4.1.5) ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Ahead (Section 5-6.3.3.2) ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Astern (Section 5-6.3.3.3) Page5-7 SET UP For Functions E1, E2, E3, E4, E6, and L4 connect the 8-Pin connector of the Service Field Test Unit into the Processor Throttle connector and to the Throttle Wire Harness. Figure 5-9: E1, E2, E3, E4, E6, L4 Processor, Test Unit, and Multimeter Connections L2, L3, C6, C7 connect the 12-Pin For Functions and connector of the Service Field Test Unit to the Processor Clutch connector and to the Clutch Wire Figure 5-10: L2, L3, C6, and C7 Processor, Test Unit, and Multimeter Connections 5-6 SYSTEM PROGRAMMING AND ADJUSTMENTS Harness. NOTE: SINGLE SCREW APPLICATIONS: THE FUNCTION VALUES MAY BE ENTERED AND STORED IN ANY ORDER. TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS: THE A1 FUNCTION MUST BE SET FIRST, AND THE A0 FUNCTION MUST BE SET SECOND . THE REST OF THE FUNCTION VALUES MAY BE ENTERED AND STORED IN ANY ORDER. NOTE: POWER MUST BE TURNED ON TO THE PROCESSORS WHEN PROGRAMMING OR MAKING ANY ADJUSTMENTS TO THE SYSTEM. NOTE: IN ORDER TO PREVENT NUISANCE ALARMS WHEN FIRST SETTING UP A SYSTEM, SOME FUNCTION CODES TAKE UP TO 5 MINUTES TO BECOME ACTIVE. THE FUNCTIONS AFFECTED BY THIS ARE THE FUNCTIONS THAT RELY ON THE SERIAL COMMUNICATION, SUCH AS A0, A1, A2, A3, E7, AND L0. CYCLING POWER OFF, THEN ON, EXPEDITES THESE FEATURES MAKING THE FUNCTIONS AVAILABLE IMMEDIATELY. 5-6.1 Processor Functions 5-6.1.1 Function Code A0 – Processor Identification In applications where there is more than one screw, the system must know which Processor is where. Every Processor must have its own unique identifying number. At no time can two or more Processors be identified by the same Processor Identification Number. The available Values for this Function are: (Default Value), and 00 01, 02, 03, 04 05. NOTE: IN TWIN SCREW OR MORE APPLICATIONS, THE VALUE OF FUNCTION CODE A0 CAN BE CHANGED ONLY AFTER THE VALUE IN FUNCTION CODE A1 HAS BEEN CHANGED TO 02 OR HIGHER. Page5-8 SET UP To change the Value (Refer to Sections ): A) Scroll to Function Code A0. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. A0 Set Up Activated 5-6.1.2 Function Code A1 – Number of Engines The total number of engines must be entered into the memory of each of the Processors. All Processors in an installation must have the same value entered. The available Values for this Function are: Function Code is Blinking Figure 5-11: Function 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5 Display LED 01 Single Screw (Default Value) 02 Twin Screw 03 Triple Screw 04 Quad Screw 05 Quint Screw NOTE: N SCREW OR MORE APPLICATIONS REQUIRE FUNCTION CODE A1 VALUES CHANGED ON ALL ROCESSORS PRIOR TO CHANGING THE VALUE OF FUNCTION CODE A0. TWI P To change the Value (Refer to Sections A) Scroll to Function Code A1. B) Activate Set Up Mode. Figure 5-12: Display LED Function C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. A1 Set Up Activated D) Store the Value to memory. ): 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5 NOTE: EFORE CONTINUING SET UP, WAIT 5 MINUTES OR CYCLE POWER. B 5-6.1.3 Function Code A2 – One Lever Operation In Twin Screw or more applications, the System has the ability to command all engines and transmissions to the same speed and direction with a single Control Head lever. This Function allows this Feature to be enabled or disabled. (Refer to Section 2-9, page 2-5,, for operation instructions) The available Values for this Function are: 00 Disabled (Default Value) 01 Enabled To change the Value (Refer to Sections A) Scroll to Function Code A2. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. ): 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5 Figure 5-13: Display LED Function A2 Set Up Activated Page5-9 SET UP 5-6.1.4 NOTE: Function Code A3 – SE (Station Expander) HIS MANUAL DOES NOT GO INTO DETAIL ON THE STATION EXPANDER INSTALLATION AND ADJUSTMENTS. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON THE STATION EXPANDER, CONTACT YOUR LOCAL ZF MATHERS REPRESENTATIVE. T The SE is a separate unit, which gives the System the ability to increase the number of Remote Stations, if more than five Remote Stations are required. (Refer to Section 8-3, page 8-4, for further information) The available Values for this Function are: 00 Disabled (Default Value) 01 Enabled To change the Value (Refer to Sections A) Scroll to Function Code A3. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. ): 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5 Figure 5-14: Display LED Function A3 Set Up Activated 5-6.1.5 Function Code A4 – Neutral Indication Tone This Function allows the installer to turn ON a 1/2 second, 50 Hz. tone to indicate Neutral. The available Values for this Function are: Disabled (Default Value) Tone sounds when the Control Head’s lever reaches Neutral Tone sounds when the Processor commands Neutral To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code A4. 00 01 02 Figure 5-15: Display LED Function A4 Set Up Activated 5-6.2 B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. Throttle Functions 5-6.2.1 Throttle Basic Functions 5-6.2.1.1 Function Code E5 – Throttle Pause Following Shift The available Values for this Function are seconds to seconds. The Default Value is seconds. This Function programs the amount of delay between the point that Clutch engagement is commanded and throttle is allowed to increase above Idle. 00.0 05.0 00.5 NOTE: HIS FUNCTION IS TYPICALLY PROGRAMMED DURING DOCK TRIALS. ATE SECTION 6-8, PAGE 6-6, OR 6-9, PAGE 6-7. T Page5-10 EFER TO THE APPROPRI- R SET UP Figure 5-16: To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code E5. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Display LED Function E5 Set Up D) Store the Value to memory. Activated 5-6.2.1.2 Function Code E6 – High Idle This Function Code Programs the RPM of the second, elevated Idle. The available Values for this Function are to % of Throttle Maximum. The Default Value is %. The Value selected is a percentage of the Value selected in Function Code – Throttle Maximum. 00.0 20.0 00.0 E3 NOTE: HIS FUNCTION IS TYPICALLY PROGRAMMED DURING DOCK TRIALS OR SEA TRIALS. ECTION 6-5, PAGE 6-2. T EFER TO R S To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Display LED Function E6 Set Up D) Store the Value to memory. Activated Function Code is Blinking E6 Figure 5-17: 5-6.2.1.3 Function Code E1 – Throttle in Neutral This Function allows the engine RPM at Neutral to be adjusted independently of the RPM at Idle Ahead and Astern. The available Values for this Function are to percent of the Throttle Range. The Default Value is %. To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, Function Code is Blinking page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Figure 5-18: Display LED Function E1 Set Up D) Store the Value to memory. Activated 00.0 25.0 00.0 E1 5-6.2.1.4 Function Code E4 – Throttle Maximum Astern This Function limits the amount of Throttle permitted in Astern. The available Values for this Function are % to %. The Default Value is % of Throttle Maximum. The Value selected is a percentage of the Value selected in Function Code – Throttle Maximum. 00.0 100.0 100.0 E3 Page5-11 SET UP Figure 5-19: Display LED Function Activated E4 Set Up 5-6.2.1.5 Example: A Value of 50.0 will allow 50% of Throttle Maximum when commanding Astern. The Value selected is a matter of personal preference. To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code E4. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. Function Code This Function Code selects the type of Synchronization, if Synchronization is required. The types are described in Section 2-10, page 2-6. The available Values for this Function are: 00 01 02 03 Figure 5-20: E7 – Synchronization Equal Throttle (Open Loop) Synchronization Active (Closed Loop) Synchronization (reverts to Equal Throttle Synch if there is no Tachometer Sensor signal) No Synchronization Active (Closed Loop) Synchronization (reverts to no Synchronization if there is no Tachometer Sensor signal) (Default Value) The Default Value is 02. To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code E7. B) Activate Set Up Mode. Display LED Function E7 Set Up C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Activated D) Store the Value to memory. 5-6.2.2 Throttle Servo Functions This section along with Section 5-6.2.1 Throttle Basic Functions, allows the adjustment of Throttle Servo related items: 5-6.2.2.1 Function Code E0 – Throttle Servo Direction This Function determines if the Throttle PushPull cable is fully extended or retracted when at Idle. The available Values for this Function are: 20 Fully Retracted [Pull] at Idle (Default Value) 21 Fully Extended [Push] at Idle To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Ensure that the engine’s Governor or Carburetor lever is at the Idle position. • If the Throttle Push-Pull cable’s ball joint is close to the Throttle lever’s position, no change is required to this Function Code. Figure 5-21: Throttle Push-Pull Cable Orientation • If the Throttle Push-Pull cable’s ball joint is at the opposite side of the lever’s position, continue with the next step. Page5-12 SET UP Figure 5-22: Example: Throttle Push-Pull Cable Fully Retracted Position for Idle B) Scroll to Function Code E0. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down until the Value 21 is displayed. E) Store the Value to memory. (The Throttle Push-Pull cable should drive to the fully retracted position.) F) Do not connect the ball joint to the throttle lever at this time. Figure 5-23: Display LED Function E0 Set Up Activated 5-6.2.2.2 Function Code E2 – Throttle Minimum This Function further adjusts the Push-Pull cable’s Idle position electronically. The primary purpose is to adjust the Push-Pull cable/Throttle Selector Lever’s position so that any further movement will result in an increase in engine RPM. (No Dead-band) The available Values for this Function are 00.0 to 20.0%. The Default Value is 00.0%. This value will always be 10% or more below E3 Throttle Maximum. To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): Function Code is Blinking A) Ensure that the Throttle push-pull cable is connected to the Throttle lever. B) Scroll to Function Code E2. C) Activate Set Up Mode. Figure 5-24: Display LED Function E2 Set Up D) Scroll Up until the engine RPM begins to Activated increase above Idle. E) Scroll Down until Idle RPM is reached. F) Store the Value to memory. 5-6.2.2.3 Function Code E3 – Throttle Maximum Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Retracted Throttle Selector Lever is not at 12267 Full Throttle and against the Full Throttle Stop FUNCTION CODE E3 NEED TO BE ADJUSTED Full Throttle Stop Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Retracted Throttle Selector Lever at 12267 Full Throttle and Laying Firmly against the Full Throttle Stop FUNCTION CODE E3 DOES NOT NEED TO BE ADJUSTED Full Throttle Stop Figure 5-25: Throttle Push-Pull Cable Full Throttle Position This Function adjusts the position of the Throttle Push-Pull cable at Full Throttle. The available Values for this Function are 10.0% to 100.0%. The Default Value is 33.0%. This value will always be 10% or more above E2 Throttle Minimum. The Value entered is the percentage of the servo’s maximum travel of 3.00 inches (76,2mm). Example: A Value of 50.0, will equal 1.50 inches (38,1mm) of travel from Idle to Full Throttle. To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Take command at a Remote Station. Page5-13 SET UP Function Code is Blinking Figure 5-26: Display LED Function E3 Set Up Activated B) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Ahead position. C) Check to see if the Throttle Push-Pull cable reaches the Full Throttle stop. • If the Throttle lever is firmly (not bound) against the Full Throttle stop, no adjustment to Function Code E3 is required. • If the Throttle lever does not reach the Full Throttle stop, continue with the next step. D) Scroll to Function Code E3. E) Activate Set Up Mode. F) Scroll Up until the Throttle lever is firmly (not bound) against the Full Throttle Stop. G) Store the Value to memory. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. 5-6.2.3 Throttle Electronic Functions 5-6.2.3.1 Function Code E0 – Engine Throttle Profile This Function selects the appropriate Throttle Signal range for various engines The available Values for this Function are listed below: 01 - Caterpillar (PWM) (8 to 92%) 02 - Cummins Centry (Voltage) (0.9 to 4.5 VDC) 03 - Cummins Quantum (Voltage) (0.9 to 1.2 - 4.0 VDC) 04 - Detroit Diesel (Voltage) (0.64 to 4.65 VDC) 05 - MTU or MAN (Current) (4.0 to 20.0 mA) 06 - Scania (Voltage (0.42 to 2.95 VDC) 07 - John Deere (Voltage) (0.5 to 4.5 VDC) 08 - Volvo (Voltage) (0.6 to 3.6 VDC) 09 - Detroit Diesel (Frequency) (120.64 to 360.9 Hz) 10 - Detroit Diesel (Frequency) (120.64 to 463.5 Hz) Figure 5-27: Display LED Function E0 Set Up Activated The Default Value is set to 06 Scania Profile. To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code E0. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down until the the desired Value is displayed. D) Store the Value to memory. Page5-14 SET UP 5-6.2.3.2 Function Code E2 – Throttle Minimum Function Code is Blinking Figure 5-28: Display LED Function E2 Set Up Activated This Function allows the throttle signal at Idle to be fine tuned from the Value provided by the E0 Throttle Profile. The available Values for this Function are 00.0 to 20.0%. The Default Value is 08.0%. To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 52 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code E2. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up until the engine RPM at Idle begins to increase above Idle RPM. D) Scroll Down until Idle RPM is reached. E) Store the Value to memory. 5-6.2.3.3 Function Code E3 – Throttle Maximum Function Code is Blinking Figure 5-29: Display LED Function E3 Set Up Activated 5-6.3 This Function allows the throttle signal at Full to be fine tuned from that provided by the E0 Throttle Profile. The available Values for this Function are 10.0% to 100.0%. The Value entered is the percentage of the throttle’s range from Idle to Full. EXAMPLE: A Value of 50.0, will equal a 2.10 VDC throttle signal when the Volvo profile is selected, which has a throttle range of 0.6 to 3.6 VDC. The Default Value is 59.0%. To determine and change the Value (Refer to Sections 52 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Take command at a Remote Station. B) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Ahead position. C) Measure the throttle signal. D) Scroll to Function Code E3. E) Activate Set Up Mode. F) Scroll Up until the throttle signal is at Full Throttle. G) Store the Value to memory. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. Clutch Functions 5-6.3.1 Clutch Basic Functions 5-6.3.1.1 Function Code C0 – Clutch Pressure Interlock This adjustment is to be set to Enabled only if the optional Clutch Pressure Switch is being used with this application. This Function enables or disables the feature and allows for two different modes of behavior when a Page5-15 SET UP Function Code is Blinking Clutch Pressure Switch is used. Refer to Section 8-2, page 8-2, for detailed information. The available Values for this Function are: 00 Not Installed (Default Value) 01 Installed 02 Throttle Clutch Pressure Interlock Mode To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory. C0 Figure 5-30: Display LED Function C0 Set Up Activated 5-6.3.1.2 Function Code C1 – Clutch Interlock Delay This adjustment is to be used only if the optional Clutch Pressure Switch is being used with this application. This Function works together with Function Code – Clutch Pressure Interlock. Refer to Sections 8-2, page 8-2, for operational details. The available Values are to seconds. The Default Value is seconds. Function Code is Blinking To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5) A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. Figure 5-31: Display LED Function C1 Set Up C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Activated D) Store the Value to memory. C0 00.5 10.0 01.0 C1 5-6.3.1.3 Function Code C2 – Proportional Pause This Function selects whether the Clutch stays engaged or at Neutral when performing a Full Speed Reversal. The In-Gear Delay is most commonly used. The Neutral Delay is used when a Shaft Brake is installed. The amount of time is adjustable with Function Code Proportional Pause Time. C3 • The delay programmed is maximum and proportional when Values and are used. • The programmed delay is fixed when Value is selected and Function Code Proportional Pause • Ratio is set to (1:1 Ratio). When is set to , the pause from Astern through Neutral to Ahead is 1/2 of the selected value. 00 01 02 C4 01 C4 The available Values are: 00 In-Gear (Default) 01 Neutral 02 Page5-16 Fixed Neutral Delay Enabled 00 SET UP To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code C2. B) Activate Set Up Mode. Display LED Function C2 Set Up C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Activated D) Store the Value to memory. Function Code is Blinking Figure 5-32: F C2 PROPORTIONAL PAUSE IS SET TO 02 FIXED NEUTRAL DELAY ENABLED, FUNCTION C3 PROPORTIONAL PAUSE TIME WILL SET THE FIXED NEUTRAL DELAY DURATION. NOTE: I 5-6.3.1.4 Function Code C3 – Proportional Pause Time The Proportional Pause Time feature provides engine deceleration, followed by a pause in throttling to the commanded speed in the new desired direction, upon a Full-Speed Reversal. This pause time is proportional to how much throttle is being commanded and for how long. In order to build up to the pause value set, the vessel must be at full throttle and Ahead six (6) times the pause set. The default pause from Astern to Ahead is 1/2 the Proportional Pause value set. When Proportional Pause is set to , the throttle position drops to Idle and the transmission remains engaged Ahead; the pause that follows is in proportion to the prior Control Head lever position and how long the lever had been in that position before the reversal. This Function selects the amount of time that the Clutch will stay engaged or at Neutral (depending on setting) while performing a Full Speed Reversal. The available Values are to seconds. The default Value is seconds. C2 C2 00 C2 00 99 03 NOTE: HE VALUE FOR THIS FUNCTION CODE SHOULD BE DETERMINED DURING THE SEA TRIAL. T To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. Figure 5-33: Display LED Function C3 Set Up C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Activated D) Store the Value to memory. Function Code is Blinking C3 5-6.3.1.5 Function Code C4 – Proportional Pause Ratio 00 - 2:1 Ratio This is the default setting and determines how the value set in the Proportional Pause Time C3 Function is applied. The number of seconds selected is for an Ahead to Astern maneuver only. An Astern to Ahead maneuver will be 1/2 of the Proportional Pause Time selected. This is the typical selection since most vessels do not reach the same throttle in Astern as they would in Ahead. Therefore, the time required to get to a sufficient water speed for a safe reversal is significantly less. Page5-17 SET UP - 1:1 Ratio When this setting is selected, the value set in the Proportional Pause Time is the same for both Ahead to Astern, as with Astern to Ahead maneuvers. This may be selected when the vessel reaches the same water speed in both directions, as would be the case with a Double Ended Ferry. Another application where this option may be selected would be the control of a Bow or Stern Thruster. This Function Code selects whether the Proportional Pause Time is the same in Ahead and Astern or whether the time in Ahead is twice that in Astern. Standard vessels with a bow and a stern typically select a pause which is twice as much in Ahead compared to Astern. This is because much more speed is obtainable in Ahead, then Astern. Consequently, more time is required to slow down from Ahead as compared to Astern. 01 C3 NOTE: WHEN THE CONTROLS ARE INSTALLED ON A VESSEL SUCH AS A DOUBLE ENDED FERRY OR THE CONTROLS ARE BEING USED TO CONTROL A THRUSTER, THE PROPORTIONAL PAUSE SHOULD BE THE SAME IN AHEAD AS ASTERN OR PORT AND STARBOARD IN THE CASE OF A THRUSTER. The available Values for this Function are: 2:1 Ahead to Astern vs. Astern to Ahead (Default Value) 1:1 Ahead to Astern vs. Astern to Ahead To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A)Scroll to Function Code C4. B) Activate Set Up Mode. Figure 5-34: Display LED Function C4 Set Up C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Activated D)Store the Value to memory. 00 01 5-6.4 Clutch Servo Functions This section along with Section 5-6.3.1 Clutch Basic Functions allows the adjustment of Clutch Servo related items: 5-6.4.1.1 8 7/8 inch Maximum (225,3mm) Clutch Selector Lever at AHEAD 12267 Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Extended (Default Setting) Function Code This Function allows the Processor to be programmed to retract the Push-Pull cable for Ahead or extend for Ahead. The available Values are: Pull [Retracted] for Ahead (Default) Push [Extended] for Ahead If required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Position the Clutch Selector Lever to the Ahead position. B) Move a Control Head’s lever into the Ahead detent. 20 ORIENTATION MATCHES DO NOT CHANGE FUNCTION C5 21 8 7/8 inch Maximum (225,3mm) Clutch Selector Lever at AHEAD 12267 Processor Push-Pull Cable Fully Extended (Default Setting) ORIENTATION DOES NOT MATCH CHANGE FUNCTION C5 Figure 5-35: Clutch Push-Pull Cable Orientation C5 – Clutch Servo Direction Page5-18 SET UP C) Check the Shift Push-Pull cable to see if it drove in the correct direction. • If the cable drove in the correct direction, no change to this Function Code is required. Figure 5-36: Display LED Function C5 Set Up Activated • If the cable drove in the opposite direction, con- D) E) F) G) tinue with the next step. Scroll to Function Code C5. Activate Set Up Mode. Scroll Up to change the Value to . Store the Value to memory. 21 5-6.4.1.2 Function Code C6 – Clutch Ahead Travel This function adjusts the amount of Clutch push-pull cable travel in both the Ahead and the Astern directions. The available Values are to percent of the maximum available travel from Neutral to Ahead. The Default Value is %. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. B) Move the Clutch Selector Lever to the Ahead Clutch Push-Pull Cable Ahead stop. Position C) Does the cable’s ball joint and lever align? 00.0 100.0 80 Figure 5-37: • If yes, no further adjustment of this Function is required. • If no, continue with the next step. Function Code is Blinking D) Scroll to Function Code . E) Activate Set Up Mode. F) Scroll Up or Down until the ball joint and lever align perfectly. G) Store the Value to memory. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. C6 Figure 5-38: Display LED Function C6 Set Up Activated 5-6.4.1.3 Function Code C7 – Clutch Astern Travel 12267 This function is only required when the distance from Neutral to Astern differs from Neutral to Ahead. This Function Code allows the independent adjustment of Astern travel. Otherwise, the Value selected in Function Code is automatically entered for Function Code . The available Values are to percent of the available travel from Neutral to Astern. The Default Value is %. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): C6 C7 00.0 12267 Figure 5-39: Clutch Push-Pull Cable Astern Position 80 Page5-19 100.0 SET UP A) Move the Control Head lever to the Astern detent. B) Move the Clutch Selector Lever to the Astern stop. C) Does the cable’s ball joint and lever align? • If yes, no further adjustment of this Function is required. • If no, continue with the next step. Figure 5-40: Display LED Function Activated 5-6.4.2 C7 Set Up D) Scroll to Function Code C7. E) Activate Set Up Mode. F) Scroll Up or Down until the ball joint and Clutch Selector lever aligns perfectly. G) Connect the ball joint to the Clutch Selector lever. H) Store the Value to memory. I) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. Clutch Solenoid Functions This section along with Section 5-6.3.1 Clutch Basic Functions allows the adjustment of Clutch Solenoid related items: 5-6.4.2.1 Function Code C5 – Shift Solenoid Type This Function Code must be left at the default value unless a ZF-Hurth Gear is installed with proportional Ahead and Astern Solenoids. When values or are selected, the current is limited to the solenoids. The available Values are: - All Shift Solenoids except ZF-Hurth (DEFAULT) - ZF-Hurth Proportional Solenoids with 12V Power - ZF-Hurth Proportional Solenoids with 24V Power The default value of is used with most types of solenoids, with the exception of the ZF-Hurth Gears with proportional Ahead and Astern solenoids. CAUTION: The maximum amount of current to these solenoids MUST be limited by the control system. Failure to do so can cause permanent damage to the solenoids. Depending on the voltage applied to the solenoids, adjust the Value to 01 for 12V power and 02 for 24V power. To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code C5. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up to change the Value. D) Store the Value to memory. Figure 5-41: Display LED Function C5 Set Up 01 00 01 02 00 Activated Page5-20 02 SET UP 5-6.4.2.2 Function Code C6 – ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Ahead This function adjusts the maximum current available to the Ahead Proportional Solenoid. Failure to limit the current may result in permanent damage to the solenoid. The available Values are to percent Duty Cycle of the applied voltage. The Default Value is %. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Ensure that Troll is not selected (no rapidly blinking LED). Function Code is Blinking B) Connect an amp meter in series with the Ahead solenoid signal. C) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. D) Scroll to Function Code . Figure 5-42: Display LED Function C6 Set Up Activated E) Activate Set Up Mode. F) Scroll Up or Down until the appropriate maximum current level is reached. G) Store the Value to memory. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. 00.0 100.0 100 C6 5-6.4.2.3 Function Code C7 – ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Astern This function limits the amount of current delivered to the Astern Proportional Solenoid. Failure to limit the current may result in permanent damage to the solenoid. The available Values are to percent Duty Cycle of the applied voltage. The Default Value is %. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Ensure that Troll is not selected (no rapidly blinking LED). B) Connect an amp meter in series with the Astern solenoid signal. C) Move the Control Head lever to the Astern detent. D) Scroll to Function Code . Display LED Function C7 Set Up E) Activate Set Up Mode. Activated F) Scroll Up or Down until the appropriate minimum current level is reached. G) Store the Value to memory. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/ Idle position. 00.0 100 Figure 5-43: C7 Page5-21 100.0 SET UP 5-6.5 Troll Functions 5-6.5.1 Basic Troll Command Functions NOTE: IF THE CONTROL SYSTEM DOES NOT OFFER INTEGRATED TROLL CONTROL, A 9001 TROLL ACTUATOR IS REQUIRED TO OFFER TROLLING VALVE CONTROL. INTEGRATED TROLL CONTROL ALL TROLL FUNCTIONS OTHER THAN L0 WILL NOT BE DISPLAYED ON THE PROCESSOR DISPLAY LED IF FUNCTION L0 IS SET TO 00. TO UTILIZE TROLL AND DISPLAY THE REST OF THE TROLL FUNCTIONS, A VALUE OTHER THAN 00 NEEDS TO BE ENTERED FOR FUNCTION L0. 9001 TROLL ACTUATOR ALL THE FUNCTION CODES RELATING TO TROLL WILL NOT BE DISPLAYED, UNLESS AN EXTERNAL TROLL ACTUATOR (P/N 9001) IS CONNECTED TO THE PROCESSOR. INSTALLATION AND ADJUSTMENT DETAILS ARE INCLUDED WITH THE TROLL ACTUATOR. THE FOLLOWING IS A BRIEF OUTLINE OF THE BASIC TROLL FUNCTION ADJUSTMENTS. 5-6.5.1.4 Function Code L0 – Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Troll Range This Function Code tells the Processor whether or not: • A 9001 TROLLING ACTUATOR OR INTEGRATED TROLL CONTROL EXISTS. • HOW THE TROLLING VALVE IS TO BE CONTROLLED. There are four types which can be used to control any trolling valve. How these different Types function and when and where they may be applied is described in the Trolling Actuator’s Installation Manual for the 9001 Trolling Actuator and in Section 2-4, page 2-2, for Integrated Troll Control. The available Values are: No Troll (Default Value) 20 Degrees – Type 1 35 Degrees – Type 2 45 Degrees – Type 3 (Throttle limited to 75%). 55 Degrees - Type 4 (Throttle limited to 10%). 00 01 02 03 04 To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory L0 Figure 5-44: Display LED Function L0 Set Up Activated NOTE: FUNCTION CODES L1 THRU L6 ARE NOT DISPLAYED ON THE PROCESSOR DISPLAY LED UNLESS FUNCTION CODE L0 IS SET TO A VALUE OTHER THAN 00. Page5-22 SET UP Figure 5-45: Control Head 20 Degree Troll Range Type 1 Figure 5-46: Control Head 35 Degree Troll Range Type 2 Figure 5-47: Control Head 45 Degree Troll Range Type 3 Figure 5-48: Control Head 55 Degree Troll Range Type 4 5-6.5.1.5 Function Code L4 – Troll Throttle Limit This Function allows an increase in throttle above Idle while commanding clutch slippage. The throttle increases linearly to the Value set while commanding Troll Minimum to Troll Maximum. The Values available to this Function are 00 to 20 percent of Throttle Maximum. The default value is 00% of Throttle Maximum. Figure 5-49: Display LED Function L4 Set Up Activated To change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code L4. B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. D) Store the Value to memory NOTE: DO NOT MAKE ANY ADJUSTMENTS TO FUNCTION CODES L5 AND L6 UNTIL THE VESSEL HAS BEEN SEA TRIALED AND FUNCTION CODES L0, L1, L2, L3, AND L4 HAVE BEEN PROPERLY ADJUSTED. FOR 9001 TROLL ACTUATOR DETAILED INSTRUCTIONS ON THE ADJUSTMENTS OF L5 AND L6 CAN BE FOUND IN THE TROLLING ACTUATOR’S INSTALLATION MANUAL. FOR INTEGRATED TROLL DETAILED INSTRUCTIONS ON THE ADJUSTMENT OF L5 CAN BE FOUND IN THE FOLLOWING SECTION 5-6.5.1.6 F UNCTION C ODE L5 – TROLL PULSE DURATION. THE ADJUSTMENT OF INTEGRATED SERVO TROLL L6 IN SECTION 5-6.4.2.4, PAGE 5-35, OR INTEGRATED SOLENOID TROLL L6 IN SECTION 5-6.4.4.4, PAGE 5-38. Page5-23 SET UP 5-6.5.1.6 Function Code L5 – Troll Pulse Duration This Function determines the length of time that the Value selected in Function Code is applied. The available Values for this Function are to seconds. The default Value is seconds. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) With Troll selected, place the Control Head lever into the Ahead detent. L6 00.0 09.9 00.6 • If the vessel lunges for ward or the shaft takes too long to start rotating, continue with the next B) C) D) E) 5-6.5.2 step. Scroll to Function Code . Activate Set Up Mode. Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. Store the Value to memory. L5 Troll Servo Functions NOTE: ALL TROLL FUNCTIONS OTHER THAN L0 WILL NOT BE DISPLAYED ON THE PROCESSOR DISPLAY LED IF FUNCTION L0 IS SET TO 00. TO UTILIZED TROLL AND DISPLAY THE REST OF THE TROLL FUNCTIONS, A VALUE OTHER THAN 00 NEEDS TO BE ENTERED FOR FUNCTION L0. This section along with Section 5-6.4.1, page 5-29, Basic Troll Command Functions allows the adjustment of Troll Servo related items: 5-6.5.2.1 Function Code L1 – Troll Servo Direction This Function Code determines whether the Troll Push-Pull cable is fully extended or retracted when at Lock-up. The available Values are: Lock-up – Push-Pull cable fully retracted. (Default Value) Lock-up – Push-Pull cable fully extended. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Move the Troll Selector Lever to the Lock-up (Full Pressure) position. B) Check to see if the Push-Pull cable’s ball joint are in close proximity to one another. 20 21 Figure 5-50: Display LED Function L1 Set Up Activated • If so, no adjustments of Function Code L1 Troll Servo Direction are required. • If they are not, continue with the next step. C) Scroll to Function Code L1. D) Activate Set Up Mode. E) Scroll Up or Down to Value F) Store the Value to memory Page5-24 20 or 21. SET UP NOTE: EFER TO THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS WHEN MAKING THE TROLL MINIMUM AND TROLL MAXIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS. A SHAFT TACH IS REQUIRED TO PROPERLY ADJUST THESE ITEMS. THESE ADJUSTMENTS ARE BEST DONE WHILE UNDERWAY. R 5-6.5.2.2 Function Code L2 – Troll Minimum Pressure This Function adjusts the Troll Push-Pull cable travel to the point where clutch pressure is at the minimum point where shaft rotations are still possible. The hydraulic pressure on the Clutch plate can typically be decrease to a point where the shaft is rotating at 30% to 50% of normal shaft RPM at Idle. The available Values are to percent of the 3.00 inches (76,2mm) of Troll Push-Pull cable travel. The Default Value is %. The Value selected must always be at least 10% below the Troll Maximum Pressure selected. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): 0.10 80.0 70.0 L3 Figure 5-51: Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated A) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. B) Scroll to Function Code L2. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value E) Store the Value to memory 5-6.5.2.3 Function Code L3 – Troll Maximum Pressure This Function adjusts the Troll Push-Pull cable travel to the point where clutch pressure is at the maximum point, yet not quite at normal shaft RPM at Idle. The hydraulic pressure on the Clutch plate can typically be decreased to a point where the shaft is rotating at approximately 70% of normal shaft RPM at Idle. The available Values are to percent of the 3.00 inches (76,2mm) of Troll Push-Pull cable travel. The Default Value is %. The Value selected must be at least 10% above the Troll Minimum Pressure selected. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. B) Scroll to Function Code L3. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value E) Store the Value to memory 20.0 90.0 L2 Figure 5-52: Display LED Function L3 Set Up Activated Page5-25 100.0 SET UP NOTE: O NOT MAKE ANY ADJUSTMENTS TO FUNCTION CODES L5 AND L6 UNTIL THE VESSEL HAS BEEN SEA-TRIALED AND FUNCTION CODES L0, L1, L2, L3, AND L4 HAVE BEEN PROPERLY ADJUSTED. FOR INTEGRATED TROLL DETAILED INSTRUCTIONS ON THE ADJUSTMENT OF L5 CAN BE FOUND IN SECTION 5-6.4.1.6 PAGE 5-33. T HE ADJUSTMENT OF INTEGRATED SERVO TROLL L6 CAN BE FOUND IN THE FOLLOWING SECTION 5-6.5.2.4, FUNCTION CODE L6 – TROLL PULSE PERCENTAGE. D 5-6.5.2.4 Function Code L6 – Troll Pulse Percentage This Function Code selects the percentage of available Troll Servo Range the Processor’s push-pull cable travels when first engaging the Clutch while in Troll. The available Values for this Function are % to % The default Value is %. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) With Troll selected, place the Control Head lever into the Ahead detent. 01.0 100.0 90.0 • If the vessel lunges for ward or the shaft takes too long to start rotating, continue with the next step. B) Scroll to Function Code L6. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value E) Store the Value to memory Figure 5-53: Display LED Function L6 Set Up Activated 5-6.5.3 9001 Troll Actuator Functions (Servo 3) Refer to the manual supplied with the 9001 Troll Actuator for the Set Up Procedures for Trolling. 5-6.5.4 Integrated Troll Solenoid Functions NOTE: ALL TROLL FUNCTIONS OTHER THAN L0 WILL NOT BE DISPLAYED ON THE PROCESSOR DISPLAY LED IF FUNCTION L0 IS SET TO 00. TO UTILIZE TROLL AND DISPLAY THE REST OF THE TROLL FUNCTIONS, A VALUE OTHER THAN 00 NEEDS TO BE ENTERED FOR FUNCTION L0. This section along with Section 5-6.4.1 Basic Troll Command Functions allows the adjustment of Integrated Troll Solenoid related items: 5-6.5.4.1 Function Code L1 – Troll Valve Function This Function Code presets the profile and the amount of current delivered to the Trolling Valve’s proportional solenoid. The Values for this Function are listed below: - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up - Inverse, No Current when at Lock-up - Normal, Maximum Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF220-550, 12VDC Systems. 00 01 02 Page5-26 SET UP 03 - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF220-550, 24VDC Systems. 04 - Normal, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF2000, 24 VDC Systems. 05 - Inverse, No Current when at Lock-up. Preset for ZF670, 1900 or 2500, 24VDC Systems. 06 - Preset for 12VDC ZF Hurth Systems. 07 - Preset for 24VDC ZF Hurth Systems. The default value is 00. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Scroll to Function Code . B) Activate Set Up Mode. C) Scroll Up or Down to the appropriate Value for the Trolling Valve. D) Store the Value to memory L1 Figure 5-54: Display LED Function L1 Set Up Activated 5-6.5.4.2 Function Code L2 – Troll Minimum Pressure This Function fine tunes the amount of current delivered to the proportional solenoid, so that clutch pressure is at the minimum point where shaft rotations are still possible. The hydraulic pressure on the Clutch plate can typically be decreased to a point where the shaft is rotating at 30% to 50% of normal shaft RPM at Idle. The available Values are to percent of the maximum current available. The Default Value is %. The Value selected must always be at least 20% below or above (Normal/Inverted) the value selected with Troll Maximum Pressure . To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. B) Scroll to Function Code . C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the appropriate Value for the Trolling Valve. E) Store the Value to memory 0.00 80.0 10.0 L3 L2 Figure 5-55: Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated 5-6.5.4.3 Function Code L3 – Troll Maximum Pressure This Function fine tunes the amount of current delivered to the proportional solenoid, so that clutch pressure is at the maximum point prior to Clutch Plate lock-up. The hydraulic pressure on the Clutch plate can typically be decreased to a point where the shaft is rotating at approximately 70% of normal shaft RPM at Idle. Attempts to increase pressure above this point typically results in Clutch Plate lock-up. Page5-27 SET UP The available Values are to percent of the the maximum current available. The Default Value is %. The Value selected must be at least 20% above or below (Normal/Inverse) the Troll Minimum Pressure selected. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. B) Scroll to Function Code L3. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the appropriate Value for the Trolling Valve. E) Store the Value to memory 20.0 100.0 25.0 L2 Figure 5-56: Function NOTE: Display LED L3 Set Up Activated O NOT MAKE ANY ADJUSTMENTS TO FUNCTION CODES L5 AND L6 UNTIL THE VESSEL HAS BEEN SEA-TRIALED AND FUNCTION CODES L0, L1, L2, L3, AND L4 HAVE BEEN PROPERLY ADJUSTED. D OR INTEGRATED TROLL DETAILED INSTRUCTIONS ON THE ADJUSTMENT OF L5 CAN BE FOUND IN ECTION 5-6.4.1.6 PAGE 5-33. THE ADJUSTMENT OF INTEGRATED SOLENOID TROLL L6 CAN BE FOUND IN THE FOLLOWING SECTION 5-6.5.4.4, FUNCTION CODE L6 – TROLL PULSE PERCENTAGE. F S 5-6.5.4.4 Function Code L6 – Troll Pulse Percentage This Function Code selects the percentage of maximum available current applied to the proportional solenoid when first engaging the Clutch while in Troll. The available Values for this Function are % to % and the default Value is %. The Value is automatically changed to the same Value selected with Function Code Troll Maximum Pressure. To determine, and if required, change the Value (Refer to Sections 5-2 and 5-3, page 5-5): A) With Troll selected, move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. 00.0 100.0 25.0 L3 • Figure 5-57: Display LED Function L2 Set Up Activated If the vessel lunges forward or the shaft takes too long to start rotating, continue with the next step. B) Scroll to Function Code L6. C) Activate Set Up Mode. D) Scroll Up or Down to the desired Value. E) Store the Value to memory 5-6.5.5 Troubleshooting Functions 5-6.5.1 Basic Processor Troubleshooting Functions 5-6.5.1.1 Function Code H0 - Diagnostics 5-6.5.1.2 Function Code H1 – Return to Factory Defaults This Function is used during troubleshooting and is explained in detail in Section B-1.5, page B-7. Page5-28 SET UP This Function may be used during troubleshooting. (Do not make any adjustments to this Function Code, unless directed to do so by ZF Mathers Service or Engineering Departments). 5-6.5.2 Additional 9000 Series Troubleshooting Function 5-6.5.2.1 NOTE: Function Code H2 - Driver Fault Detection Enable The H2 Function is available only on Processors with integrated Clutch and/or Troll Solenoids (i.e. 9120, 9121, 9122, and 9221). The Processor can be programmed to monitor the current flow through the clutch and/or Troll solenoids. When this option is selected, if the current level is too high or too low, an alarm is sounded and an Error Code is produced. Table 5-1: lists the required value that needs to be entered to monitor the Ahead, Astern, Neutral, Troll Command, and Troll ON/OFF solenoids. UNCTION CODES 32 THROUGH 63 ARE RESERVED FOR FUTURE EXPANSION AND SHOULD NOT BE USED AT THIS TIME. F Table 5-1: Solenoid Error Status Enable Ahead 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Astern 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 Neutral 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Troll Command 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Page5-29 Troll On/Off 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Value 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 DOCK TRIALS 6 DOCK TRIALS WARNING: IT IS IMPERATIVE THAT THE INFORMATION PROVIDED IN THE PREVIOUS SECTIONS HAS BEEN READ AND FOLLOWED PRECISELY, PRIOR TO ATTEMPTING A DOCK TRIAL. CAUTION: With I/O or Outboard applications, do not attempt to shift into or out of gear with engines stopped. This may cause a jam condition or damage to the linkage to some clutch configurations. NOTE: ON TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, THE FOLLOWING TESTS MUST BE PERFORMED ON BOTH SIDES. IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING TESTS FAIL, CONSULT APPENDIX B TROUBLESHOOTING. 6-1 ONTROL HEADS (ENGINES STOPPED) C A) Turn power ON to the Control System. B) The Control Head at each Remote Station should produce an intermittent tone. C) Perform each of the following steps on all Remote Stations. 1. Move the Control Head’s lever(s) full Ahead and full Astern. Ensure that there are no obstructions to the movement, the Processor reacts to the lever movement, and that no tones are generated. 2. Place the Control Head’s lever(s) in the Neutral position. 3. Depress and hold the Station transfer button while moving the Control Head’s lever(s) to the Ahead detent. Release the transfer button. • The red LED on the Control Head should blink, indicating Warm-up Mode has been entered. Warm-up Mode only operates in the Ahead direction. 6-2 TART INTERLOCK (ENGINES STOPPED) S A) Turn the Processor DC power OFF. • Verify that the engine(s) will not start. B) Turn Processor DC power ON. Do not take command at a Remote Station. • Verify that the engine(s) will not start. C) Take command at a Remote Station. Place the Control Head’s lever(s) to approximately 50% of the throttle range. • Verify that the engine(s) will not start. D) Place the Control Head’s lever(s) in the Neutral/Idle position. Take command at a Remote Station. • Verify that the engine(s) will start in this position. 6-3 NGINE STOP SWITCHES E Start the engine(s) and verify that the Stop switches (normally push buttons) function correctly at all Remote Stations. Page6-1 DOCK TRIALS USH-PULL CABLES 6-4 P 6-5 H 6-6 C 6-7 C A) Check that all Push-Pull cable connecting fasteners are tightened securely. B) In the Processor(s) check that the Push-Pull cable jam nuts are securely tightened. A loose hex nut can back off the Push-Pull cable threaded end and effectively change the cable length. IGH IDLE A) Place the Station in command into Warm-up Mode. B) Adjust Function Code E6 to the desired engine RPM, as described in Section 5-5.2.6.2, page 5-9. C) Return the Control Head’s lever to the Neutral/Idle position. ONTROL HEAD SERVO COMMAND A) Start the engine(s) and let them run at Neutral/Idle. B) Place one Control Head lever at a time into the Ahead detent, the Astern detent and then Neutral. Confirm that the push-pull cable movement is in the direction commanded. • If incorrect, perform the steps described in Section 5-5.2.7.6, page 5-10, for transmission push-pull. C) Place the Control System into Warm-Up Mode and confirm that there is control of speed. D) Run the throttle up to approximately 20% of the throttle range for at least 10 seconds. E) Return the lever to the Neutral/Idle position. F) Repeat steps A) thru E) at the remaining Control Head levers. ONTROL HEAD SOLENOID COMMAND A) Start the engine(s) and let them run at Neutral/Idle. B) Place one Control Head lever at a time into the Ahead detent, the Astern detent and then Neutral. Confirm that the movement of the vessel is in the correct direction. • If incorrect, reverse the electric cable connections at the shift solenoids. C) Place the Control System into Warm-Up Mode and confirm that there is control of speed. D) Run the throttle up to approximately 20% of the throttle range for at least 10 seconds. E) Return the lever to the Neutral/Idle position. F) Repeat steps A) thru E) at the remaining Control Head levers. Page6-2 DOCK TRIALS 6-8 HROTTLE PAUSE FOLLOWING SERVO SHIFT T NOTE: A TEST CONTROL HEAD AND A STOP-WATCH ARE RECOMMENDED TO DETERMINE THE CORRECT SETTING FOR THE THROTTLE PAUSE. IF A TEST CONTROL HEAD IS NOT AVAILABLE, A SECOND PERSON MAY BE NEEDED. A) Move the Station in command’s lever to the Ahead detent, while monitoring the Shaft. B) Start the stop-watch as soon as the Clutch Push-Pull cable stops moving. C) When the Shaft begins to rotate, stop the stop-watch. D) Record the time expired on the stop-watch. E) Program Function Code E5 as described in Section 5-5.2.6.1, page 5-8 . NOTE: IF THE TIME RECORDED IN SECTION 6-8, STEP D) EXCEEDS 5.0 SECONDS, A CLUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK IS REQUIRED. REFER TO SECTION 8-2, PAGE 8-2. 6-9 HROTTLE PAUSE FOLLOWING SOLENOID SHIFT T NOTE: A TEST CONTROL HEAD AND A STOP-WATCH ARE RECOMMENDED TO DETERMINE THE CORRECT SETTING FOR THE THROTTLE PAUSE. IF A TEST CONTROL HEAD IS NOT AVAILABLE, A SECOND PERSON MAY BE NEEDED. A) Move the Station in command’s lever to the Ahead detent, start the stop-watch while monitoring the Shaft. B) When the Shaft begins to rotate, stop the stop-watch. C) Record the time expired on the stop-watch. D) Program Function Code E5 as described in Section 5-6.2.1.1, page 5-10. NOTE: IF THE TIME RECORDED IN SECTION 6-9, STEP D) EXCEEDS 5.0 SECONDS, A CLUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK IS REQUIRED. REFER TO SECTION 8-2, PAGE 8-2. ROLLING VALVE 6-10 T WARNING: 6-10.1 Troll Servo Adjustments IT IS PREFERABLE TO ADJUST THE TROLLING VALVE DURING SEA TRIALS. HOWEVER, IN SOME CASES ADJUSTMENT OF TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE (L2) CAN BE ACCOMPLISHED WHILE AT THE DOCK. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO MAKE ANY TROLL ADJUSTMENTS UNLESS THE DOCK AND THE MOORING LINES ARE CAPABLE OF SECURING THE VESSEL WITH FULL THRUST FROM AT LEAST ONE SCREW. A) Verify that the Troll Push-pull cable is positioned at the Full Pressure (Lock-up) position. B) If connected, disconnect the push-pull cable from the Trolling Valve lever. C) Secure the Troll lever using wire or rope so that the position cannot change due to vibration or if accidentally bumped. Page6-3 DOCK TRIALS NOTE: 6-10.1.1 Troll Minimum Pressure Adjustment at the Dock HE GEAR OIL MUST REACH NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE BEFORE THE TROLLING VALVE CAN BE ACCURATELY ADJUSTED. THE ADJUSTMENT OF THE MINIMUM PRESSURE POINT MUST BE DONE ONE SCREW AT A TIME WHEN TIED TO A DOCK. T A) Verify that the Troll push-pull cable is positioned at the Full Pressure (lock-up) position. B) With the engine running, place the Station-in-Command’s lever into the Ahead Detent. C) Measure the Shaft RPM at Idle with a Shaft Tach and record on Table 6-1: Table 6-1: Shaft RPM at Idle Port Starboard D) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral detent. • If connected, disconnect the push-pull cable from the Trolling Valve lever. E) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. F) Manually position the Troll lever to the point where the Shaft rotation is 30 to 50% of that measured in Table 6-1: above. G) If not previously selected, enable Troll with Function Code L0. H) Depress the Transfer Button until the red LED begins blinking rapidly (approximately 2 seconds). I) Scroll to Function Code L2 (Troll Minimum Pressure) and activate Set Up Mode. J) Scroll Up or Down until the Push-pull cable aligns with the troll lever. K) Store the Value to Memory. L) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral Detent. M)Repeat steps A) thru L) on the opposite side if required. 6-10.2 Troll Solenoid Adjustments WARNING: IT IS PREFERABLE TO ADJUST THE TROLLING VALVE DURING SEA TRIALS. HOWEVER, IN SOME CASES ADJUSTMENT OF TROLL MINIMUM PRESSURE (L2) CAN BE ACCOMPLISHED WHILE AT THE DOCK. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO MAKE ANY TROLL ADJUSTMENTS UNLESS THE DOCK AND THE MOORING LINES ARE CAPABLE OF SECURING THE VESSEL WITH FULL THRUST FROM AT LEAST ONE SCREW. 6-10.2.1 Troll Minimum Pressure Adjustment at the Dock NOTE: HE GEAR OIL MUST REACH NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE BEFORE THE TROLLING VALVE CAN BE ACCURATELY ADJUSTED. THE ADJUSTMENT OF THE MINIMUM PRESSURE POINT MUST BE DONE ONE SCREW AT A TIME WHEN TIED TO A DOCK. T A) Verify that the appropriate Value is selected with Function Code L1 (Trolling Valve Function) for the Gear. B) Connect a Service Field Test Unit in-line with the Clutch Harness and Pigtail as shown in Appendix B, MM13927 Rev.C 4/03 Service Field Test Unit Manual. Page6-4 DOCK TRIALS C) With the engine running, place the Station-in-Command’s lever into the Ahead Detent. D) Measure the Shaft RPM at Idle with a Shaft Tach and record on Table 6-1:. Table 6-2: Shaft RPM at Idle Port Starboard E) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral detent. F) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. G) Manually position the Troll lever to the point where the Shaft rotation is 30 to 50% of that measured in Table 6-1: above. H) If not previously selected, enable Troll with Function Code L0. I) Depress the Transfer Button until the red LED begins blinking rapidly (approximately 2 seconds). J) Scroll to Function Code L2 (Troll Minimum Pressure) and activate Set Up Mode. K) Scroll Up or Down until the push-pull cable aligns with the troll lever. L) Store the Value to Memory. M)Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral Detent. N) Repeat steps A) thru M) on the opposite side if required. Page6-5 SEA TRIALS 7 SEA TRIALS WARNING: IT IS IMPERATIVE THAT THE INFORMATION PROVIDED IN THE PREVIOUS SECTIONS HAS BEEN READ AND FOLLOWED PRECISELY, PRIOR TO ATTEMPTING A SEA TRIAL. IF ANY OF THE FOLLOWING TESTS FAIL, DISCONTINUE THE SEA TRIAL IMMEDIATELY AND RETURN TO THE DOCK. CONSULT APPENDIX B TROUBLESHOOTING SECTION OR A ZF FACILITY PRIOR TO RESUMING THE SEA TRIAL. NOTE: N TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, THE FOLLOWING TESTS MUST BE PERFORMED ON BOTH SIDES. URING THE COURSE OF THE DOCK TRIAL AND SEA TRIALS, FILL OUT THE TRIAL REPORT. RETAIN THIS INFORMATION FOR FUTURE USE. O D ULL SPEED SETTING - SERVO THROTTLE 7-11 F A) Warm-up the engine(s) and transmission(s) and slowly move into open water. B) Gradually move the lever(s) to Full speed. C) If synchronization is installed, disable synchronization as explained in Section 2-10.4, page 2-7. • If the engine RPM is low, check whether the engine throttle lever is against the full speed stop. • If the engine RPM is high, decrease by using Function Code E3, as explained in Section 5-6.2.2.3, page 5-17. D) For twin screw applications, check that matching Idle, Midrange and Full speed Control Head lever positions cause equal RPM in both engines. • If RPM’s do not match, check push-pull cable travel. If travel does not match when the Control Head levers are side by side, adjust Function Code E3 Throttle Maximum, refer to Section 5-6.2.2.3, page 5-17. ULL SPEED SETTING - ELECTRONIC THROTTLE 7-12 F A) Warm-up the engine(s) and transmission(s) and slowly move into open water. B) Gradually move the lever(s) to Full speed. C) If synchronization is installed, disable synchronization as explained in Section 5-6.2.1.5, page 5-16. • If the engine RPM is low, refer to Appendix B, MM13927 Rev.C 4/ 03 Service Field Test Unit Manual. • If the engine RPM is high, decrease by using Function Code E3, as explained in Section 5-6.2.3.3, page 5-20. D) For twin screw applications, check that matching Idle, Midrange and Full speed Control Head lever positions cause equal RPM in both engines. Page7-1 SEA TRIALS ROPORTIONAL PAUSE 7-13 P The proportional pause feature provides engine deceleration when making a direction change. The pause is variable and in proportion to: • The Control Head’s lever position prior to the reversal. • How long the Control Head’s lever has been in that position prior to the reversal. The pause is In-Gear or at Neutral, depending on the Function Code C2 Proportional Pause setting. The sequence of events, are as follows for the three different Reversal Pause types: 7-13.1 In-Gear Delay [C200] • The Throttle position drops to Idle. • The Transmission remains engaged in Ahead or Astern. • The Control System pauses at this position until the delay has timed out. • The Transmission shifts to the opposite gear (Astern or Ahead). • The Throttle position moves to the Control Head’s present lever position. 7-13.2 Neutral Delay [C201] • The Throttle position drops to Idle. • The Transmission shifts to Neutral. • The Control System pauses at this position until the delay has timed out. • The Transmission shifts to the opposite gear (Astern or Ahead). • The Throttle position moves to the Control Head’s present lever position. 7-13.3 Fixed Neutral Delay [C202] CAUTION: The Fixed Neutral Delay feature was added in order to accommodate Thruster Control installations. Damage to the drive train may occur when used for reverse reduction gear applications. • The Throttle drops to Idle. • The Transmission shifts to Neutral. • The Control System pauses at this position for the amount of time programmed (duration) with Function C3 Proportional Pause Time (regardless of prior throttle setting). • The Transmission shifts to the opposite gear (Port or Starboard) • The Throttle position moves to the Control Head’s present commanded position. Page7-2 SEA TRIALS 7-13.4 Calculating Proportional Pause Time C3 NOTE: THE PAUSE ON A THROUGH NEUTRAL SHIFT IS PROPORTIONAL TO THE SPEED COMMANDED AND THE TIME AT THAT SPEED. THE VALUES LISTED FOR FUNCTION CODE C3 , PROPORTIONAL PAUSE TIME, ARE THE MAXIMUM POSSIBLE DELAYS. WHEN SHIFTING FROM IDLE AHEAD TO IDLE ASTERN OR VICE-VERSA THE DELAY IS ZERO. THE TIME REQUIRED TO BUILD UP TO THE MAXIMUM PAUSE IS SIX TIMES THE VALUE SELECTED. IN ADDITION, IN ORDER TO BUILD UP TO THE MAXIMUM DELAY VALUE, THE SYSTEM MUST BE COMMANDING FULL THROTTLE. THE PAUSE WHEN SHIFTING FROM ASTERN TO AHEAD IS EITHER HALF OR THE SAME AS THE AHEAD TO ASTERN DELAY DEPENDING ON THE VALUE SELECTED FOR FUNCTION CODE C4 PROPORTIONAL PAUSE RATIO. NOTE: A STOP-WATCH IS REQUIRED TO ACCURATELY PROGRAM THE PROPORTIONAL PAUSE TIME. The amount of pause required is determined as follows: A) Place the Control Head lever(s) to the Full Ahead position. B) Leave the Control Head lever(s) at this position for whichever of the following two is longer: • Sixty seconds. • The vessel’s speed through the water reaches maximum. C) Quickly move the Control Head lever(s) to Ahead Idle or Neutral, (depending on Function Code C4 setting) while starting the stop-watch. D) When the engine(s) RPM reaches Idle and the vessel’s speed through the water is within two knots of the standard Idle Ahead speed, stop the stop-watch. E) Program Function Code C3, Proportional Pause Time, as described in MM9000-I Set Up Procedures, to the time expired on the stop-watch. 7-13.5 Testing The Proportional Pause CAUTION: It is critical that the Proportional Pause is tested as outlined below to ensure that it was properly programmed. Failure to do so could cause damage to the transmission. A) Position the boat in open water and slowly increase the Throttle to 25% of the speed range. B) Leave the Control Head lever(s) at this position for at least 60 seconds. C) Quickly move the Control Head lever(s) to Idle Astern. • The engine(s) RPM should drop to Idle. • The Clutch should stay engaged or shift to Neutral for 25% of the time selected with Function Code C3 Proportional Pause Time. • Once the time has expired, the Clutch should Shift to Astern. • The engine RPM will drop slightly when the Astern load is placed on the engine, but not to the point where it comes close to stalling. D) Increase the Throttle slightly until the vessel starts moving in the opposite direction. Page7-3 SEA TRIALS • If the engine stalled or came very close to stalling, increase the Value of Function Code C3 by one second. Repeat steps A) through C). • If the engine does not stall or come close to stalling, proceed with the next step. E) Repeat steps A) through D) with the Throttle at 50%, 75%, and 100% of the speed range. • If the engine stalls at any time, increase the Value of Function Code C3 by one second and repeat the steps A) through D) again. F) Once a Full Speed Reversal is successful without coming close to stalling, the Proportional Pause is properly adjusted. YNCHRONIZATION TEST (TWIN SCREW ONLY) 7-14 S 7-14.1 Equal Throttle Synchronization A) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 25% of the Throttle range. B) If previously disabled, enable the synchronization by depressing the transfer button for two seconds. • The green LED on the Control Head should illuminate, indicating synchronization. C) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. D) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 50% of the Throttle range. E) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. F) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 75% of the Throttle range. G) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. H) Move both Control Head levers side by side to 100% of the Throttle range. I) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. • While synchronized, if the tachometers have a greater than 1% difference at any engine RPM, Active Synchronization is recommended. 7-14.2 Active Synchronization A) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 25% of the Throttle range. B) If previously disabled, enable the synchronization by depressing the transfer button for two seconds. • The green LED on the Control Head may blink while driving toward synchronization. Page7-4 SEA TRIALS • Once the engine RPM’s are within 1% of one another, the green LED will remain solidly lit. C) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. D) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 50% of the Throttle range. E) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. F) Move both Control Head levers side by side to approximately 75% of the Throttle range. G) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. H) Move both Control Head levers side by side to 100% of the Throttle range. I) Check the engine tachometers to see if they are within 1% of one another. While synchronized, if the tachometers have a greater than 1% percent difference at any engine RPM, or if they appear to be continually “hunting” for the correct RPM, refer to the Appendix B, B9 Troubleshooting Section. 7-15 TROLLING VALVE ADJUSTMENTS 7-15.1 Integrated Servo Trolling 7-15.1.1 Enabling Troll Press and hold the Transfer Button for two seconds with the Control Head lever in the Neutral detent. • The Control Head’s red LED should begin blinking rapidly, indicating that Troll is enabled. • If not, refer to Section 5-6.4.1.4, page 5-29, Function Code L0 – Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Troll Range. NOTE: O NOT ATTEMPT THE FOLLOWING ADJUSTMENTS UNTIL THE GEAR OIL TEMPERATURE HAS REACHED A MINIMUM OF 140 DEGREES F (60 DEGREES C). D 7-15.1.2 Troll Minimum Pressure Adjustments (Function Code L2) A) The red LED should still be blinking rapidly. If not, enable troll. B) If connected, disconnect the Troll push-pull cable from the Troll selector lever. C) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. Page7-5 SEA TRIALS D) Using a Shaft Tach, measure the RPM of the Shaft and record on Table 7-1:. Table 7-1: Shaft RPM at Idle Port Starboard E) Manually move the Troll selector lever while periodically measuring the Shaft RPM. The typical Trolling Valve can be adjusted so that the Shaft is rotating a 30 to 50 percent of the RPM’s measured and recorded on Table 7-1: F) Once the desired RPM has been reached, scroll to Function Code L2. Adjust the Value as described in Section 5-6.4.2.2, page 5-33, until the Troll push-pull cable aligns with the Troll selector lever. G) Enter the Value into memory. H) Leave the push-pull cable disconnected. 7-15.1.3 Troll Maximum Pressure Adjustments (Function Code L3) A) Leave the Control Head lever in the Ahead detent with Troll enabled. B) Manually position the Troll selector lever while monitoring the Shaft RPM. The typical trolling valve can be adjusted to 70 to 80 percent of the RPM’s measured and recorded on Table 7-1:. C) Once the desired RPM has been reached, scroll to Function Code L3. Adjust the Value as described in Section 5-6.4.2.3, page 5-34, until the Troll push-pull cable aligns with the Troll selector lever. D) Enter the Value into memory. E) Connect the push-pull cable. NOTE: N TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, THE TROLL MINIMUM AND MAXIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS MUST BE DONE ONE SIDE AT A TIME INITIALLY. ONCE EACH TROLLING VALVE HAS BEEN ADJUSTED INDIVIDUALLY, THEY MUST BE OPERATED AS A PAIR AND ADJUSTED FURTHER, AS NECESSARY. O 7-15.2 Integrated Solenoid Trolling T IS STRONGLY RECOMMENDED THAT THE FIELD SERVICE TEST UNIT (P/N 1400) IS UTILIZED WHEN ADJUSTING THE PROPORTIONAL SOLENOID. NOTE: I The Values selected for Function Code L1 in Section 5-6.4.4.1, page 5-37, are approximations for the various types of Gears. The actual amount of current required for satisfactory troll operation may differ from the preset Values. Table 7-2: provides typical current requirements for some of the ZF Gears. As stated previously, the actual current required to provide satisfactory operation may differ slightly from those Page7-6 SEA TRIALS listed. Table 7-2: also lists the typical pressure range in bars during troll operation. The approach taken for adjusting the Trolling Valve may be based purely on Shaft RPM, where the preset is used and the Value is increased or decreased based on the Shaft RPM only. The most effective approach is to use a combination of the preset, Shaft RPM and the measurement of the current flowing to the proportional solenoid or pressure applied to the clutch plate. Regardless of which approach is used, always adjust the preset to the appropriate Value prior to adjusting the Troll Minimum and Troll Maximum Function Codes. L1 L1 L1 L2 Model Number ZF 25- 80 L3 Table 7-2: Troll Valve Adjustments Troll Current Minimum Maximum 12VDC- 900 mA. 24VDC- 450 mA. 12VDC- 1260 mA. 24VDC- 630 mA. ZF90- 110TS, 200 mA. 220- 311, 220A, 325, 350, 550 & 665 ZF600, 1900 160 mA. 300 mA. ZF2000 150 mA. 300 mA. ZF2500 175 mA. 350 mA. ZF4500- 7500 n/a 350 mA. n/a Troll Pressure Minimum Maximum Comments 1 Bar (15 PSI) 8 Bar (116 PSI) Main shift control valve is proportional. The Minimum & Maximum Troll currents listed are at lock-up. Exceeding the Maximum current may damage the solenoid. Current below the Minimum listed may damage the clutch pack when the engine rpm exceeds 1000. 1 Bar (15 PSI) 4 Bar (58PSI) One variable current control valve in addition to Ahead & Astern solenoids. Increased current equals increased pressure. 1 Bar (15 PSI) 6 Bar (87 PSI) Two Solenoids in addition to Ahead & Astern solenoids; one On/ Off, one variable current control valve. Increased current equals decreased pressure. The ZF1900 Gear may also be ordered with Auto-Troll, which is not supported by the 9000 Series Processors. 1 Bar (15 PSI) 4 Bar (58 PSI) Two Solenoids in addition to Ahead & Astern solenoids; one On/ Off, one variable current control valve. Increased current equals increased pressure. 1 Bar (15 PSI) 6 Bar (87 PSI) Two Solenoids in addition to Ahead & Astern solenoids; one On/ Off, one variable current control valve. Increased current equals decreased pressure. The ZF2500 Gear may also be ordered with Auto-Troll, which is not supported by the 9000 Series Processors. n/a n/a These series of Gears are available with Auto-Troll only and are not supported by the 9000 Series Processors. 7-15.2.1 Enabling Troll Press and hold the Transfer Button for two seconds with the Control Head lever in the Neutral detent • The Control Head’s red LED should begin blinking rapidly, indicating that troll is enabled. Page7-7 SEA TRIALS • If not, refer to Section 5-6.4.1.4, page 5-29, Function Code L0 – Troll Enable and Control Head Lever Troll Range. O NOT ATTEMPT THE FOLLOWING ADJUSTMENTS UNTIL THE GEAR OIL TEMPERATURE HAS REACHED A MINIMUM OF 140 DEGREES F (60 DEGREES C). NOTE: D NOTE: THE EFFECTS OF THE FOLLOWING ADJUSTMENTS ARE NOT IMMEDIATE. ALLOW ENOUGH TIME FOR THE SHAFT RPM TO STABILIZE BETWEEN ANY CHANGES TO THE L2 AND L3 VALUES. 7-15.2.2 Troll Minimum Pressure Adjustment (Function Code L2) A) Ensure that the Control Head lever is at the Neutral / Idle position. B) If the red LED is blinking rapidly, disable Troll by pressing the Transfer Button until the red LED becomes lit solid. C) Connect a Service Field Test Unit (P/N 14000) and Ammeter to the Troll Command Signal output as described in Section 2.3.2, page MM13927-16, of the Service Field Test Unit Manual in Appendix B. D) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. E) Using a Shaft Tach, measure the RPM of the Shaft and record. F) Depress and hold (approximately 2 seconds) the Transfer Button until the red LED starts blinking rapidly. G) Measure the Shaft RPM and record. H) Adjust the Value of Function Code L2 until the Shaft RPM is 30 to 50% of that measured in step E). I) Enter the new Value into memory. J) If twin screw application, repeat steps A) through H) on the opposite side. NOTE: ADJUST THE VALUE OF L2 BASED ON THE DESIRED VESSELS WATER SPEED OR SHAFT RPM. DO NOT BASE THE ADJUSTMENT ON THE RESPONSE TIME (HOW QUICKLY OR SLOWLY THE SHAFT BEGINS TO ROTATE AFTER SHIFTING FROM NEUTRAL TO AHEAD OR ASTERN). THE RESPONSE TIME MAY BE ADJUSTED LATER WITH FUNCTION CODES L5 AND L6. 7-15.2.3 Troll Maximum Pressure Adjustment (Function Code L3) A) Place one Control Head lever in the Ahead detent with Troll enabled. B) If twin screw, ensure that the opposite lever is at the Neutral/ Idle position. C) Scroll to Function Code L3 and enter Setup Mode as described in Section 5-2, page 5-5. D) Increase or decrease the Value until the Shaft RPM is 70 to 80% of that measured in step E), page 7-8, of Section 7-15.2.2. E) Enter the new Value into memory. Page7-8 SEA TRIALS F) If twin screw, repeat steps A) through E) on the opposite side. N TWIN SCREW APPLICATIONS, THE TROLL MINIMUM AND TROLL MAXIMUM PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS SHOULD BE DONE ONE SIDE AT A TIME INITIALLY. ONCE EACH TROLLING VALVE HAS BEEN ADJUSTED INDIVIDUALLY, THEY MUST BE OPERATED AS A PAIR AND ADJUSTED FURTHER, AS NECESSARY. NOTE: O 7-15.3 Troll Throttle Limit Adjustment (Function Code L4) CAUTION: Consult the Trolling Valve’s Installation Manual prior to programming any increased throttle above Idle, while slipping the Clutch. Failure to adhere to the Transmission manufactures directives may permanently damage the clutch pack and void the warranty. • The Value programmed for Function Code is a percentage of the throttle range. The Throttle Range is the difference between Throttle Maximum ( ) and Throttle Minimum ( ). • The maximum percentage of the Throttle Range which the Value can be set to is %. • The adjustment of this Function Code is a matter of personal preference. There is not set procedure which determines when increased throttle should be used and what percentage of the range it should be set to. 7-15.4 Troll Pulse Duration (Function Code ) & Troll Pulse Percentage (Function Code ) Adjustments Whenever Troll is enabled (red LED blinking rapidly) and the Control Head lever is moved from Neutral/Idle to the Ahead or Astern detent, the current to the Proportional Solenoid is delivered at a value which causes a higher clutch pressure for a set period of time. The period of time where the higher pressure is commanded is adjustable with this Function. The default Value of seconds has been found to be adequate with most applications. However, if the shaft takes unreasonably long to begin rotating, or if an excessive surge is felt when commanding Ahead with Troll selected, the amount of time that the higher pressure is commanded may be adjusted with the Troll Pulse Duration Function. The Troll Pulse Percentage’s Value automatically changes to the same Value selected with Troll Maximum (Function Code ). As with Troll Pulse Duration, experience has showed us that commanding this higher clutch pressure is adequate in most applications. In the event that the shaft takes unreasonably long to begin to rotate, or an excessive surge is produced every time Ahead is commanded with Troll, the Value can be increased or decreased. When the need to adjust these Values arises, it is recommended that small adjustments to each of these Functions are made instead of one large adjustment to one or the other. After each small adjustment, test the vessel’s response prior to making further adjustments. L4 E3 E2 20 L5 L6 00.6 L3 Page7-9 SEA TRIALS 7-15.5 Integrated ZF-Hurth Solenoid Trolling T IS STRONGLY RECOMMENDED THAT THE FIELD SERVICE TEST UNIT (P/N 1400) IS UTILIZED WHEN ADJUSTING THE ZF-HURTH SOLENOID. NOTE: I 7-15.5.1 Enabling ZF-Hurth Troll A) Ensure Function Code (Shift Solenoid Type) value is set to or (refer to Section 5-6.3.3.1, page 5-27) B) Place the Control System into Troll Mode by pressing and holding the transfer button for approximately 2 seconds, until the red LED begins blinking rapidly. C) Move the Control Head lever into the Ahead Detent. 7-15.5.2 Troll Maximum Current Adjustment Ensure that the current to the Ahead and Astern Solenoids do not exceed the current rating of the Solenoid. A) This is accomplished by connecting an amp meter in series with the Ahead and then the Astern solenoid signal. B) Place the Control Head lever into the Ahead and the Astern detent without Troll selected (Control Head red LED lit solid). C) Adjust Function Code for Ahead and for Astern as described in Sections 5-6.3.3.2, page 5-28, and 56.3.3.3, page 5-28. C5 01 02 . C6 Page7-10 C7 SEA TRIALS EA TRIAL REPORT 7-16 S The purpose of this Sea Trial Report is to provide a convenient checklist and record of installation, dock trial set up, and sea trial performance of the ZF Mathers Propulsion Control System. Please enter ALL of the information. We recommend that this form remains aboard the vessel, and a copy is sent to ZF Mathers with the Warranty Registration located at the end of this manual. 7-16.1 Vessel Information Vessel Name: Vessel Type: Installing Yard/ Project Manager: Owner/Owner’s Representative:: ENGINE DATA: Make: PROPELLER DATA: No. of Screws: GEAR DATA: Make: Hull No. Trial Date: Dwg No.: Tel: Model: Propeller Type: Fixed Model: No. of Remote Stations: Locations: Tel:: HP (KW): Othe r 1. 2. 5. 3. 4. RPM: Ratio: 7-16.2 Control System Checks Make the following checks prior to applying power to the Processor. PORT STARBOARD _________________ _________________ Processor Mounting Location: YES NO YES NO YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES NO NO NO NO NO NO NO NO YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES NO NO NO NO NO NO NO NO YES YES NO NO YES YES NO NO Power Supply: What is the source of Processor power and how is it charged? YES NO YES NO Processor Serial Numbers Is the Processor subject to excessive heat? (Above 70 degrees C) At least 4 feet (1,2m) from strong magnetic fields? Accessible for checkout, adjustments, and maintenance? Are the Processors bonded (grounded)? Are all Electric Cables supported every 18 inches (45,72cm)? Do the push-pull cables travel in the correct direction? Is the amount of push-pull cable travel set properly? Are all of the push-pull cable’s fasteners tightened? Are the electrical cable connections tight at the Processors and Control Heads? Is the Processor’s Start Interlock Circuit being used? Is there an Engine Stop Switch installed at each Remote Station? _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________ Is there a backup power supply? APS or other, explain. _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ _______________________________________________________ Page7-11 SEA TRIALS YES PORT NO YES YES NO YES At the Battery ____________ VDC At the Battery ____________ VDC At the Battery ____________ VDC At the Processor ____________ VDC At the Processor ____________ VDC At the Processor ____________ VDC At the Battery ____________ VDC At the Battery ____________ VDC At the Battery ____________ VDC Dock Trials: PORT YES NO YES YES YES NO STARBOARD NO Are the power cables protected by 10 Ampere Circuit Breakers? NO If separate power supplies are used for the Port and Starboard Processors, do they have a common ground? At the Processor What is the Voltage when not being charged? ____________ VDC At the Processor What is the Voltage when connected to Shore Power? ____________ VDC At the Processor What is the Voltage when the engines are running? ____________ VDC STARBOARD NO NO YES NO YES NO RPM__________________ RPM__________________ YES NO YES NO YES NO RPM__________________ RPM__________________ YES NO Sea Trials: PORT RPM__________________ YES NO STARBOARD RPM__________________ YES NO Does the engine start when the Control System is turned OFF? Does the Engine Stop Switch function at all Stations, regardless of RPM? Can all Remote Stations take command? Does the Warm-up Indicator Light blink in Ahead? What is the Low Idle RPM? High Idle RPM (optional) Does the vessel surge forward with Control Head lever in the Ahead Detent? What is the Full Throttle RPM? Do the Dual Control Head levers match position and RPM throughout the speed range? Seconds__________________ Seconds__________________ The Full Speed Reversal Delay is set for how many seconds? YES NO YES NO Is Synchronization operational? Station 1 Station 2 Station 1 Station 2 What is the length of the Control Head Harness? ____________ ____________ ____________ ____________ Station 3 Station 4 Station 3 Station 4 ____________ ____________ ____________ ____________ Station 5 Station 5 ____________ ____________ 7-16.3 Record Parameters Record information onto the following appropriate Processor Parameter Table only after ALL information has been recorded in Section 7-16.2 Control System Checks Page7-12 SEA TRIALS Table 7-3: Processor Parameters Record Function Code Function Name Port Stbd PROCESSOR FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.1, page 5-8) A0 Processor Identification A1 Number of Engines A2 One Lever Operation A3 SE (Station Expander) A4 Neutral Indication Tone THROTTLE FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.2, page 5-14) E0 Engine Throttle Profile OR Throttle Servo Direction E1 Throttle in Neutral E2 Throttle Minimum E3 Throttle Maximum E4 Throttle Maximum Astern E5 Throttle Pause Following Shift E6 High Idle E7 Synchronization CLUTCH FUNCTIONS (Section 5-6.3, page 5-21) C0 Clutch Pressure Interlock C1 Clutch Interlock Delay C2 Proportional Pause C3 Proportional Pause Time C4 Proportional Pause Ratio C5 Shift Solenoid Type OR Clutch Servo Direction C6 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Ahead OR Clutch Ahead C7 ZF-Hurth Duty Cycle Astern OR Clutch Astern TROLL FUNCTIONS (Only Available and Displayed When P/N 9001 Troll Actuator Is Connected To The Processor OR when L0 is programmed to a value other then 0 with integrated troll (Section 5-6.4, page 5-29) L0 Troll Enable and Control Head Troll Lever Range L1 Troll Valve Function OR Troll Servo Direction L2 Troll Minimum Pressure L3 Troll Maximum Pressure L4 Troll Throttle Limit L5 Troll Pulse Duration L6 Troll Pulse Percentage Page7-13 SEA TRIALS 7-16.4 Comments (Please use additional paper as necessary): 7-16.4.1 General Installation Condition 7-16.4.2 Any Irregularities: INSPECTOR_______________________________________________ DATE_________________ Page7-14 CONTROL OPTIONS 8 CONTROL OPTIONS 8-1 EXTERNAL ALARM CAPABILITY CAUTION: The Processor’s Alarm circuit is limited to a maximum current of 0.5 Amperes and a maximum voltage of 100 Volts DC. Exceeding these limits will permanently damage the Alarm circuit. The Processor comes equipped with a normally open relay contact for connection to an external Status Indication circuit. The relay energizes, closing the contact when the Circuit Board has power applied and the software program is running normally. In the event of a power loss or the software program detects an anomaly, the relay de-energizes and the contact opens. 1 SOLENOIDS Figure 8-1: External Alarm Connections with Processor Harness Example PB2 1 2 START 5 TB6 6 7 4 3 8 5 TB11 6 ALARM 7 4 8 3 2 INTERLOCK 6 + POWER J3 7 STATION1 8 PB1 1 OPI 2 AUTOTROLL 3 1 2 3 2 CLUTCH 1 4 TB2 5 Figure 8-2: External Alarm Connections Processor Hard-Wired Example Page8-1 CONTROL OPTIONS 8-1.1 Installation (Refer to Figure 8-1: or Figure 8-2:) The following items should be considered when designing and installing the Status Indication Panel: • The Power Wire Harness (p/n 13631-#) must be used if an Exter- nal Alarm is required. • The Processor’s Alarm Circuit uses a “dry” contact. Therefore, the polarity of the conductors is not a concern. • The External Status Indication Circuit must not use the same power source as the Processor. • Since the External Status Indication Circuit is activated on a loss of power to the Processor, an On/Off Switch is strongly recommended. • Figure 8-1: and Figure 8-2: are an example of a suitable circuit, but not necessarily the only circuit acceptable . A) Plug the Power Wire Harness into the Processor’s Power pigtail. B) Run the two-conductor Alarm cable to the location of the Status Indication Circuit. C) Connect the black and red conductors to the Status Indication Circuit as shown in Figure 8-1: or Figure 8-2:. LUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK 8-2 NOTE: C T HE CLUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK C0 MUST BE SET TO BE USED. REFER TO THE SECTION 5PAGE 5-12, FOR FUNCTION CODE C0 – CLUTCH PRESSURE INTERLOCK 5.3.8.9, The Clutch Pressure Interlock uses a Pressure Switch which monitors the Ahead and Astern Clutch pressures. The Pressure Switch must have a Normally Open (N.O.) contact that closes when adequate Clutch pressure is reached. The primary function of the Interlock is to prevent high engine RPM when the Clutch is not fully engaged. The Interlock option must be selected with Function Code C0. There are two selectable methods of operation as described below: 8-2.1 C0 Methods of Operation 8-2.1.1 01 - Installed When selected, the Interlock will command the Throttle to Idle, if low or a loss of pressure occurs while cruising. The Interlock is activated when the Pressure Switch’s contact opens for the minimum period of time selected with Function Code C1. If adequate Clutch pressure is not reached in the time programmed in Function Code E5, throttle will be allowed to increase above Idle. The Throttle will remain at this commanded speed for the time programmed in Function Code C1 and then returned to Idle, unless adequate pressure is reached during this time. Page8-2 CONTROL OPTIONS The Throttle will remain at Idle until the Control Head’s lever is returned to Idle, the Pressure Switch contact closes and a speed command above Idle is commanded. 8-2.1.2 02 - Throttle Clutch Pressure Interlock This option is typically selected when the Clutch takes longer than five seconds to reach full pressure. The Throttle will remain at Idle until there is a closure of the Pressure Switch’s contact. This prevents speeds above Idle prior to full Clutch engagement. In the event of a loss of Clutch pressure while cruising, the Throttle will be returned to Idle after the time selected with Function Code C1 has expired. Once a closure of the Switch is sensed, indicating adequate pressure, the Throttle immediately returns to the commanded signal, without having to return the Control Head lever to Idle first, as is the case with Value 01. To External Status Indication Circuit Hydraulic Line Processor Pressure Switch Shuttle Valve To Processor DC Power Source Ahead Clutch Pack Power Power Wire Pigtail Harness 12281 To Starter Solenoid Astern Clutch Pack Figure 8-3: Clutch Pressure Switch with Processor Harness Diagram 1 PB 2 2 STA RT INT ERLO CK 8 TB6 7 5 A LARM 6 4 3 1 OP I 2 7 STA TION 1 8 6 5 4 2 CLUT CH 3 1 TB 1 P2 TB 3 7 S TATI ON 3 8 6 5 TB8 2 EL EC-THR 3 1 8 3 4 5 6 7 4 J1 S ERIAL 5 4 TB7 3 2 J MP 1 DS 2 TB5 P1 1 STATI ON 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 6 1 2 7 8-3 DS 1 Figure 8-4: Clutch Pressure Switch with Processor Hard-Wired Diagram STATION EXPANDER (SE) 8-3.1 Installation The installation of the Clutch Pressure Switch is the same for both methods of operation. (Refer to Figure 8-3: or Figure 8-4:) Page8-3 CONTROL OPTIONS A) Install a Shuttle Valve on or near the Transmission. B) Connect hydraulic line from the Ahead and Astern Clutches. C) Connect a hydraulic line that is no longer than 5 feet (1,524m)and at approximately the same height between the Shuttle Valve and the Pressure Switch. D) Connect the Power Wire Harness’s Clutch Pressure Interlock cable to the Pressure Switch’s normally open contact. E) Calibrate the Pressure Switch to close when adequate Clutch Pressure is reached. (Refer to the Transmission manufactures Installation Manual) The Processor allows up to five Remote Stations. The SE allows up to an additional four Remote Stations for a total of nine Stations. The SE and Processor communicate via the Serial Communication cable. Control Heads connected to the SE offer all of the functionality of a standard Remote Station. For detailed information on the operation, installation and adjustment of the SE, refer to the Station Expander Installation Manual supplied with the Expander. 8-4 9001 ACTUATOR TROLLING VALVE CONTROL Most Marine Transmissions offer an optional Trolling Valve. A Trolling Valve controls the amount of pressure applied to the Clutch Plate. By doing so, the speed of the propeller can be reduced without decreasing engine RPM. The Processor allows the operator to control, with a single lever, the Trolling Valve, Clutch and Throttle. In order to do so, a separate Trolling Actuator [p/n 9001] must be installed. The Trolling Actuator and the main Processor(s) communicate with one another via the Serial Communication cable. The Trolling Actuator contains two Servos, which allows the control of two Trolling Valves with a single Actuator. This option is available only for Processors that do not have Integrated Servo or Solenoid Trolling. For detailed information on the operation, installation and adjustment of the Trolling Actuator, refer to the Trolling Actuator Installation Manual supplied with the Actuator. Page8-4 PERIODIC CHECKS AND MAINTENANCE 9 PERIODIC CHECKS AND MAINTENANCE The items listed below should be checked on an annual basis or less, when noted: 9-1 9-2 ONTROL HEADS C • Check the terminal strip for signs of corrosion or a loose connection. • If used, disconnect the Deutsch connector and check the pins and sockets for signs of moisture and corrosion. ROCESSOR P • Check all terminal connections for signs of corrosion or loose connections. • Un-plug and inspect all Deutsch connectors for signs of moisture or corrosion. • While in the vicinity of the Processor, move the Station-in-Command’s lever. If the Servo’s are excessively noisy, apply a light coating of silicone grease to the stainless steel lead screws. If there are no Stations in close proximity to the Processor(s), use a Field Service Control Head or have someone assist. 9-2.1 Throttle Servo Processor • Check mechanical connections within the Processor and at the Throttle selector lever. • Check the mechanical movement of the Throttle lever from Idle to Full. Ensure that the cable does not bind while positioning the Throttle at Idle or Full speed. 9-3 9-2.2 Clutch Servo Processor 9-2.3 Troll Integrated Servo Processor • Check mechanical connections within the Processor and at the Transmission selector lever. • Check the mechanical movement of the Clutch selector lever from Neutral to Ahead, and Neutral to Astern. Ensure that the cable does not bind while positioning the Control Head lever at Ahead or Astern. Ensure that the Clutch selector lever and the Push-Pull cable form a 90 degree angle at Neutral. • Check mechanical connections within the Processor and at the Troll selector levers. • Check the mechanical movement of the Troll selector lever from Lock-up to Minimum pressure and back to Lock-up. Ensure that the cable moves smoothly and does not bind while positioning the Control Head lever. OWER SUPPLY P 9-3.1 Battery WARNING: BATTERIES CONTAIN SULFURIC ACID AND EMIT HYDROGEN GAS WHILE CHARGING. THEREFORE, SPECIFIC SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MUST BE ADHERED TO WHILE HANDLING AND SERVICING. SPECIFIC INFORMATION ON HANDLING AND SERVICING BATTERIES CAN BE OBTAINED FROM THE BATTERY COUNCIL INTERNATIONAL, BATTERY SERVICE MANUAL. Page9-1 PERIODIC CHECKS AND MAINTENANCE CAUTION: In many newer batteries, the vent cap is permanently attached, preventing access to the electrolyte for water level and specific gravity tests. Attempting to pry off these caps could result in premature battery failure. The following tests should be performed in the intervals specified: 9-3.1.1 Quarterly (Every 3 Months) • Check the level of the water (electrolyte) within the Lead-Acid batteries. The plates must be covered. If not, add a small amount of distilled water. • Check the voltage of the battery. The battery must have a chance to “rest” (no charging and no load for a couple of hours) prior to testing. The following table represents a fully charged battery: Table 9-1: Fully Charged Battery Lead Acid Batteries 12V – 12.6 TO 12.8V 24V – 25.2 TO 25.6V Gel Cell or AGM Batteries 12V – 12.4 TO 12.6V 24V – 25.0 TO 25.4V • Check the battery terminals for signs of corrosion, acid buildup or loose connections. 9-3.1.2 Semi-Annually (Every 6 Months) • Check the specific gravity of your Lead-Acid battery(s) with a Hydrometer. The reading for a fully charged lead acid battery is 1.260 to 1.280. 9-3.1.3 Annually (Every 12 Months) WARNING: THE BATTERY LOAD TEST SHOULD BE PERFORMED BY A QUALIFIED MARINE ELECTRICIAN ONLY. The tests performed on quarterly and semi-annual basis, give a relatively good indication of the batteries’ health. However, the only way to accurately determine the actual health of your battery is to perform a Battery Load Test. • There are two types of Battery Load Tests performed in the field, Performance and Service. In order to determine the actual health of your battery a Performance Load Test is recommended. The Service Load Test determines how well your battery performs in the boat and doesn’t take into account the battery’s original rating, which could result in misleading results. The Performance Load Test places an accurate load on the battery and compares the results to the battery manufacture’s specification. The battery should be replaced if the results are 80% or less than the manufacture specifications. 9-3.2 Power Cables, Distribution Panels, etc. • Check all of the connections from the battery to the DC Distribution Panel to the APS for loose or corroded connections. • Measure the voltage at the battery and at the Processor while the Clutch or Throttle Servo is driving. There should be no Page9-2 PERIODIC CHECKS AND MAINTENANCE more than 10% difference between these two points. If so, check all devices and connections for excessive voltage drop. NOTE: IF AN APS IS USED IN THE CIRCUIT TO SUPPLY POWER TO THE PROCESSOR, ACCOUNT FOR THE 0.7V DROP ACROSS THE APS. EXAMPLE: 12.6V @ BATTERY – 1.26V (10% DROP) – 0.7V (APS DROP) = 10.64V (MINIMUM ALLOWABLE VOLTAGE) Page9-3 APPENDIX A PARTS LIST PART NO. DESCRIPTION PROCESSORS (X represents number of remote stations) 9120 X 9121 X 9122 X 9210 X 9211 X 9221 X 9001 X Processor (mechanical throttle, solenoid shift) Processor (mechanical throttle, solenoid shift, mechanical troll) Processor (mechanical throttle, solenoid shift, solenoid troll) Processor (electronic throttle, mechanical shift) Processor (electronic throttle, mechanical shift, mechanical troll) Processor (electronic throttle, solenoid shift, mechanical troll) Actuator (mechanical troll) Multi-voltage Multi-voltage Multi-voltage Multi-voltage Multi-voltage Multi-voltage Multi-voltage CONTROL HEADS SINGLE SCREW 450-3L or 3R Left or Right Control Head, 'T' Lever 453-3L or 3R Left or Right Control Head, Chrome Knob Lever 455-3L or 3R Left or Right Control Head, Black Low Profile Lever 456-3L or 3R Left or Right Control Head, Chrome Low Profile Lever 456-3LP or 3RP Left or Right Control Head, Chrome Low Profile Lever, Pluggable 521-4L or 4R Left or Right Control Head, Single Lever Tournament Style - Aluminum 521-4LB or 4RB Left or Right Control Head, Single Lever Tournament Style - Aluminum, Junction Box 521-5L or 4R Left or Right Control Head, Single Lever Tournament Style - Chrome 521-5LB or 4RB Left or Right Control Head, Single Lever Tournament Style - Chrome, Junction Box 750-L or –R Left or Right Control Head, Heavy Duty MC2000-1L or 1R Left or Right Black Control Head, Black Lever MC2000-2L or 2R Left or Right Chrome Control Head, Chrome Lever MC2000-4L or 4R Left or Right Black Control Head, Chrome Lever MC2000-4LP or 4RP Left or Right Black Control Head, Chrome Lever, Pluggable MC2000-5L or 5R Left or Right Black Control Head, Gold Lever TWIN SCREW (Synchronization Indication) 460-4 460-4P 463-4 463-4P 464-4 465-4 466-4 522-4 522-4B 522-5 522-5B 760 760P MC2000-1 MC2000-1P MC2000-2 MC2000-2P MC2000-3 MC2000-4 MC2000-4P MC2000-5 Control Head, 'T' Lever Control Head, 'T' Lever, Pluggable Control Head, Chrome Knob Lever Control Head, Chrome Knob Lever, Pluggable Control Heads, Split, with Single Levers, Chrome Knobs (pair) Control Head, Black Low Profile Lever Control Head, Chrome Low Profile Lever Control Head, Dual Lever Tournament Style - Aluminum Control Head, Dual Lever Tournament Style - Aluminum, Junction Box Control Head, Dual Lever Tournament Style - Chrome Control Head, Dual Lever Tournament Style - Chrome, Junction Box Control Head, Heavy Duty Control Head, Heavy Duty, Pluggable Black Head, Black Levers Black Head, Black Levers, Pluggable Chrome Head, Chrome Levers Chrome Head, Chrome Levers, Pluggable Gold Head, Gold Levers Black Head, Chrome Levers Black Head, Chrome Levers, Pluggable Black Head, Gold Levers Page A-1 CONTROL HEAD ADAPTER PADS (400 and MC2000 Series Only) 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 Pad Kit - white, blank Pad Kit - black, blank Pad Kit - teak, blank Pad Kit - white, machined Pad Kit -black, machined Pad Kit - teak, machined CABLE (Electric) 180 350 11811 212 349 183 355 8-Cond. Shielded Cable 8-Cond. Shielded Cable 8-Cond. Shielded Cable 2-Cond. Power Cable 2-Cond. Power Cable 2-Cond. Start Interlock Cable 2-Cond. Start Interlock Cable Per/ft. 500’ Spool 1000’ Spool Per/ft. 250’ Spool Per/ft. 250’ Spool WIRE HARNESS (Plug) Replace the # after the Part Number with the length of harness required. EXAMPLE: 13316-10; 1331620; 13316-30 13316-# 13432-# 13494-# 13533-# 14363-# 15027-# 15719-# 15732-# 15725-# 13239-# 13631-# 13552-# 13756-# 15023-# 13557-# 14261-# Serial Communication (Twin Screw) Throttle, Voltage Throttle, Current Throttle, PWM Throttle, MAN Throttle, Frequency Clutch – Ahead/Astern/Clutch Power Clutch – Ahead/Astern/Troll CMD Clutch – Ahead/Astern/Troll/Troll CMD Magnetic Pickup or Pulse Transmitter Power/Start Interlock/Clutch Pressure/Alarm Circuit Power/Start Interlock/Clutch Pressure Power/Start Interlock Power Control Head - 1 Connector Control Head - 2 Connectors TEST UNIT 13927 14000 Service Field Test Unit Field Test Control Head - Dual Page A-2 ZF Mathers, LLC MMC-280 Rev.K 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 8/03 400 Series Standard Control Head Variations This Service Sheet reflects all current variations of the standard 3-detent ZF Mathers 400 Series Control Heads. Part Numbering Configurations Detents Available REQUIREMENTS: MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) 8-Conductor Cable per Control Head lever. Pluggable MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. CruiseCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. Included with the Control Head: • Gasket • Mounting screws and washers • Terminals (For 8-Conductor or 1-Connector Harnesses) • Watertight cable grip for the cable entrance on the Processor (For 8-Conductor) When the Control Head is properly mounted on a console, it is spray proof from the top only. An adhesive gasket must be used to seal it to the mounting surface. However, below the mounting surface it needs protection from water or spray. Consider using a Weather Mount Enclosure, which is available from ZF Mathers. MOUNTING AND INSTALLATION: Select the desired mounting locations and make cutouts per template. Refer to the Dimensions Diagram. Check that the four mounting screws will start into the Control Head. Remove the Control Head from the cutout. Remove the backing from the adhesive gasket and apply the gasket adhesive side to the console around the cutout. Run cable/harnesses between Processor and Control Head. Label both ends with Station it connects (EXAMPLE: Port, Center, or Starboard; Port Thrust, Port Throttle; etc.) Page A-3 Dimensions There are two types of Control Head connections available: Plug or Terminal Connected. Both types may be used with MicroCommander, ClearCommand, or CruiseCommand using the appropriate cable or harness. Follow the appropriate steps for the Control Head that has been supplied for your system. Standard Cable Pluggable Strip back the PVC cover on the shielded cable Plug Control Head cable into approximately 2-1/2" (63,5mm) at the Control Head. the pigtail at the Control (Ensure the correct ProcesAt the Control Head end of the cable strip and cut Head. sor Cable is being plugged into the off the shielding and drain wire flush with the end corresponding Control Head lever of the PVC cover (the drain wire at the Control pigtail). Head is not connected to ground). When connecting the plugs, Strip 3/8" (9,5mm) insulation off each wire. ensure that the release button Twist the individual strands of the wires to mini- or buttons are depressed and held until plug is fully conmize fraying. or disconnected. ConCrimp a locking fork terminal (included with each nected necting or disconnecting Control Head) to each of the conductors. plugs without depressing and Make connections to the Control Head as indicated holding the release button or in the following TERMINAL CONNECTIONS dia- buttons will damage the plug. grams. ALWAYS REFER TO THE MANUAL THAT IS SUPPLIED WITH THE CONTROL SYSTEM FOR ANY UNIQUE CONTROL HEAD CONNECTIONS FOR YOUR SYSTEM. When cable connections are complete, MOUNT Control Head to the console using the four (4) mounting screws and washers supplied with the Control Head. Page A-4 CABLE/HARNESS CONNECTIONS: Dual Control Head Connections TERMINAL CONNECTIONS Cable/Jumper connections 5 and 7 at the Port and Starboard terminal block are direction sensitive. MicroCommander/ClearCommand Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Red Terminal 3 Red Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 Yellow Terminal 7 Yellow Terminal 7 Blue CruiseCommand/9000 Series Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Red & JUMPER Terminal 3 Red & JUMPER Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 JUMPER Terminal 7 JUMPER Terminal 7 Blue PLUGGABLE CONNECTIONS Pluggable Control Heads are supplied with a harness pigtail for each lever. When disconnecting/connecting the plugs, ensure that the release button or buttons are depressed and held until plug is fully disconnected or connected. Disconnecting/ connecting plugs without depressing and holding the release button or buttons WILL damage the plug. Aft Facing Control Heads For dual lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft: Reverse connections 5 and 7. For single lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft and the one Control Head lever on the user’s right, reverse connections 5 and 7. Handheld Control is a Station option. Contact your ZF Mathers Dealer for further information on Handheld requirements and options. Page A-5 Page A-6 0.19 Diameter (4,8mm) through Holes (4 Holes) Page A-7 . Page A-8 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-329 Rev.C 8/03 MC2000 Series Standard Control Head Variations This Service Sheet reflects all current variations of the standard 3-detent ZF Mathers MC2000 Series Control Heads Part Numbering Configurations Detents Available REQUIREMENTS: MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) 8-Conductor Cable per Control Head lever. Pluggable MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. CruiseCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. Included with the Control Head: • Mounting screws • Terminals (For 8-Conductor or 1-Connector Harnesses) • Watertight cable grip for the cable entrance on the Processor (For 8-Conductor) When the Control Head is properly mounted on a console, it is spray proof from the top only. An adhesive gasket is mounted on the bottom of the Control Head to seal it to the mounting surface. However, below the mounting surface it needs protection from water or spray. Consider using a Weather Mount Enclosure, which is available from ZF Mathers. MOUNTING AND INSTALLATION: Select the desired mounting locations and make cutouts per template. Refer to the Dimensions Diagram. Check that the two mounting screws will start into the Control Head. Remove Control Head from cutout. Run cable/harnesses between Processor and Control Head. Label both ends with Station it connects (EXAMPLE: Port, Center, or Starboard; Port Thrust, Port Throttle; etc.) Page A-9 Dimensions There are two types of Control Head connections available: Plug or Terminal Connected. Both types may be used with MicroCommander, ClearCommand, or CruiseCommand using the appropriate cable or harness. Follow the appropriate steps for the Control Head that has been supplied for your system. Standard Cable Pluggable Strip back the PVC cover on the shielded cable Plug Control Head cable into approximately 2-1/2" (63,5mm) at the Control Head. the pigtail at the Control At the Control Head end of the cable strip and cut off Head. the shielding and drain wire flush with the end of the PVC cover (the drain wire at the Control Head is not . connected to ground). When connecting the plugs, Strip 3/8" (9,5mm) insulation off each wire. ensure that the release button Twist the individual strands of the wires to minimize or buttons are depressed and fraying. held until plug is fully conCrimp a locking fork terminal (included with each nected or disconnected. Control Head) to each of the conductors. Connecting or disconnecting Make connections to the Control Head as indicated in plugs without depressing and the following TERMINAL CONNECTIONS diagrams. holding the release button or buttons will damage the plug. ALWAYS REFER TO THE MANUAL THAT IS SUPPLIED WITH THE CONTROL SYSTEM FOR ANY UNIQUE CONTROL HEAD CONNECTIONS FOR YOUR SYSTEM. When cable connections are complete, MOUNT Control Head to the console using the two (2) mounting screws and washers supplied with the Control Head. (Ensure the correct Proces- sor Cable is being plugged into the corresponding Control Head lever pigtail) Page A-10 CABLE/HARNESS CONNECTIONS: Dual Control Head Connections TERMINAL CONNECTIONS Cable/Jumper connections 5 and 7 at the Port and Starboard terminal block are direction sensitive. MicroCommander/ClearCommand Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Red Terminal 3 Red Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 Yellow Terminal 7 Yellow Terminal 7 Blue CruiseCommand/9000 Series Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Red & JUMPER Terminal 3 Red & JUMPER Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 JUMPER Terminal 7 JUMPER Terminal 7 Blue PLUGGABLE CONNECTIONS Pluggable Control Heads are supplied with a harness pigtail for each lever. When disconnecting/connecting the plugs, ensure that the release button or buttons are depressed and held until plug is fully disconnected or connected. Disconnecting/ connecting plugs without depressing and holding the release button or buttons WILL damage the plug. Aft Facing Control Heads For dual lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft: Reverse connections 5 and 7. For single lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft and the one Control Head lever on the user’s right, reverse connections 5 and 7. Handheld Control is an option. Contact your ZF Mathers Dealer for further information on Handheld requirements and options. Page A-11 Page A-12 0.25 Diameter (6,1mm) through Holes (2 Holes) Page A-13 . Page A-14 ZF Mathers, LLC MMC-307 Rev.G 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 8/03 700 Series Standard Control Head Variations This Service Sheet reflects all current variations of the standard 3-detent ZF Mathers 700 Series Control Heads. Part Numbering Configurations Detents Available REQUIREMENTS: MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) 8-Conductor Cable per Control Head lever. Pluggable MicroCommander/ClearCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. CruiseCommand: one (1) Control Head Harness per Control Head lever. Included with the Control Head: • (4) Flat-washer - Stainless Steel, 1/4 inch • (4) Screw - Stainless Steel, Philip Pan Head, 1/4 inch-20 x 1-3/4 inch • (4) Nut - Stainless Steel, 1/4 inch-20 • (14) Terminal - Flanged For, #6 • (2) Liquid Tight Connector (in addition to those installed at the factory) When the Control Head is properly mounted on a console, the Control Head is watertight. Dimensions Page A-15 MOUNTING AND INSTALLATION: Select the desired mounting locations and drill screw and cable holes as indicated on the template diagram. Refer to the Dimensions Diagram on the next page. Run cable/harnesses between Processor and Control Head. Label both ends with the Station it connects (EXAMPLE: Port, Center, or Starboard; Port Thrust, Port Throttle; etc.) There are two types of Control Head connections available: Plug or Terminal Connected. Both types may be used with MicroCommander, ClearCommand, or CruiseCommand using the appropriate cable or harness. Follow the appropriate steps for the Control Head that has been supplied for your system. Standard Cable Pluggable Remove the six screws holding the bottom cover of the Plug Control Head cable Control Head housings and set aside. into the pigtail at the Insert cable through the correct cable grip in the bottom Control Head. cover. Strip back the PVC cover on the shielded cable approximately 2-1/2" (63,5mm) at the Control Head. . At the Control Head end of the cable strip and cut off the When connecting the shielding and drain wire flush with the end of the PVC plugs, ensure that the cover (the drain wire at the Control Head is not connected release button or butto ground). tons are depressed and held until plug is fully Strip 3/8" (9,5mm) insulation off each wire. Twist the individual strands of the wires to minimize fray- connected or disconnected. Connecting or ing. plugs Crimp a locking fork terminal (included with each Control disconnecting without depressing and Head) to each of the conductors. holding the release butMake connections to the Control Head as indicated in the ton or buttons will damfollowing TERMINAL CONNECTIONS diagrams. age the plug. (Ensure the correct Processor Cable is being plugged into the corresponding Control Head lever pigtail) ALWAYS REFER TO THE MANUAL THAT IS SUPPLIED WITH THE CONTROL SYSTEM FOR ANY UNIQUE CONTROL HEAD CONNECTIONS FOR YOUR SYSTEM. When cable connections are complete: Replace Control Head bottom cover using the six (6) mounting screws removed earlier. Ensure seal is in place. Tighten watertight cable grip(s). Remove front cover from the Control Head Mount Control Head with supplied hardware. Replace front cover when mounting is complete. Page A-16 CABLE/HARNESS CONNECTIONS: Dual Control Head Connections TERMINAL CONNECTIONS Cable/Jumper connections 5 and 7 at the Port and Starboard terminal block are direction sensitive. 585CE and Earlier MicroCommander and MS Series ClearCommand Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Red Terminal 3 Red Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 Yellow Terminal 7 Yellow Terminal 7 Blue CruiseCommand, 9000 Series, Pluggable 585CE MicroCommander and Pluggable MS Series ClearCommand Port Lever: Starboard Lever: Terminal 3 Terminal 3 Red & JUMPER Red & JUMPER Terminal 5 Blue Terminal 5 JUMPER Terminal 7 JUMPER Terminal 7 Blue PLUGGABLE CONNECTIONS Pluggable Control Heads are supplied with a harness pigtail for each lever. When disconnecting/connecting the plugs, ensure that the release button or buttons are depressed and held until plug is fully disconnected or connected. Disconnecting/ connecting plugs without depressing and holding the release button or buttons WILL damage the plug. Aft Facing Control Head For dual lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft: Reverse connections 5 and 7. For single lever Control Head Stations that have the user facing aft and the one Control Head lever on the user’s right, reverse connections 5 and 7. Handheld Control is a Station option. Contact your ZF Mathers Dealer for further information on Handheld requirements and options. Page A-17 Page A-18 TEMPLATE Page A-19 Page A-20 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-279 Rev.B 7/02 400 Series Weather Mount Enclosure Single or Dual Control Head Gasket Control Head Mounting Holes .75 inch Diameter Hole Locate where required. (two if Dual Control Head) 3.54 (89,9mm) Enclosure Watertight Cable Grip (two if Dual Control Head) 6.29 (159,8mm) 4.72 (119,9mm) 10241 Deck Mount or Exposed Mount Ideal for outside Weather Mount To prevent internal condensation and moisture build up the mount is drilled to allow air circulation. Part No. 12110 . Page A-21 Page A-22 Deutsch Connector Assembly DT Type Step 1: Contact Removal Step 2: Wire Stripping Solid Contacts 1. Remove wedgelock using needlenose pliers or a hook shaped wire. Pull wedge straight out. 2. To remove the contacts, gently pull wire backwards, while at the same time releasing the locking finger by moving it away from the contact with a screwdriver. 3. Hold the rear seal in place, as removing the contact may displace the seal. Contact Part Number Wire Gauge Range Strip Length (inches) 0460-202-20141 0462-201-20141 20 AWG 20 AWG .156-.218 .156-.218 0460-202-16141 0462-201-16141 16, 18 & 20 AWG 16, 18 & 20 AWG .250-.312 .250-.312 0460-215-16141 0462-209-16141 14 AWG 14 AWG .250-.312 .250-.312 0460-204-12141 0462-203-12141 12 & 14 AWG 12 & 14 AWG .222-.284 .222-.284 0460-204-08141 0462-203-08141 8 & 10 AWG 8 & 10 AWG .430-.492 .430-.492 0460-204-0490 0462-203-04141 6 AWG 6 AWG .430-.492 .430-.492 Step 4: Contact Insertion Step 3: Contact Crimping Use Crimp Tool #HDT48-00 1. Strip insulation from wire. (See Step 2). 2. Raise selector knob and rotate until arrow is aligned with wire size to be crimped. 3. Loosen locknut, turn adjusting screw in until it stops. 4. Insert contact with barrel up. Turn adjusting screw counter– clockwise until contact is flush with indentor cover. Tighten locknut. 5. Insert wire into contact. Contact must be centered between indicators. Close handles until crimp cycle is completed. 6. Release handles and remove crimped contact. 7. Inspect terminal to ensure that all strands are in crimp barrel.NOTE: Tool must be readjusted for each type/size of contact. Use HDT04-08 for size 8 and 4 contacts. 1. Grasp crimped contact approximately (25.2 mm) one inch behind the contact barrel. 2. Hold connector with rear grommet facing you. 3. Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that contact is properly locked in place. 4. Once all contacts are in place, insert wedgelock with arrow pointing toward exterior locking mechanism. The wedgelock will snap into place. Rectangular wedges are not oriented. They may go in either way. NOTE: The receptacle is shown –use the same procedure for plug. (800) 223-1236 Page A-23 Page A-24 ZF Mathers, LLC S-214 Rev.E 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 5/03 Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505 A) GENERAL INFORMATION The APS (Automatic Power Selector), Model 13505, provides a simple, solid state solution to the need for routing redundant DC power sources for vital electronic equipment while maintaining isolation of the DC power sources. Two independent batteries rated at the same nominal voltage are wired to separate terminals on the APS and internal diodes maintain total isolation between them. A single output terminal is wired to the ZF Mathers Propulsion Control System. The APS is rated for loads of up to 70 Amps on 12-24V systems. The unit is ruggedly constructed with heavy-duty wiring studs and epoxy-potted components in an anodized aluminum case. B) APS SPECIFICATIONS Model: 13505 Maximum Load Current: 70 amps Operating Temperature: -40 degrees C to +80 degrees C; derate linearly from 100% @ 50 degrees C to 70% @ 80 degrees C Voltage Drop: 0.7 VDC @ 50% load; 0.9 VDC @ full load Dimensions: 3.25" x 4.5" x 3.1" (8,3 x 11,4 x 7,9 cm) C) MATERIALS PROVIDED The single APS is supplied with a hardware packet containing (6) hex nuts, (3) lock washers, (4) self-tapping mounting screws, (1) instructions diagram. NOTE: NOT ALL OF THE HARDWARE WILL BE USED IN THE INSTALLATION; SOME SPARES ARE PROVIDED. NUT SIZE IS M-6. The twin APS is supplied with (2) single APS hardware packets. D) INSTALLATION Refer to the installation Drawing 11488C. 1. Shut off all charging sources and disconnect the negative (ground) side of each battery which will be wired to the APS. 2. Mount the APS(s) in a suitable location which will keep wire runs to a minimum length, and is (preferably) ventilated, for cooler operation. The case of the APS is electrically isolated from the internal diodes, so mounting on either a metal or non-metal surface is acceptable. 3. Complete the wiring as indicated on either Drawing 11488C-1 or 11488C-2. 4. Reconnect the negative battery posts. E) IMPORTANT NOTE ABOUT BATTERY SOURCES Whenever the load is turned on, it can be drawing power from the batteries. Therefore, if the batteries are not simultaneously being recharged, or if charging will not be available for an extended period, it is recommended that the load be shut off to prevent complete discharge of batteries. Page A-25 Page A-26 Drawing 11488D-1 Twin Screw Single APS Connection & Alternate Remote Switch Page A-27 Page A-28 Drawing 11488D-2 Twin Screw Dual APS Connections Page A-29 Page A-30 Drawing 11488D-3 APS Notes Page Page A-31 Page A-32 ZF Mathers, LLC MMC-287 Rev.D 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 8/03 Bonding: A.B.Y.C. E-11, 46 CFR 111.05 All boats equipped with a permanently installed electrical system shall also be equipped with a bonding system. The negative terminal of all batteries should be connected at only one point, the DC common, and from DC common to bond system or hull. Metal - Hull Vessels The metallic hull of the vessel may also serve as the common bonding conductor. If it is desirable for the item being installed to be bonded to the vessel bonding system, and the installation or mounting method does not provide the desired path, a separate bonding conductor may be required. Page A-33 Page A-34 ZF Mathers, LLC MMC-288 Rev.E 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 8-03 References and Parts Source A) REFERENCES 1. American Boat & Yacht Council (ABYC) 3069 Solomons Island Road Edgewater, MD 21037-1416 E-3 Wiring Identification on Boats E-11 AC and DC Electrical Systems on Boats H-2.4e or 32.4g Ambient Temp. 50 degrees C P-24 Electric/Electronic Propulsion Controls 2. Code of Federal Regulations 33 CFR 183 Subpart I - Electrical Systems 33 CFR 183.410 Ignition protection 33 CFR 183.415 Grounding 33 CFR 183.425 Conductors: General 33 CFR 183.430 Conductors in circuit of less than 50 Volts 33 CFR 183.445 Conductors: Protection 33 CFR 183.455 Over-current and Protection: General 46 CFR 111.01 - 15(b) Ambient Temp. Machinery Spaces 50 degrees C 46 CFR 111.05- System Grounds 3. Society of Automotive Engineers 400 Commonwealth Drive Warrendale, PA 15096 J1171 External Ignition Protection J1428 Marine Circuit Breakers J378 Marine Engine Wiring 4. National Marine Manufacturers Association 401 North Michigan Avenue Chicago, IL 60611 5. Underwriters Laboratories B) PARTS SOURCE Anti-Static Wrist Strap P/N 517 [Thomas & Betts (P/N AWCC)] Automatic Power Selector P/N 13505 Circuit Breaker- UL Approved P/N 810 [E-T-A (P/N 41-2-514-LN2-10)] Fuse P/N 1030 [Bussman (P/N. GDC-1A)] Relay 12 VDC P/N 1114 [Potter-Brumfield (P/N KRPA5D6-12)] Relay 24 VDC P/N 1122 [Potter-Brumfield (P/N KRPA5D6-24)] Service Field Test Unit (Break-out Box) P/N 13927 WAGO Tool P/N 397 [WAGO (P/N 236-332)] Field Test Control Head - Dual P/N 14000 Page A-35 Page A-36 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 Engine Tachometer Sender Requirements SER-161 Rev.B 5/03 Engine Type Engine Model Inboard Gasoline Outboard 4, 6, 8, 14 Pole Diesel Caterpil- Most Older & 3208, lar D336, D346, D348, D398, D399 & D334 Caterpil- 3116, 3126, 3176, 3196, 8922 lar 3406, 3408, 3306, 3412, 3056, 3512 & 3516 Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel Detroit Diesel Detroit Diesel Detroit Diesel EMD Diesel Diesel EMD Hino Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel Alternator’s Stator AC N/A Terminal or Point Side of the Coil Alternator’s Stator AC N/A Terminal or Point Side of the Coil 8902 N/A DDEC Electronic System 53, 71, & 92 Series Comments 8912 Some use 8912. New engines have Magnetic Pickup already installed on flywheel. Use ECM output. Outputs 12 PPR. N/A Most have Magnetic Pickup already installed on flywheel. Must have Detroit datalink output module. Engines manufactured before 1976 use Aetna Part No. 8152 drive key with Sender. N/A 8902 N/A 8912 8902 N/A 250 HP: Tach drive on front Port side of engine. 310HP: Tach drive on rear center, just below the head. Tach drive usually at rear Starboard side of engine. Magnetic Pickup usually already installed. Engine built after 1977 require the Aetna Part No. 8619 tachometer drive adapter. N/A N/A Caterpil- All Electronic N/A lar Cummins Most Older & 555 8902 Cummins B & C Series, KTA19M3, 8912 MTA855, * KTA1150M Diesel Diesel 3, 4, 6, 8 Cylinder Sender Gasoline 8902 8902 8.2 Liter 2 Cycle, Some 71 & 92 Series Mechanical Sender Applications Flywheel Applications All Engines John Deere Older Engines 8902 John Deere Lehman (Ford) Newer Engines 8912 All Engines 8902 Lugger MAN All Engines In-line 8912 8902 Page A-37 Engine Type Engine Model Diesel MAN V-Engines 8902 Diesel MAN 826 8912 Diesel MAN 8912 Diesel Diesel Diesel MTU Perkins Perkins 2840, 2842, 2848, 2866 & 2886 All Engines 1980 and earlier 4-236 & 6-354 Diesel Diesel Perkins Perkins 4-107, 4-108 & M-800TI 8902 4-154 N/A Diesel Perkins Diesel Volvo Diesel Diesel Volvo Volvo M-135, M225, M-300 & M30 70, 100 & 120 A or B Series 3, 6A, 17 & 30 31 & Up, 41 Diesel Volvo Diesel Volvo 40, 60, 61 & Up, 71 & N/A Up, 100C & Up, 102, 121C & Up, 122, 2010 & 2020 42 & 43 N/A Diesel Volvo 2030 & 2040 N/A Diesel Yanmar All Engines N/A 8902 8902 8902 Sender Comments An extension tachometer cable Aetna Part No. 9212 is usually required. It may be necessary to manufacture a mounting plate for the magnetic pickup. N/A 8912 N/A N/A Perkins Part No. 8875 drive adapter needed on 1980 and newer engines. N/A Aetna Part No. 8709 Magnetic Sensor must be used in lieu of SAE drive. N/A 8902 N/A 8912 N/A N/A Aetna Part No. 8709 Magnetic Sensor must be used in lieu of SAE drive. Magnetic pickup already installed on cam gear. Connect at blower box. Black wire is ground and grey is signal Magnetic pickup already installed on cam gear. A metric Magnetic pickup is already installed on all engines. P/N 8902 Dual Mechanical Sender P/N 8912 Dual Magnetic Pickup (3/4-16) P/N 8922 Single Magnetic Pickup (5/8-18) Available through Aetna Engineering only. Page A-38 MMC-289 Rev.- 6/01 Morse Clutch and Throttle Kit Selection Pre-Engineered Throttle Connection Kits MAKE Caterpillar ENGINE MODEL 3208NA 3208TA 334, 3304, 3306 3406 & 343 3408 Cummins A11 w/MVSGOV AFC Fuel Pump V504M, V555M, V903M, VT903M, VTA903M, NT855M, VT171OM, VTA171OM, KT & KTA 1150M, KT & KTA 2300M, 1975 and later General Motors 3, 4, & 6-71 w/var.sp.gov. 6, 8, 12 V-71 & 6, 8 V-92 w/var.sp.gov. 6-71 inclined 2, 3, 4-53 w/left hand gov. Right hand gov. 6V-53 Rear entry 6V-53 Front entry 6, 8V-71 Front entry 12, 16V-149 Perkins 4, 236M 6, 3544M; T6, 3544M; ST6, 3544M; SST6, 3544M 4, 108 W/shut off KIT NO. 300172 305403 36680 36680 36680 36680 300580 41736 41736 36680 36680 36680 36680 36680 36680 48931 302026 303878 Pre-Engineered Clutch Connection Kits MAKE Allison Borg Worner Capital MerCruiser Paragon Twin Disc Twin Disc Trolling Valve TRANSMISSION MODEL M & MH 70, 71, 72 In line w/red gear rear entry 12400 2, 3, & 4 HD & HE Inboard w/o Warner red gear HF-7 MG508, 509, 510, 510A, 512, 514C, 514CHP, 518, 521, 527, 530, 540 MG502, 506, 507, W/x9994, xA7022, A7048 Valves MG509, 510A, 511A, 514C KIT NO. 41482 301474 36680 36680 62355 36680 42577 63696 307171 Outboard and I/O Cable Connection Kits ENGINE MAKE Chrysler 1975 & later Evinrude/Johnson 55-235 H.P. 1978 to date Mercury 40-300 H.P. Mercruiser I/O OMC Sterndrive I/O Volvo I/O Engine and out drive brackets are provided by Volvo Page A-39 KIT NO. 300465 301729 301901 302123 300557 Page A-40 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-290 Rev.- 6/01 Universal Mounting Kit Fabricate Bracket to match dimensions shown 3/16" (4,8mm) Diameter 33C Cable TYP 7/32" (5,8mm) Diameter 1/4" (6,4mm) Diameter 7-3/8" (187mm) Shim 31638 Cable Clamp 31509 90 Jam Nut 1" (25,4mm) Ball Joint 31126 1/4"-28 UNF Stud 10246A Page A-41 2-3/4" (70mm) Maximum Movement Selector Lever Page A-42 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MM13821 Rev.A 8/03 43C Cable Conversion Kit 9000 Series Processors and Actuators 585CE Actuator (Serial Number B06500 and up) 813CE Actuator (Serial Number C01150 and up) ClearCommand Processors (Serial Number D02100 and up) Revisions List Rev A Date 8/03 Revision Description Added 9000 Series. This procedure is to be used in conjunction with the technical manual supplied with the System’s Actuator/Processor. A) Parts Required: One 43C Conversion Kit (P/N 13821) for each cable. Kit includes the following: • 43C cable nut (P/N MS12820) • 43C cable retainer (P/N 13694) • Cable retainer screws (P/N 00791) B) Tools Required: • • • • Snap Ring Tool or Small Slotted Screwdriver Phillips Screwdriver 7/16 Nut Driver or Socket 7/16 Open End Wrench C) Actuator/Processor Preparation [Refer to Figure 1:] D) Remove cover to Actuator/Processor. Remove 33C Cable Connect Nut Cross-bar Lead Screw Remove Snap Ring Cable Retainer Screws 11452- Figure 1: Actuator/Processor Preparation CAUTION: Static electricity can destroy electronic components. Anytime the Actuator/Processor cover is off, use an anti-static wrist strap and connect it to the Actuator/Processor frame. This will drain any static charge you may have on your person. E) Remove screws holding Cable Retainer in place. F) Remove and discard Cable Retainer. G) Remove the Snap Ring holding the Cable Connect Nut in the cross-bar using a snap ring tool or small screwdriver. H) Remove and discard Cable Connect Nut and Snap Ring. Page A-43 I) Cable Installation [Refer To Figure 2:] NOTE: 43C CABLE AND JAM NUT ARE SUPPLIED BY OTHERS. 1. Remove and retain the jam nut from the end of the 43C cable to be installed in the Actuator/Processor. Cross-bar Lead Screw Jam Nut 43C Cable Connect Nut 43C Cable Retainer 10917A Remove rubber boot and dust cover 43C Cable Figure 2: Actuator/Processor Cable Installation 2. Remove and discard the rubber boot and the rubber dust cover from the end of the 43C cable to be installed in the Actuator/Processor. 3. Insert the end of the cable through the hole in the Actuator/Processor. 4. Thread the jam nut onto the end of the cable inside the Actuator/Processor. 5. On the outside of the Actuator/Processor, press the 43C Cable Retainer over the notch in the 43C cable. This is intended to be a snug fit and may require some force. 6. Install two screws through the 43C Cable Retainer and into the Actuator/Processor. 7. Tighten the two screws securely with a Phillips Screwdriver. 8. Insert the 43C Cable Connect Nut through the cross-bar. 9. Thread the 43C Cable Connect Nut onto the end of the 43C cable. 10.After the cable connect nut is threaded onto the cable, tighten the jam nut against the cross-bar using a 7/16 nut driver or socket and 7/16 open end wrench. 11.Replace cover to Actuator/Processor. Refer to technical manual supplied with the Actuator/Processor for any other required set up or adjustment. Page A-44 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-165 Rev.D 3/02 Electronic Propulsion Control Systems Three Year Limited Warranty Your ZF Mathers product has been designed and manufactured by experienced engineers and craftsmen. ZF Mathers LLC, warrants for the period indicated below, each product to be free from defect in material and workmanship. Repair or replacement, at ZF Mathers option, will be provided if the product, upon ZF Mathers inspection, is found to be properly installed and operated in accordance with ZF Mathers Manual. This warranty does not apply to malfunction caused by damage, unreasonable use, misuse, repair or service by unauthorized persons or normal wear and tear. A) Coverage Under Warranty Three years from the date of purchase by the original end user. Year One No charge for equipment repair, parts and labor. Up to three hours labor toward troubleshooting and replacement of defective equipment. Year Two and Three There is no charge for equipment repairs performed at the factory that are covered under warranty. No labor allowance for troubleshooting and replacement of defective equipment. B) No Coverage Under Warranty The following will not be covered under warranty.Travel to and from the job site. 1. Adjustment or calibration of any ZF Mathers equipment. 2. Adjustment or calibration of any associated equipment which may include but not limited to push-pull cables, engine governor or carburetor, transmission or trolling valve. 3. Damage due to accidents, improper installation or handling and or improper storage. 4. Damage due to faulty repairs performed by an unauthorized service representative. 5. Damage due to conditions, modifications or installation contrary to published specifications or recommendations. 6. Original installation charges or start-up costs. 7. Battery service including labor charges related to battery service. 8. Rental of equipment during performance of warranty repairs. 9. Unauthorized repair shop labor, without prior approval from ZF Mathers Service Department. 10. Shop supplies such as connectors, wire, cable, etc. C) Warranty Service Call 1-800-546-5455 or 1-425-583-1900 for your nearest ZF Mathers Factory Authorized Dealer. 1. Prior to returning any product to the factory, you must contact ZF Mathers Service Department for a Material Return Authorization (MRA) number. Return the product freight prepaid, marked clearly with the MRA number and a description of the malfunction. 2. If there is a defect covered by warranty, ZF Mathers will, at its option, either repair or replace the defective part or product. If after inspection, ZF Mathers determines that the product is not defective, ZF Mathers will charge a testing fee and return the product to the sender, freight collect. 3. Repair or replacement during the warranty period will not extend the warranty period. 4. All claims must be submitted within 30 days from date of service. 5. Claims for over 3 hours must be pre-approved by the ZF Mathers Service Department. THIS WARRANTY IS EXPRESSLY IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROHIBITED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ZF MATHERS HEREBY DISCLAIMS ALL OTHER IMPLIED OR EXPRESS WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, INCLUDING WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL ZF MATHERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES SUSTAINED IN CONNECTION WITH THE PRODUCT OR ITS USE, INCLUDING ANY COSTS OR DAMAGES WHICH RESULT FROM LOSS OF USE OF THE PRODUCT OR ANY ENGINE OR BOAT WITH WHICH IT IS USED. ZF MATHERS DOES NOT AUTHORIZE ANY REPRESENTATIVE OR AGENT TO ASSUME FOR IT ANY OBLIGATION OR LIABILITY OTHER THAN THOSE EXPRESSLY SET FORTH ABOVE. SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED WARRANTY LASTS OR THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, IF ANY, ARE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THIS EXPRESS WARRANTY. THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU LEGAL RIGHTS, AND YOU MAY HAVE OTHER RIGHTS WHICH MAY VARY FROM STATE TO STATE. Page A-45 Page A-46 ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 U.S.A. 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-163 Rev.B 1-01 Warranty Registration Actuator/Processor, Serial # Number of Remote Stations Purchase Date Dealer's Name Installer's Name Phone Number ( ) Purchaser's Name Street Address City, State, Zip Phone Number ( ) YOUR VESSEL: Engine, Make & Model Length Manufacturer ZF Mathers, LLC. Product First Seen At: Boat Show Dealer Magazine Page C-47 Serial # Friend ZF Mathers, LLC. 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo, WA 98275 Page C-48 APPENDIX B TROUBLESHOOTING B1 TROUBLESHOOTING GENERAL The ClearCommand Control System consists of one Processor per engine, typically mounted in the engine room, and one to five Control Heads located at the vessel’s Remote Stations. In the event that a malfunction occurs, review the appropriate Processor System Diagram and the descriptions in Section B1-1, page B1-1. Become familiar with the various components, their functions and location on the vessel. Section B1-2, page B1-2, is a list of the main components that make up a typical system, along with a brief description of their functions: ONTROL SYSTEMS EXAMPLES B1-1C B1-1.1 9120 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid) Processor and 9122 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid, Troll Solenoid) Processor SERIAL COMMUNICATION ALARM ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. START INTERLOCK 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) CLUTCH PRES. Figure B1-1: 9120 and 9122 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram The 9120 Processor is designed to precisely control speed and direction on vessels equipped with mechanical Throttle and Solenoid Clutch Selectors. The 9122 Processor is designed to precisely control speed, direction, and trolling valve on vessels equipped with mechanical Throttle, Solenoid Clutch and Trolling Valve Selectors. PageB1-1 TROUBLESHOOTING B1-1.2 9121 (Throttle Servo 2, Shift Solenoid, Troll Servo 1) Processor The 9121 Processor is designed to precisely control speed, direction, and trolling valve on vessels equipped with mechanical Throttle and Trolling Valve, and Solenoid Clutch Selectors. Figure B1-2: 9121 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram B1-1.3 9210 (Throttle Electronic, Shift Servo 1) Processor STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION THROTTLE TACH 1 THROTTLE TACH 1 PORT R N STBD F R SHIFT 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE N 12294F SHIFT 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. ALARM START INTERLOCK 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) CLUTCH PRES. APS COMMON GROUND - + + - COMMON GROUND Figure B1-3: 9210 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram PageB1-2 The 9210 Processor is designed to precisely control speed and direction on vessels equipped with electronic Throttle, and mechanical Clutch Selectors. TROUBLESHOOTING B1-1.4 9211 (Throttle Electronic, Shift Servo 1, Troll Servo 2) Processor The 9211 Processor is designed to precisely control speed, direction, and trolling valve on vessels equipped with electronic Throttle, and mechanical Clutch and Troll Selectors. Figure B1-4: 9211 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram B1-1.5 9221 (Throttle Electronic, Clutch Solenoid, Troll Servo 2) Processor STATION 1 STATION 2 SERIAL COMMUNICATION THROTTLE TACH 1 THROTTLE TACH 1 PORT STBD MIN MAX SLIP SLIP MIN MAX SLIP SLIP TROLL TROLL 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. 10 AMP CIRCUIT BREAKERS (BY OTHERS) 33C PUSH/PULL CABLE ALARM START INTERLOCK CLUTCH PRES. APS COMMON GROUND - + 12297 + - COMMON GROUND Figure B1-5: 9221 Basic Single Screw, Two Station Diagram PageB1-3 The 9221 Processor is designed to precisely control speed, direction, and trolling valve on vessels equipped with electronic Throttle, solenoid Clutch selection, and mechanical Troll selector. TROUBLESHOOTING B1-2 TYPICAL SYSTEM MAIN COMPONENTS B1-2.1 Control Head The primary function of the Control Head is to send out a variable DC voltage to the Processor. This DC voltage is representative of the Control Head’s present lever position. In addition to the primary function, the Control Head also has audible (Sound Transducer) and visual (LED) status indications, along with a Transfer Button for taking command and performing other system functions. B1-2.2 Processor The Processor receives the variable DC voltage from the Control Head(s) and converts these inputs to the appropriate electronic or electric outputs at the correct time and sequence to the Governor and Gear Box. The information regarding throttle type, throttle/ clutch sequencing, etc., are all stored on memory within the Processor. B1-2.3 Power Source All electronic equipment must have power in order to operate. Ensuring a properly charged reliable power source is available is crucial. The Processor requires a 12 or 24 VDC power system. The minimum voltage at which the Processor will continue to operate is 8.00 VDC. The maximum allowable voltage is 30 VDC. Exceeding these limits will not damage the Processor, but will render it unusable temporarily. The power supply must be capable of delivering 10 amperes to each Processor on a continual basis and current surges up to 20 amperes. All cable calculations should be based on a 10 ampere draw with no more than 10% voltage drop. B1-2.4 Electrical Cables and Harnesses The function of the Electrical Cables and Harnesses are to move electrical information from one point to another. The ZF Mathers’ System has electrical cables and/or pluggable Harnesses. These Harnesses may have plugs on one end or both, depending on its purpose. There are Harnesses available for Control Head Interface, DC Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Oil Pressure Interlock and External System Status Indication Circuit. Not all of the above harnesses may be used. In addition, the application may require Harnesses for one or more of the following: Engine Interface, Shift Interface, Troll Interface, Serial Communication and Tachometer Sensor Signal. B1-2.5 Push-Pull Cables The primary function of a Push-Pull cable is to allow a physical movement on one end to be felt at the opposite end with a minimum of back-lash. The Push-Pull cables are mechanically connected to the Processor’s cross-bars on one end and the governor and/or transmission selector levers on the end. The Processor PageB1-4 TROUBLESHOOTING uses the 33C Type push-pull cable as standard, or 43C Type with a special adapter. ZF Mathers ENGINE CLUTCH TROLL Processor Part No. Mechanical Mechanical Mechanical 9120 Servo 2 9121 Servo 2 9122 Servo 2 Servo 1 9210 Servo 1 9211 Servo 1 9221 Servo 2 Servo 2 Table B1-1: ClearCommand Processor Push-Pull Reference Prior to attempting to troubleshoot the System, get as much information as possible from the owner or operator. Inspect the System for signs of misadjustments, loose connections, physical damage or water incursion. Pay special attention to the following items: • DC Power Source • Component Location • Component Condition • Interconnecting Wiring and Harnesses • Wire Terminations • Plug and Socket Pins • Mechanical connections at the Throttle and Transmission Selector Levers • Mechanical connections within the Processor PageB1-5 TROUBLESHOOTING B2 TROUBLESHOOTING QUESTIONS Prior to lifting a tool or stepping on board the vessel, many problems can be resolved by asking the customer the following basic questions: A) Is the System installed on a Single, Twin or Multiple Screw vessel? • If the System is installed on a Single Screw vessel, this question does not have much value in narrowing down the source of the problem. • If the System is installed on a Twin or more Screw application, this question is quite useful, if you ask the following question. 1. Does the problem or symptom occur on the Port, Starboard or both sides? • If the problem or symptom occurs on one side only, you have effectively eliminated 50% of the possible causes. For example, the symptom only occurs on the Port side. All of the components on the Starboard side have been eliminated as potential causes. B) What is the Part Number and Serial Number of the Processor? Whenever the factory is called for technical assistance, the part number and serial number will be required. These numbers provide the Service Technician information about the operating characteristics of the Processor. The numbers are located on the Processor’s front cover. C) How many Remote Stations are there? • If only one Remote Station is present, not much will be gained by asking this question. However, if more than one Remote Station is being used, command should be taken from one of the other Stations to see if the problem occurs from another Station. • If the problem occurs from more than one Remote Station, the odds are that the Control Heads are not the cause of the trouble. • If the problem occurs at one Remote Station only, there is a greater chance of the Control Head or the Control Head Harness of being the cause. D) Are any tones generated when the problem occurs? The tones are used to bring the operator’s attention to a possible condition or problem. The following basic tones can be produced on all Systems: (Refer to Section B5-1.1, page B5-1) Slow Repetitive Tone PageB2-1 TROUBLESHOOTING One Long- Three Short Tones (Refer to Section B5-1.2, page B5-2) (Refer to Section B5-1.3, page B5-4) (Refer to Section B5-1.4, page B5-4) Steady Tone Three Second Steady Tone Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone (Refer to Section B5-1.6, page B5-5) (Refer to Section B5-1.7, page B5- Five Second Steady Tone 5). The following tones can be produced on all Systems utilizing Servo 1: (Refer to Section B5-2.2, page B5-6) (Refer to Section B5-2.1, page B5-6) The following tones can be produced on all Systems utilizing Servo 2: (Refer to Section B5-3.1, page B5-7) (Refer to Section B5-3.2, page B5-8) The following tone can be produced on all Systems using Solenoid Clutches: (Refer to Section B5-2.1, page B5-6) One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tone One Long - One Short Tone One Long - Two Short Tones One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones One Long - One Short Tone E) Are there any Error Messages displayed on the Processor’s Display LED? • In addition to generating a tone, at any time the system detects a malfunction or fault, an error message will be displayed at the Processor. Refer to Table B8-4:, Basic Control System Error Codes, page B8-3, for an explanation of the errors. F) What is the status of the Control Head in command’s red LED? The red LED(s) will be in one of the following states: Lit Steady When the red LED is , this indicates that the Station is in command and in Normal operative mode. Lit Steady Not Lit When the red LED is , that Station is not in command, or there is no power to the Control System. Not Lit Blinking Slowly A red LED indicates that the Control Head is in Throttle Only Mode (Warm-up Mode). Slow Blinking PageB2-2 TROUBLESHOOTING Blinking Rapidly A red LED that is tem is in Troll Mode. Blinking Rapidly indicates that the Sys- G) Has anything on the vessel changed shortly prior to or when the problem arose? This question is often overlooked, but should be considered. Obvious changes such as additions or changes to the electrical/ electronic equipment onboard can affect the electrical load and in turn the Processor’s power supply. Ask the operator if any changes or maintenance to the vessel’s machinery have occurred lately. Items which are significant to you, the technician, may not seem so to the casual owner or operator. An example would be changes to the engine’s fuel system. Ask about changes, that when initially considered, appear to have nothing to do with the Control System. An example where this really occurred was on a vessel which had recently been repainted. For unknown reasons, the painter took it upon himself to disconnect the connections at a Control Head and then reconnected it incorrectly. In many cases, these simple questions can resolve a problem with no further action from you, the technician. Take the time to consider these questions. In the long run, you will save yourself and the customer a lot of time and money. PageB2-3 TROUBLESHOOTING B3 TROUBLESHOOTING PROBLEM RESOLUTION If the problem could not be resolved by asking the questions in the previous section, a careful inspection of the Control System may be the next step. Even in situations where the problem was found and corrected, it is good practice to always perform a careful inspection of the entire Control System each and every time you are asked aboard a boat. Always verify that the installation of the System is in compliance with the Installation Manual by carefully inspecting the following: OWER B3-1 DC P A) Ensure that the Processor(s) is connected to a properly charged 12 or 24 VDC battery through a 10 Ampere circuit breaker. B) To ensure reliable power to the Processors an APS (Automatic Power Selector) is strongly recommended. The APS take inputs from two separate power sources. Whichever power source is at the higher voltage level, will be automatically switched through. C) Refer to Automatic Power Selector (APS) Model: 13505, page A-25. OMPONENT LOCATION B3-2 C B3-2.1 Control Heads There are virtually no restrictions regarding the location of the 400 Series and MC2000 Series Control Heads, as long as the bottom is protected from the environment. The 500 Series Control Heads must be mounted to a console and the 700 Series are waterproof from top to bottom. Refer to Appendix A - Control Head Reference Sheet for Installation requirements. B3-2.2 Processors The Processors are typically mounted in the engine room, while maintaining a minimum distance of 4 feet (1,22m) from sources of high heat and EMI (Electro Magnetic Interference) or RFI (Radio Frequency Interference). Refer to Section 3-1, page 3-1, for Installation requirements. PageB3-1 TROUBLESHOOTING OMPONENT CONDITION B3-3 C B3-3.1 Control Heads Inspect for any signs of corrosion due to water incursion. If hard-wired, ensure that all the fork connectors are properly secured to the terminal. Verify all wires are fully crimped and do not pull loose. B3-3.2 Processors Inspect the Processor for any signs of physical damage. NTERCONNECTING WIRING AND HARNESSES B3-4 I A) Inspect the wire terminations for loose connections, corrosion or wire strands. B) Inspect the Harness’s pins and sockets for bent pins, torn boots or any signs of corrosion. The first step in troubleshooting a problem with the Propulsion System is to determine if the problem is with the Control System or something external to the System. In all cases a Control System malfunction will alert the operator of the potential problem. This is accomplished through the audible tone emitted at all Remote Stations. When an audible tone is emitted, it will be accompanied by an Error Message at the Processor. Also, in many cases, the Control System will alert the operator to a problem external to the Control System. The following are examples of components both internal and external to the Control System which could be a source of trouble: Table B3-2: Examples of Components (Internal/External) Internal 1) Processor 2) Control Head 3) Interconnecting Wiring (Harnesses) 4) Push-Pull Cable External 1) DC Power Source 2) Engine 3) Transmission 4) Push-Pull Cable The following pages should give you a good guideline for making this determination. There is no need to troubleshoot the system to any point further than one of the main components listed above. If the fault is found to be with a Control System component, that component is simply replaced. If the fault is found to be with one of the external components, replace or repair the defective component or contact a qualified mechanic. PageB3-2 TROUBLESHOOTING B4 TROUBLESHOOTING DIAGNOSTIC MENU The Processor has built in diagnostics designed to assist the technician in determining the cause of a problem. The following information is available to view at any time: • Applied Battery Voltage • Tachometer Sender Frequency • Stations 1- 5 A/D’s • Stations 1- 5 Transfer Button Status • Servo 2 Feedback A/D’s • Servo 1 Feedback A/D’s • Software Revision Level In order to access this information, follow the steps below: A)Locate the Display LED on the Port or Starboard Processor. The Display LED will have the Processor Part Number Figure B4-6: Display Function displayed in a running pattern moving Code List from left to right while the program is running in Normal Operation. B) Depress the Up or Down Push Button Figure B4-7: Display Troubleshooting Function to activate the Function Code List. The characters A001 will be shown on the Display like Figure B4-6: C) Depress the Up or Down Push Button repeatedly until H000 is displayed like Figure B4-8: Display Troubleshooting Function Blinking Figure B4-7:. D)Depress and hold the Left and Right Push Buttons simultaneously until the Figure B4-9: Example Display of H0 begins to blink. (Figure B4-8:) Applied Battery Voltage Release the Push Buttons; the applied battery voltage will now be displayed: Function Code is Blinking • The displayed value is in “real time” and provides a rough estimate of the DC voltage applied to the Processor. The reading is accurate to within 0.50 DC. Refer to Figure B4-9: PageB4-1 TROUBLESHOOTING E)In addition to the applied battery voltage, scrolling through the Diagnostics Menu by pressing the Up or Down Push Button can also show the Tachometer Sender Frequency (Figure B4-10:): Figure B4-10: Example Display of Tach Sensor Frequency • The information shown is the actual frequency outputted by the Tachometer Sender. This signal is utilized in “Closed Loop” Synchronization or “Closed Loop” Troll (future) systems • The Control Head’s lever position, and the resulting outputs of Stations # 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5’s Control Heads can always be monitored. This is regardless of whether that Station is in command or not. Note the placement of the decimal points in the examples below, which show all five Stations with the lever positioned at the Neutral/Idle position. This will be covered in further detail later. STATION #1 LEVER A/D COUNT STATION #2 LEVER A/D COUNT STATION #4 LEVER A/D COUNT STATION # 5 LEVER A/D COUNT STATION #3 LEVER A/D COUNT Figure B4-11: Example Display Control Head Lever Current Positions F) The current status of all the Control Head’s Transfer Buttons can be monitored within the Diagnostic Menu. A 1 indicates a closure (depressed Transfer Button) of the switch, while PageB4-2 TROUBLESHOOTING a 0 indicates an open switch. This will also be covered inTATION more detail later. TATION STATION #1 RANSFER BUTTON DEPRESSED T S TATION #4 RANSFER BUTTON DEPRESSED S T T T S #2 RANSFER BUTTON DEPRESSED S #3 RANSFER BUTTON DEPRESSED T TATION # 5 RANSFER BUTTON DEPRESSED Figure B4-12: Example Display Control Head Transfer Button Status View G) Depressing the Up or Down Push Button one more time will show the current revision level of the software. This feature will provide invaluable information in the years to come. Determining the characteristics or capabilities of a certain Processor will be as simple as selecting this feature. Figure B4-13: Example Display Software Revision Level View H) Pressing the Up or Down (Scroll) Push Button once more, returns you to the Applied Battery Voltage. (Figure B4-9:) I) The Diagnostic Menu can be exited two ways: Do not touch any Push Buttons for 5 minutes. The system will automatically exit. • Depress the Left Push Button until appears. You may now scroll through the Set Up Menu. • H000 PageB4-3 TROUBLESHOOTING B5 TROUBLESHOOTING AUDIBLE TONES As mentioned previously, there are various tones emitted from the Control Head if an error were to occur. ASIC CONTROL SYSTEM TONES B5-1 B These basic tones are as follows: B5-1.1 Slow Repetitive Tone Figure B5-14: Slow Repetitive Tone The Slow Repetitive Tone, also referred to as the “Initialization Tone” is the tone you hear at all Remote Stations when power is initially applied to the control system. When this tone is heard, you know for a fact that the following are true: • Power has just been applied to the system. • The Software Program is running normally. • The Processor is commanding the throttle to Idle. • The Processor is commanding the clutch to Neutral. This is a normal tone when power has first been applied to the Processor and no Control Head has taken command. However, the tone may also be an indication of a problem, if during normal operation the engine’s throttle drops to Idle, followed by the clutch to Neutral, the Control Head’s red LED goes out and a slow repetitive tone is heard at all remote stations. This indicates that the voltage at the Processor has momentarily dropped below 8 VDC and then returned to a normal operational level. This could be due to: • Loose battery power cable connection. • Under-charged or defective battery. • Voltage drop due to current flow. In order to pinpoint the exact cause of the low voltage at the Processor, perform the following checks: A) Check the Display on the Processor for Error Messages. Error Message may appear indicating Under Voltage. One or more of Error Messages through may also be displayed. This is due to the momentary loss of serial communication between the two Processors. Take note that the Under Voltage error is not only dependent on low voltage, it is also dependent on the duration of the low voltage. The possibility exists that an error message would not be displayed if the duration of the low voltage was short enough. However, the other symptoms mentioned above still occur. B) In either case, follow the procedure listed under (Section B4, page B4-1) until the Applied Battery Voltage is displayed. Take note of the applied voltage. C) Go to the battery or Main Distribution Panel which is feeding power to the Processor. With a DC Voltmeter, measure the voltage at this power source. The battery voltage 57 43 54 Diagnostic Menu PageB5-1 TROUBLESHOOTING should be greater than 12.4 Volts in 12 VDC systems and 24.8 Volts in 24 VDC systems. If not, the battery or it’s charging system needs servicing. D) The voltage differential between the power source and the Processor should not exceed 1.2 Volts in 12 VDC systems and 2.4 Volts in 24 VDC systems. If so, there is high resistance somewhere between the battery and Processor. NOTE: IF AN APS IS BEING UTILIZED IN THE POWER CIRCUIT, TAKE INTO ACCOUNT THE 0.7 VDC FORWARD VOLTAGE DROP OF THE DIODES. THIS WOULD INCREASE THE PERMISSIBLE DIFFERENTIAL BETWEEN POWER SOURCE AND PROCESSOR FROM 1.2 TO 1.9 VDC IN 12 VDC CIRCUITS AND 2.4 TO 3.1 VDC IN 24 VDC CIRCUITS. E) High resistance, resulting in a differential voltage of 1.2 Volts (12 VDC Systems) or 2.4 Volts (24 VDC Systems) or greater, may be the result of corroded or tarnished connections, dirty or pitted relay contacts or an improperly sized power cable. F) If the voltage differential is less than 1.2 Volts (12 VDC Systems) or 2.4 Volts (24 VDC Systems), which is what you would typically expect, a loose connection may exist between the power source and the Processor. The vibration experienced while the vessel is underway may intermittently cause the circuit to open. Check all the connections between the power source and the Processor for a loose bolts, nuts, etc. B5-1.2 One Long - Three Short Tones Figure B5-15: One Long - Three Short Tones This tone indicates that there is an invalid command signal at the Station-in-Command. The Processor expects a DC voltage, representative of the Control Head’s present lever position. This voltage is referred to as the “Command Signal”. In normally functioning Control Heads, the command signal is between approximately 0.8VDC at Full Astern to 4.10 VDC at Full Ahead. The command signal is converted by the Processor to a digital representation, referred to as an A/D Count. More on A/D Counts later. If the command signal drops below 0.6VDC or exceeds 4.40 VDC, the tone will be generated. At the same time the tone is heard, throttle command drops to Idle and the clutch will be commanded to Neutral. The following items will cause this to occur: • An open or high resistance connection between the Control Head and Processor. • Out of calibration Control Head. • A defective Control Head. • A defective A/D Converter in the Processor. The exact cause of the malfunction can be found as follows: PageB5-2 TROUBLESHOOTING A) Check the Processor’s Display for error messages. Most likely, one of error messages 13 thru 32 will be shown. The exact number shown depends on which remote station is experiencing the problem and whether the command signal was too high or too low. B) Enter the Diagnostic Menu as outlined in Section B4, page B4-1. C) Depress the Up or Down (Scroll) Push Button until the appropriate Remote Station is displayed. • The Remote Station are identified by the position of the deci- mal points. • Station 1 has no decimal point after the first digit to the far right. The remaining three digits all have decimal points. • If the digit to the far left had no decimal point following it, but the remaining three do, this would represent Station 4. STATION 2 STATION 1 STATION 3 STATION 5 STATION 4 Figure B5-16: Display Examples of Remote Stations D) The examples in Figure B5-16: are shown with no Control Heads connected to any Remote Stations. When a Control Head is connected, the appropriate A/D (Analog/Digital) value for the present position of the Control Head’s lever will be shown, as in the examples below: STATION 1 (NEUTRAL COMMANDED) STATION 2 (FULL AHEAD C OMMANDED) STATION 4 (NO CONTROL HEAD CONNECTED) STATION 5 (NEUTRAL COMMANDED) STATION 3 (FULL ASTERN COMMANDED) Figure B5-17: Display Examples of Remote Stations A/D Value E) An A/D value of 910 or greater will generate an Error Code. The code will be 13 to 22 (Control Head # Faulted High), depending on which Station has the high Command Signal. • If the A/D value is greater than 910, but less than 990, one of the following may be the cause: 1. The Control Head’s potentiometer is out of calibration. 2. The potentiometer is defective. In either case, it is recommended that the Control Head is replaced. PageB5-3 TROUBLESHOOTING • If the A/D value is 995 or higher, most likely the potentiome- ter’s ground has been lost. • Right hand Control Heads have a jumper between pins 3 and 5 if a Harness is used. This jumper provides the potentiometers ground. • Left hand Control heads have a jumper between pins 3 and 7 is a Harness is used. This jumper provides the potentiometers ground. • The potentiometer ground connection for Control Heads which are hard-wired to the Processor is through the yellow wire (pin 5 on right hand and pin 7 on left hand). F) If the A/D value is 100 or less, one of Error Codes 23- 32 (Control Head # Faulted Low) will be shown. • If the A/D value is less than 100, but greater than 75, the fol- lowing may be the cause: 1. The Control Head’s potentiometer is out of calibration. 2. The potentiometer is defective. 3. A high resistance connection exists on pin 6 (green wire) between the Control Head and Processor. • If the A/D value is less than 75: 1. There is an open wire between pin 6 (green wire) of the Control Head and the Processor. 2. There is an open wire between pin 7 (blue wire) of a right hand Control Head and the Processor. 3. There is an open wire between pin 5 (blue wire) of a left hand Control Head and pin 7 (blue wire) of the Processor. B5-1.3 Steady Tone Figure B5-18: Steady Tone The Steady Tone is an indication to the operator that something has gone wrong within the Control System. The Steady Tone will typically be accompanied by an Error Message on the Processor’s Display. If the tone is heard, the Processor’s Display must be referred to in order to further diagnosis the problem. The Transfer Button is shorted - Tone will cease when command is taken at another Station. If the Transfer Button becomes shorted for 12 seconds or more during Normal Operation, a steady tone will be produced at all Remote Stations as long as the Transfer Button remains shorted. Full System control remains. Transferring to another Remote Station silences the Steady Tone. Command cannot be regained at the Station until the problem is rectified. B5-1.4 Three Second Steady Tone Figure B5-19: Three Second Tone This tone could indicate one of three things. Transfer Button on the Control Head in command is stuck. PageB5-4 TROUBLESHOOTING If the Processor for this System includes the use of Back-up Mode, this tone would indicate that there has been a switch closure requesting Back-up Mode. If the Processor for this System includes Integrated Solenoid Trolling Valve control, this tone would indicate that there has been a Troll Solenoid error. Refer to the Error Code displayed. B5-1.5 Three Second Steady Tone, followed by a Slow Repetitive Tone Figure B5-20: Three Second Tone, followed by a Slow Repetitive Tone This tone indicates that there has been a shorted Transfer Button on power-up. Command can be gained at any other Remote Station, which silences the Slow Repetitive Tone. B5-1.6 Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone Figure B5-21: Five Seconds On, Five Seconds Off - High Repetitive Rate Tone Loss of communication with Station Expander (SE) or the Troll Actuator (p/n 9001). This tone cannot be cleared unless all Error Codes (Active and In-Active) have been cleared. B5-1.7 Five Second Steady Tone Figure B5-22: Five Second Steady Tone Loss of Serial Communication. ERVO B5-2 S ONTROL SYSTEM TONES 1 C B5-2.1 One Long - One Short Tone Figure B5-23: One Long - One Short Tone This tone indicates that the feedback signal, which represents the position of the Servo 1 cross-bar, is out of the expected range. This tone will be accompanied by Error Code 63 or 64. • If Error Code 63 is displayed, the signal received from the feedback potentiometer is higher than expected. This is due to one of the three following reasons: 1. The orange wire (ground) between the potentiometer and plug are not making contact, or have a high resistance contact. 2. The potentiometer is out of calibration. 3. The potentiometer is defective. • If Error Code is displayed, the signal received from the feedback potentiometer is lower than expected. This is due to one of the following reasons: 64 1. The green (signal) or orange (reference voltage) wires between the potentiometer and plug are not making contact or have a high resistance contact. PageB5-5 TROUBLESHOOTING 2. The potentiometer is out of calibration. 3. The potentiometer is defective. 4. The Control Circuit is defective. The Servo 1 feedback signal can be viewed within the Diagnostic Menu. The Value displayed depends on the direction and amount of push-pull cable travel. As a general rule: • When the Value displayed is or , the problem is with the wiring between the potentiometer and plug. • If the displayed Value varies, the potentiometer is defective. • When the Value is slightly too high or too low when fully extended, the potentiometer requires calibration. 1023 0 B5-2.2 One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones Figure B5-24: One Long, One Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones This tone is also referred to as a Jam Tone. When sounded, Servo 1 is unable to reach the commanded position. In most cases when a Jam Tone is encountered, it can be cleared by moving the Control Head lever back to the point prior to where the tone was first encountered. The tone will be accompanied by Error Code 62 and is typically caused by one of the following reasons: • Stiff or frozen selector lever. • Misadjusted push-pull cable. • Defective push-pull cable. • Low battery voltage. • Defective Processor. In order to isolate the cause to one of these five items, follow the steps below: A) Disconnect the push-pull cable from the selector lever. B) Move the Control Head lever to Ahead, Astern, and back to Neutral. • If the tone ceases continue with step C). • If the tone is still present, skip ahead to step D). C) Grab a hold of the selector lever and manually reposition the lever. • If the selector lever is very stiff it needs servicing. • If the selector lever moves freely, the push-pull cable’s travel is misadjusted and needs to be corrected. D) If the tone did not cease in step B), remove the push-pull cable from the Processor. E) Move the Control Head lever back and forth from Neutral to Ahead to Astern. • If the tone ceases, the push-pull cable is defective and needs to be replaced. PageB5-6 TROUBLESHOOTING • If the tone did not cease, check the DC Voltage to the Processor by accessing the Diagnostic Menu . If the voltage is adequate, replace the Processor. H0 ERVO B5-3 S ONTROL SYSTEM TONES 2 C B5-3.1 One Long - Two Short Tones Figure B5-25: One Long - Two Short Tones This tone indicates that the feedback signal, which represents the position of the Servo 2 cross-bar, is out of expected range. This tone will be accompanied by Error Code 66 or 67. • If Error Code is displayed, the signal received from the feedback potentiometer is higher than expected. This is due to one of the three following reasons: 66 1. The orange wire (ground) between the potentiometer and plug are not making contact, or have a high resistance contact. 2. The potentiometer is out of calibration. 3. The potentiometer is defective. • If Error Code is displayed, the signal received from the feedback potentiometer is lower than expected. This is due to one of the following reasons: 67 1. The green (signal) or orange (reference voltage) wires between the potentiometer and plug are not making contact or have a high resistance contact. 2. The potentiometer is out of calibration. 3. The potentiometer is defective. 4. The Control Circuit is defective. The Servo 2 feedback signal can be viewed within the Diagnostic Menu. The Value displayed depends on the direction and amount of push-pull cable travel. As a general rule: • When the Value displayed is or , the problem is with the wiring between the potentiometer and plug. • If the displayed Value varies, the potentiometer is defective. • When the Value is slightly too high or too low when fully extended, the potentiometer requires calibration. 1023 0 B5-3.2 One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones Figure B5-26: One Long, Two Short - High Repetitive Rate Tones This tone is also referred to as a Jam Tone. When sounded, Servo 2 is unable to reach the commanded position. In most cases when a Jam Tone is encountered, it can be cleared by moving the Control Head lever back to the point prior to where the tone was first encountered. The tone will be accompanied by Error Code 65 and is typically caused by one of the following reasons: • Stiff or frozen selector lever. • Misadjusted push-pull cable. PageB5-7 TROUBLESHOOTING • Defective push-pull cable. • Low battery voltage. • Defective Processor. In order to isolate the cause to one of these five items, follow the steps below: A) Turn the power ON to the Processor. • If the tone is not present continue with step C) • If the tone is present, check the DC voltage to the Processor by accessing the Diagnostic Menu H0. If the voltage is adequate continue with step B. B) Disconnect the push-pull cable from the selector lever. • If the tone is still present after cycling power, replace the Processor. • If the tone is no longer present, continue with step C) C) If disconnected, reconnect the push-pull cable. D) Depress the Transfer Button while moving the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. E) Release the transfer button and continue to move the Control Head lever through the speed range. • If the tone does not sound until the Control Head lever is close to full throttle, Function Code E3 Throttle Maximum is misadjusted. • If the tone sounds earlier than full throttle, continue with step F). F) Disconnect the push-pull cable from the selector lever. G) Manually reposition the selector lever (Idle to Full). • If the selector lever is very stiff it needs to be serviced. • If the selector lever moves freely, the push-pull cable is defective and needs replacing. B5-4 CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL SYSTEM TONES B5-4.1 One Long - One Short Tone Figure B5-27: One Long - One Short Tone This tone can be produced if solenoid monitoring is turned ON with Function Code H2. When this tone is sounded this tone will also be accompanied by one of the following error codes: 1 - Clutch Astern Shorted 2 - Clutch Astern Open 5 - Clutch Ahead Shorted 6 - Clutch Ahead Open PageB5-8 TROUBLESHOOTING B6 TROUBLESHOOTING STATION TRANSFER In order to transfer command from one Remote Station to another, the following must occur: There must be a valid “Command Signal” at the Station being transferred to. • The “Command Signal” must indicate that the Control Head’s lever(s) is at the Neutral/Idle position. • The Transfer Button must be depressed which takes the “Station Select” signal from 5.00 VDC to 0.00 VDC. • If a transfer from one Remote Station to another is requested, but does not take place; the items required for successful transfer can be tested as follows: OMMAND SIGNAL B6-1 C The Command Signal is a DC voltage which varies in relationship to the Control Head’s lever position. The Processor provides each Control Head 5.00 +/- 0.20VDC, which is referred to as the “Reference Voltage”. The Reference Voltage is applied to a 5K Ohm Potentiometer in the Control Head. The potentiometer’s “Wiper” taps off a portion of the Reference Voltage and sends it back to the Processor. The amount of DC voltage which is tapped off, is dependant on the position of the Control Head’s lever. When the lever is fully Astern, a small portion of the Reference Voltage is tapped off by the wiper, and therefore, the voltage is at its lowest point (approximately 0.80 VDC). When the lever is positioned fully Ahead, a larger portion is tapped off and the voltage is at its highest point (approximately 4.10 VDC). B6-2 A TO D COUNTS Since all the calculations within the control system are performed digitally, these DC voltages are expressed as and converted to a digital representation. • The “Reference Voltage” (approximately 5.00 VDC) by which all analog inputs are based, is represented as 1023 A/D (Analog to Digital) Counts. • This allows for the possibility of a 1024 possible positions when 0 is included in the count. • The value of the Command Voltage with the lever at the Neutral/ Idle position is 49- 51% of the Reference Voltage when measured at the Station terminal block. The actual value read by the Processor is 2% below that value or 47% to 49% of 1023 A/D Counts (485505 A/D). Page B6-1 TROUBLESHOOTING NOTE: THE A/D VALUES LISTED FOR FULL AHEAD AND FULL ASTERN REPRESENT THE POINT WHERE MAXIMUM THROTTLE IS REACHED. THE A/D COUNT WHEN THE CONTROL HEAD LEVER IS PHYSICALLY AT IT ’S MAXIMUM POINT WILL BE HIGHER, BUT MAY NOT EXCEED THE OUT-OF-RANGE VALUES LISTED IN TABLE B6-3:, PAGE B6-2. • The Command Signal at Full Ahead is 82- 84% of the Reference Voltage when measured at the Station terminal block. The actual value read by the Processor is 2% below that value or 80- 82% of 1023 A/D Counts (821- 841 A/D). • The Command Signal at Full Astern is 17 - 19% of the Reference Voltage when measured at the Station terminal block. The actual value read by the Processor is 2% below that value or 15- 17% of 1023 A/D Counts (153- 173 A/D). • Since the Command Signal is based on a percentage of the Reference Voltage, the distance of the Control Head from the Processor has no impact on the performance of the system. • The amount of voltage drop, due to current flow, is the same for both the Reference and Command Voltages. • The relationship between the Reference and Command Voltages when thought of as a percentage, will remain the same regardless of distance. For instance, here are two examples. Example 1 Reference Voltage 5.00 VDC1023 A/D Counts Command Voltage2.45 VDC501 A/D Counts Example 2 Reference Voltage4.80 VDC1023 A/D Counts Command Voltage2.35 VDC501 A/D Counts As you can see by the examples, even though the Command Voltages are different between Examples 1 and 2, the resulting A/D counts, are the same because of the different Reference Voltages. This would result in the Processor commanding the identical outputs (Clutch & Throttle) in both cases. A) The A/D count for a specific Control Head’s lever can be seen on the Processor’s Display by following the steps outlined in Section B4, page B4-1. B) Once the appropriate remote station is reached, ensure that the displayed A/D Count represents the Neutral/Idle position (485- 505 A/D counts). Command will not be accepted unless the Control Head’s lever is at the Neutral/Idle position. The following table shows the appropriate A/D Counts for various Control Head lever positions: Table B6-3: Control Head Lever A/D Counts Control Head Lever Position Lever Out of Range Low Full Astern Neutral/ Idle Page B6-2 A/D Count 100 153 - 173 485 - 505 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B6-3: Control Head Lever A/D Counts Control Head Lever Position Ahead Shift Point Full Ahead Lever Out of Range High A/D Count 537 821 - 841 910 EMOTE STATION SELECT B6-3 R The second required item for taking command is “Station Select” or depressing of the Transfer Button. • The Transfer Button can be tested by entering the Diagnostic Menu H0. A) Depress the Up or Down (scroll) Push Button until four zeroes are displayed without decimal points as shown in Figure B6-28:. Figure B6-28: Display Station A/D’s No Station B) For Stations 1 - 4 when the Transfer Transfer Button Depressed Button is depressed, the 0 which represents that remote station, will change to a 1 as shown in Figure B6-29:. For Station 5 when the Transfer Button is depressed, all four decimal points will Figure B6-29: Example Display Station A/D’s Transfer light as shown in Figure B6-30: Button Depressed for Stations 1 - 4 • Figure B6-30: Display Station A/D/s Transfer Button Depressed for Station 5 Page B6-3 Whenever command cannot be gained at a particular remote station, the Station Select and Command Signals are the first to be investigated. If either the Command Signal is out of range or the Station Select is inoperable, command will not be accepted at that remote station. TROUBLESHOOTING B7 TROUBLESHOOTING STUCK TRANSFER BUTTON The Transfer Button is a normally open, momentary switch. The only time the switch should close is when it is depressed to take command or when entering or departing various other functions. In the event that the Transfer Button became stuck in the closed position, the following will occur: • The Transfer Button would have to be closed for 15 seconds or more. • The throttle and clutch are not affected. • A solid tone is heard from all remote stations, until the button’s contact opens or transfer to another remote station has taken place. If a Control Head that is not in command has a stuck transfer button, the following will happen: • If Control Head levers are positioned at Neutral/Idle, a solid tone is heard from all remote stations. • If Control Head levers are positioned other than Neutral/ Idle, a three (3) second tone is heard from all remote stations. • Error Code 33 - 42, depending on which remote station, will be shown on the Processor Display. • Command can be taken at any other operational remote station. • After one (1) second command can be regained at the remote station with the stuck button as long as the problem has been corrected by depressing the transfer button. If a stuck Transfer Button is suspected, this can be verified by looking at the Station Select status (1 or 0) as outlined in Section B6-3, page B6-3. • An Error Code 33 - 42 will be shown on the Display, depending on which Station is experiencing the problem. Page B7-1 TROUBLESHOOTING B8 ERROR CODES As stated previously, if a problem with the Control System is detected, the Processor is programmed to display numerous Error Codes to aid in the isolation of the cause. The following tables list these Error Codes, along with a brief description . LUTCH SOLENOID ERROR CODES B8-4 C Table B8-4: Clutch Solenoid Control System Error Codes Error Title No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Clutch Astern Shorted Clutch Astern Open Clutch Neutral Shorted Clutch Neutral Open Clutch Ahead Shorted Clutch Ahead Open The Astern Clutch Solenoid is requiring more current than expected. The Astern Clutch Solenoid should be drawing current but is not. The Neutral Clutch Solenoid is requiring more current than expected. The Neutral Clutch Solenoid should be drawing current but is not. The Ahead Clutch Solenoid is requiring more current than expected. The Ahead Clutch Solenoid should be drawing current but is not. ROLL SOLENOID ERROR CODES B8-5 T Error No. 7 8 9 10 Table B8-5: Troll Solenoid Control System Error Codes Title Description Troll ON/OFF Shorted Troll ON/OFF Open Troll Command Shorted Troll Command Open The Troll ON/OFF Solenoid is requiring more current than expected. The Troll ON/OFF Solenoid should be drawing current but is not. The Troll Proportional Solenoid is requiring more current than expected. The Troll Proportional Solenoid should be drawing current but is not. ASIC CONTROL SYSTEM ERROR CODES B8-6 B Error Title No. 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 Station No.1 Faulted High Station No.2 Faulted High Station No.3 Faulted High Station No.4 Faulted High Station No.5 Faulted High Station No.6 Faulted High Station No.7 Faulted High Station No.8 Faulted High Station No.9 Faulted High Station No.10 Faulted High Station No.1 Faulted Low Station No.2 Faulted Low Station No.3 Faulted Low Table B8-6: Basic Control System Error Codes Description Station No.1 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.2 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.3 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.4 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.5 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.6 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.7 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.8 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.9 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.10 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too high. Station No.1 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.2 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.3 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. PageB8-1 TROUBLESHOOTING 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 Station No.4 Faulted Low Station No.5 Faulted Low Station No.6 Faulted Low Station No.7 Faulted Low Station No.8 Faulted Low Station No.9 Faulted Low Station No.10 Faulted Low Station No.1 Button Stuck Closed Station No.2 Button Stuck Closed Station No.3 Button Stuck Closed Station No.4 Button Stuck Closed Station No.5 Button Stuck Closed Station No.6 Button Stuck Closed Error Title No. 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 Table B8-6: Basic Control System Error Codes Station No.7 Button Stuck Closed Station No.8 Button Stuck Closed Station No.9 Button Stuck Closed Station No.10 Button Stuck Closed CAN Communication Stuffing Error CAN Communication Form Error CAN Communication Acknowledge Error CAN Communication Bit 1 Error CAN Communication Bit 0 Error CAN Communication CRC Error CAN Communication Bus Error Comm. Error Time-out System 1 Comm. Error Time-out System 2 Comm. Error Time-out System 3 Comm. Error Time-out System 4 Comm. Error Time-out System 5 SE Communication Error High Battery Voltage Fault Low Battery Voltage Fault Reset Due to Software Watchdog Reset Due to Software Fault Station No.4 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.5 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.6 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.7 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.8 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.9 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.10 Control Head’s lever position is out of range. The input appears to be too low. Station No.1 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.2 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.3 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.4 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.5 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.6 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Description Station No.7 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.8 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.9 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. Station No.10 Control Head’s Transfer Button has either been closed too long or has been closed since power-up. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a stuffing error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a form error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is an acknowledge error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a Bit 1 error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a Bit 0 error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a CRC error. The Control-Area-Network protocol has detected an error in communication with other devices on the network. The error type is a Bus failure error. The error cannot be recovered from without cycling power to the Processor. Communication with System 1 has been too long without a Refresh message. Communication with System 1 has been too long without a Refresh message. Communication with System 1 has been too long without a Refresh message. Communication with System 1 has been too long without a Refresh message. Communication with System 1 has been too long without a Refresh message. Communication with the Station Expander has been too long without a Refresh message. The applied battery voltage is 30VDC or higher for at least two seconds. The applied battery voltage is 10VDC or lower for at least two seconds. The system has had an unexpected Reset, due to a software/ hardware fault. The system has had an unexpected Reset, due to a software fault. PageB8-2 TROUBLESHOOTING 60 61 Table B8-6: Basic Control System Error Codes Reset Due to Hardware Watchdog Oscillator Watchdog The system has had an unexpected Reset, due to a software/ hardware fault. The system’s Oscillator has had an unexpected fault. RROR CODES B8-7 SERVO 1 E Error No. 62 63 64 Table B8-7: Servo 1 Error Codes Title Servo 1 Jam Servo 1Feedback High Servo 1 Feedback Low Description Servo one is unable to make any progress toward its commanded position. Servo one’s position feedback voltage is higher than the acceptable range. Servo one’s position feedback voltage is lower than the acceptable range. ERVO 2 ERROR CODES B8-8 S Error No. 65 66 67 Table B8-8: Servo 2 Error Codes Title Servo 2 Jam Servo 2 Feedback High Servo 2 Feedback Low Description Servo two is unable to make any progress toward its commanded position. Servo two’s position feedback voltage is higher than the acceptable range. Servo two’s position feedback voltage is lower than the acceptable range. PageB8-3 TROUBLESHOOTING B9 BASIC PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS The following table lists the various Error Codes and provides possible causes and solutions. Error Codes appearing on the Port side Processor’s Display LED are port side errors and vice versa. The Causes and Solutions provided are the most likely, but are not the only possible causes for the Errors Codes listed. ASIC CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-1 B Error No. Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Causes Solutions 13 a. Station No.1 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. a. Replace Station No.1 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.2 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.3 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.4 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.5 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.6 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.7 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.8 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.9 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. a. Replace Station No.10 Control Head. b. Ensure that the red conductor is properly crimped to pin 5 at both connectors. c. Install a jumper from pin 3 to 5 on right hand and 3 to 7 on left hand Control Heads. 14 a. The Station No.2 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 15 a. The Station No.3 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 16 a. The Station No.4 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 17 a. The Station No.5 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 18 a. The Station No.6 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 19 a. The Station No.7 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 20 a. The Station No.8 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 21 a. The Station No.9 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. 22 a. The Station No.10 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 5’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. Control Head jumper (pin 3 to 5 or 7) is missing. Page B9-1 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. Causes 23 a. The Station No.1 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 24 a. The Station No.2 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 25 a. The Station No.3 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 26 a. The Station No.4 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 27 a. The Station No.5 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 28 a. The Station No.6 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 29 a. The Station No.7 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 30 a. The Station No.8 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 31 a. The Station No.9 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 32 a. The Station No.10 Control Head is defective. b. No continuity between pin 6’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. c. No continuity between pin 7’s of the Control Head Harness connectors. 33 a. The Station No.1 transfer button was held down for 15 seconds or longer b. The Station No.1 Control Head transfer button is defective c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. Page B9-2 Solutions a. Replace Station No.1 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.2 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.3 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.4 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.5 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.6 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.7 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.8 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.9 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Replace Station No.10 Control Head. b. Ensure that the green conductor is properly crimped to pin 6 at both connectors and there is continuity. c. Ensure that the blue conductor is properly crimped to pin 7 at both connectors and there is continuity. a. Clear the Error Code from memory b. Replace the Control Head c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. In addition, ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. Causes Solutions 34 a. The Station No.2 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.2 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 35 a. The Station No.3 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.3 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 36 a. The Station No.4 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.4 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 37 a. The Station No.5 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.5 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 38 a. The Station No.6 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.6 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Page B9-3 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. Causes Solutions 39 a. The Station No.7 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.7 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 40 a. The Station No.8 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.8 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 41 a. The Station No.9 transfer button was held down for 15 a. Clear the Error Code from memory. seconds or longer. b. The Station No.9 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 42 a. The Station No.10 transfer button was held down for a. Clear the Error Code from memory. 15 seconds or longer. b. The Station No.10 Control Head transfer button is b. Replace the Control Head. defective. c. The Control Head Harness is miswired. c. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 at both ends and the red wire is crimped to pin 5 at both ends of the Harness. d. The Control Head’s Pigtail is miswired. d. Ensure that the orange conductor is crimped to pin 4 of the connector and connected to pin 4 of the Control Head’s terminal block. Ensure that the red conductor is crimped to pin 5 of the connector and connected to pin 3 of the Control Head’s terminal block. 43 a. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). b. The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. c. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. 44 a. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). b. The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. c. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. 45 a. The Serial Harness is not connected at one or more a. Ensure that the Serial Harness is properly seated at all Processors. Processors. b. The Serial Harness is incorrectly wired. b. Refer to the Serial Plug pin-out in Section Table B13-4: page B13-2. Correct or replace the Harness. c. Loss of power to one of the Processors. c. Restore Power to the Processor. Page B9-4 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. Causes Solutions 46 a. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). b. c. 47 a. b. c. 48 a. b. c. 49 a. b. c. 50 a. b. c. 51 a. b. 52 c. a. b. c. 53 a. b. c. 54 a. b. c. 55 a. b. c. 56 a. b. 57 a. b. c. 58 a. b. a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. The Serial Harness is in excess of 120 feet (37m). a. Reposition the Processor(s) so that the Serial Harness is less than 120 feet (37m). The Processor is defective. b. Replace the faulty Processor. The Serial Harness’s shield is not properly terminated. c. Ensure that the shield is terminated and the termination is at one side only. The Serial Harness is not connected at Processor ID a. Connect the Serial Harness into Processor ID No.1. No.1. None of the Processors has ID No. 1 selected. b. Identify one of the Processors as ID No.1 with the A0 function. Loss of power to Processor ID No.1. c. Restore power to Processor ID No.1. The Serial Harness is not connected at Processor ID a. Connect the Serial Harness into Processor ID No.2. No.2. None of the Processors has ID No.2 selected. b. Identify one of the Processors as ID No.2 with the A0 function. Loss of power to Processor ID No.2 c. Restore power to Processor ID No.2. The Serial Harness is not connected at Processor ID a. Connect the Serial Harness into Processor ID No.3. No.3. None of the Processors has ID No.3 selected. b. Identify one of the Processors as ID No.3 with the A0 function. Loss of power to Processor ID No.3. c. Restore power to Processor ID No.3. The Serial Harness is not connected at Processor ID a. Connect the Serial Harness into Processor ID No.4. No.4. None of the Processors has ID No.4 selected. b. Identify one of the Processors as ID No.4 with the A0 function. Loss of power to Processor ID No.4. c. Restore power to Processor ID No.4. The Serial Harness is not connected at Processor ID a. Connect the Serial Harness into Processor ID No.5. No.5. None of the Processors has ID No.5 selected. b. Identify one of the Processors as ID No.5 with the A0 function. Loss of power to Processor ID No.5. c. Restore power to Processor ID No.5. The Serial Harness is not connected to the SE. a. Connect the Serial Harness to the SE. The Serial Harness is not connected to the Processor b. Connect the Serial Harness to the Processor reporting reporting the fault. the fault. No power to the SE. c. Turn power ‘On’ to the SE. The battery is being overcharged. a. Repair or replace the charging system. There’s a loose terminal on the battery while being b. Clean and tighten the battery posts and terminals. charged. Battery will not take a charge and is defective. a. Replace the battery. The battery is not being properly charged. b. Repair or replace the charging system. There’s a high resistance connection between the bat- c. Locate and repair the high resistance connection. tery and the Processor. External Interference, such as a lightning strike. a. If the error message is displayed once and you are able to clear the error, take no further actions at this time. If the error cannot be cleared, replace the Processor. Component failure. b. Replace the Processor. Page B9-5 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-9: Basic Control System Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. Causes Solutions 59 a. External Interference, such as a lightning strike. a. If the error message is displayed once and you are able to clear the error, take no further actions at this time. If the error cannot be cleared, replace the Processor. b. Replace the Processor. a. If the error message is displayed once and you are able to clear the error, take no further actions at this time. If the error cannot be cleared, replace the Processor. b. Replace the Processor. a. If the error message is displayed once and you are able to clear the error, take no further actions at this time. If the error cannot be cleared, replace the Processor. b. Replace the Processor. b. Component failure. 60 a. External Interference, such as a lightning strike. b. Component failure. 61 a. External Interference, such as a lightning strike. b. Component failure. ERVO 2 THROTTLE PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-2 S Error No. 65 Table B9-10: Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions Causes Solutions a. Excessive Throttle Push-Pull cable travel. b. The load on the Push-Pull cable exceeds 40 Lbs. c. The Push-Pull cable is defective. d. The Processor’s Throttle Servo (Servo 2) is defective. e. Low battery voltage. 66 a. b. 67 c. a. b. c. d. a. Readjust Function Code E2 or E3. b. Contact a certified engine technician to determine the cause of the excessive load. c. Replace the Push-Pull cable. d. Replace the Processor. e. Charge, repair or replace the battery, charging system or power distribution system. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomeof calibration. ter. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is b. Replace The Processor or the potentiometer. defective. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. c. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomeof calibration. ter. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is b. Plug the feedback potentiometer’s brown plug into unplugged from the Circuit Board. the Circuit Board. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is c. Replace the Processor or the feedback potentiomedefective. ter. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. d. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. ERVO 1 CLUTCH PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-3 S Error No. 62 Causes Solutions a. Excessive Clutch Push-Pull cable travel. b. The load on the Push-Pull cable exceeds 40 Lbs. c. d. e. 63 Table B9-11: Servo 1 Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions a. b. c. a. Readjust Function Code C6 and or C7. b. Contact a certified Marine Transmission technician to determine the cause of the excessive load. The Push-Pull cable is defective. c. Replace the Push-Pull cable. The Processor’s Clutch Servo (Servo 1) is defective. d. Replace the Processor. Low battery voltage. e. Charge, repair or replace the battery, charging system or power distribution system. The Clutch Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomecalibration. ter. The Clutch Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defec- b. Replace the Processor or replace the potentiometive. ter. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. c. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. Page B9-6 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-11: Servo 1 Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. 64 Causes Solutions a. The Clutch Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of calibration. b. The Clutch Servo’s feedback potentiometer is unplugged from the Circuit Board. c. The Clutch Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defective. d. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiometer. b. Plug the feedback potentiometer’s brown plug into the Circuit Board. c. Replace the Processor or the feedback potentiometer. d. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. ERVO 2 THROTTLE PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-4 S Error No. 65 Table B9-12: Servo 2 Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions Causes Solutions a. Excessive Throttle Push-Pull cable travel. b. The load on the Push-Pull cable exceeds 40 Lbs. c. The Push-Pull cable is defective. d. The Processor’s Throttle Servo (Servo 2) is defective. e. Low battery voltage. 66 a. b. 67 c. a. b. c. d. a. Readjust Function Code E2 or E3. b. Contact a certified engine technician to determine the cause of the excessive load. c. Replace the Push-Pull cable. d. Replace the Processor. e. Charge, repair or replace the battery, charging system or power distribution system. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomeof calibration. ter. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is b. Replace The Processor or the potentiometer. defective. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. c. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomeof calibration. ter. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is b. Plug the feedback potentiometer’s brown plug into unplugged from the Circuit Board. the Circuit Board. The Throttle Servo’s feedback potentiometer is c. Replace the Processor or the feedback potentiomedefective. ter. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. d. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. ERVO 1 TROLL PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-5 S Error No. 62 Causes Solutions a. Excessive Troll Push-Pull cable travel. b. The load on the Push-Pull cable exceeds 40 Lbs. c. d. e. 63 Table B9-13: Servo 1 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions a. b. c. a. Readjust Function Code L2 and / or L3. b. Contact a certified Marine Transmission technician to determine the cause of the excessive load. The Push-Pull cable is defective. c. Replace the Push-Pull cable. The Processor’s Troll Servo (Servo 1) is defective. d. Replace the Processor. Low battery voltage. e. Charge, repair or replace the battery, charging system or power distribution system. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomecalibration. ter. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defec- b. Replace the Processor or replace the potentiometive. ter. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. c. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. Page B9-7 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B9-13: Servo 1 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions Error No. 64 Causes Solutions a. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of calibration. b. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is unplugged from the Circuit Board. c. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defective. d. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiometer. b. Plug the feedback potentiometer’s brown plug into the Circuit Board. c. Replace the Processor or the feedback potentiometer. d. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. ERVO 2 TROLL PROBLEM CAUSES AND SOLUTIONS B9-6 S Error No. 65 Causes a. b. 67 Solutions a. Excessive Troll Push-Pull cable travel. b. The load on the Push-Pull cable exceeds 40 Lbs. c. d. e. 66 Table B9-14: Servo 2 Troll Problem Causes and Solutions c. a. b. c. d. a. Readjust Function Code L3 or L3. b. Contact a certified engine technician to determine the cause of the excessive load. The Push-Pull cable is defective. c. Replace the Push-Pull cable. The Processor’s Troll Servo (Servo 2) is defective. d. Replace the Processor. Low battery voltage. e. Charge, repair or replace the battery, charging system or power distribution system. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomecalibration. ter. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defec- b. Replace The Processor or the potentiometer. tive. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. c. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is out of a. Replace the Processor or calibrate the potentiomecalibration. ter. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is b. Plug the feedback potentiometer’s brown plug into unplugged from the Circuit Board. the Circuit Board. The Troll Servo’s feedback potentiometer is defec- c. Replace the Processor or the feedback potentiometive. ter. The Processor’s Circuit Board is defective. d. Replace the Processor or the Circuit Board. Page B9-8 TROUBLESHOOTING B10 PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES In addition to the Error Codes listed above, some problems may not necessarily generate Error Codes. The following give some examples where the Processor may not detect a fault, though the operation may not be perfect: ASIC CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES B10-1B A) No audible tones heard at one Control Station when power is first applied to the Processor. All other features function normally. SYMPTOM: Cause B) Remedy a. Incorrectly wired Station Harness/ Cable a. Verify that the black wire is properly conor Pigtail. nected to pin 1 on the Control Head and Pin 8 at the Processor. b. The Control Head’s Sound Transducer is b. Measure the AC voltage at pins 1 & 3 of the defective. Control Head. If 20- 25 VAC is present, replace the Control Head. The Control Head’s red LED doesn’t light when in command, but otherwise functions properly. SYMPTOM: Cause C) Remedy a. Incorrectly wired Station Harness/ Cable a. Verify that the brown wire is properly conor Pigtail. nected to pin 2 on the Control head and pin 2 at the Processor. b. The Control Head’s red LED or circuit is b. Measure the DC voltage at pins 2 & 3 at the open. Control. The measurement will be approximately 2.20 VDC when the red LED is lit. If 4.00 VDC is measured, the red LED or its circuit is open. Replace the Control Head. When power is turned ON to the Processor, there are no tones from any of the Remote Stations, the Control Head red LED does not light when the Transfer Button is pressed, and the Display is not lit at the Processor SYMPTOM: . Cause a. No power to the Processor. D) Remedy a. Disconnect the Power Harness from the Processor. Measure the DC voltage at pins 10 (+) and 11 (-) of the Harness plug. If 12 or 24 VDC is not present, check the circuit breakers, switches and cables feeding power to the Processor. Correct the power source as required. b. The battery’s polarity is reversed at the b. Disconnect the Power Harness from the ProProcessor. cessor. Connect a voltmeter’s red lead to pin 10 and the black lead to pin 11 of the Harness’s plug. If negative voltage is measured, reverse the wires. c. Defective Processor. c. If Causes a. and b. were not the fault, replace the Processor. The engine begins to turn-over while starting and then stops. A slow repetitive tone is heard from all Remote Stations. SYMPTOM: Cause Remedy a. The voltage available at the Processor a. Supply power to the Processor from a battery has dropped too low, due to the starter’s other that the starting battery or supply current requirement power from two sources through an APS (Automatic Power Selector) b. Battery charge is too low b. Recharge/ replace the battery or supply battery power from two sources through an APS. Page B10-1 TROUBLESHOOTING E) SYMPTOM: Active Synchronization is inoperable. Cause Remedy a. There is no Tachometer Sensor signal at a. The Tachometer Sensor frequency can be the Port or Starboard Processor. seen on the Processor’s Display by accessing the Diagnostic Menu H0. If the frequency is not measured, check the Tachometer Sensor and the wiring. b. Loss of Serial Communication between b. If Active Synchronization is inoperative due the Processors. to a lack of Serial Communications, one or more Error Codes will be displayed indicating the loss of communication. c. The Processor’s Identification number(s) c. All Processors must have a unique identificahave not been set properly. tion number as set with Function Code A0. Refer to Section 5-6.1.1., page 5-8. d. The correct number of engines has not d. All Processor must have the same number of been set. engines selected as programmed with Function Code A1. Refer to Section 5-6.1.2., page 5-9. ERVO CLUTCH CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES B10-2S A) Cannot obtain Warm-up Mode while moving the Control Head lever in the Ahead direction, only in the Astern direction. SYMPTOM: Cause a. The Processor is sensing that the Control Head’s lever is moving in the Astern direction Remedy Depress the Transfer Button while moving the Control Head lever in the Astern direction. If the LED begins to blink, the Control Head is incorrectly wired. • Check the colors of the wires at pins 5 and 7. • A right hand Control Head should have yellow at pin 5 and blue at pin 7. • A left hand Control Head should have blue at pin 5 and yellow at pin 7. • The Clutch Servo’s direction of travel must be changed with Function Code C5 if the yellow and blue wires are reversed. ERVO THROTTLE CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES B10-3S A) The engine RPM’s vary, without moving the Control Head lever (synchronization disabled). SYMPTOM: Cause B) Remedy a. Problem with the Governor or Carbure- a. Observe the Throttle push-pull cable. If varitor. ations are seen, proceed to Step b. b. Erratic Command Signal. b. Refer to Command Signal testing in Section B6-1 and Section B6-2, page B6-1. If variations of the A/D counts occur, connect the Control Head to another Station (if available) on the Processor. If variations persist, replace the Control Head. SYMPTOM: The engine’s Idle is too high. Cause Remedy a. Idle was not adjusted mechanically cor- a. Adjust the Throttle Push-Pull cable as specirect at the Idle stop. fied in Section 5-6.2.2.1., page 5-16. b. Function Code E2 Throttle Minimum is b. Adjust Throttle Minimum as specified in Secincorrectly set. tion 5-6.2.2.2, page 5-17. c. After Causes a. and b. have been eliminated, c. The Governor or Carburetor is incorrectly adjusted. contact a certified engine mechanic to properly adjust. Page B10-2 TROUBLESHOOTING OLENOID CLUTCH CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES B10-4S A) Cannot obtain Warm-up Mode while moving the Control Head lever in the Ahead direction, only in the Astern direction. SYMPTOM: Cause a. The Processor is sensing that the Control Head’s lever is moving in the Astern direction Remedy Depress the Transfer Button while moving the Control Head lever in the Astern direction. If the LED begins to blink, the Control Head is incorrectly wired. • Check the colors of the wires at pins 5 and 7. • A right hand Control Head should have yellow at pin 5 and blue at pin 7. • A left hand Control Head should have blue at pin 5 and yellow at pin 7. • Ahead and Astern Solenoid Wires need to be reversed. LECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL SYSTEM PROBLEMS WITHOUT ERROR CODES B10-5E A) The engine RPM’s vary, without moving the Control Head lever (synchronization disabled). SYMPTOM: Cause Remedy a. Problem with the Governor. a. Connect the Break-out Box (p/n 13927) as shown in the Throttle Testing Section of the Service Field Test Unit Manual. If variations are seen, proceed to Step B). If no variations are seen, contact a certified engine mechanic. b. Refer to Command Signal testing in Section and Section B5-1.2, page B5-2. If variations of the A/D counts occur, connect the Control Head to another Station (if available) on the Processor. If variations persist, replace the Control Head. b. Erratic Command Signal. B) SYMPTOM: The engine’s Idle speed is too high. Cause Remedy a. Function Code Throttle Minimum is a. Adjust Throttle Minimum as specified in Secincorrectly set. tion 5-6.2.3.2, page 5-20. b. Function Code High Idle is prob. Decide whether High Idle is required or not. grammed to a value other than . If not required, set the value of to . If the High Idle feature is required, press the Transfer Button for approximately 1/2 second to toggle to Low Idle. c. The Governor or its Control Module is c. After Causes a. and b. have been eliminated, incorrectly adjusted or faulty. contact a certified engine mechanic to properly adjust. E2 E6 00.0 Page B10-3 E6 00.0 TROUBLESHOOTING B11 SYNCHRONIZATION TROUBLESHOOTING If you encounter a problem with Synchronization, it will more than likely one of the following; failure to attempt to synchronize, synchronizing at different RPM’s or RPM variations of one or both engines while synchronized. Each problem is distinct and the cause may differ depending on the type of Synch. Therefore, each type is discussed individually. QUAL THROTTLE SYNCHRONIZATION B11-1E B11-1.1Basic Troubleshooting Symptom 1. Will not synchronize. Table B11-15: Basic Problem Causes and Solutions Causes a. Synchronization is Disabled Solutions a. At the Station-in-Command, move both Control Head levers to more than 5% of the speed range. Press and hold the transfer button for 5 seconds. If synch is disabled, the green LED will light as long as the button is pressed. If synch was enabled, the green LED would have blinked twice. b. The Serial Communication Harness is not b. Plug the Serial Communication Harness plugged into both Processors. into both Processors. c. The Port and Starboard Processors are c. Scroll to Function Code A1, on the Port not set up for Twin Screw operation. and Starboard Processor. Enter a Value of 02 into both Processors. d. The Port and Starboard Processors have d. On the Port Processor, scroll to Function the same ID number. Code A0 and enter a Value of 01. On the Starboard Processor, scroll to Function Code A0 and enter a Value of 02. B11-1.2Servo Throttle Troubleshooting Table B11-16: Servo Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions Symptom Causes Solutions 1. The green LED is lit a. The throttle travel from Idle to Full is set a. Scroll to Function Codes E2 and E3 on solid, though the Engine differently on the Port and Starboard Proboth Processors and compare the Values. RPM’s differ by a significessors. The Values of E2 and E3 must be the same cant amount. for both Processors. b. The engines run at different RPM’s with b. While underway at cruising speed, equal travel of the Governors’/ Carburedecrease the Value of Function Code E3 tors’ selector lever. on the Processor running at the higher RPM until both engine are at the same RPM. This is not a normal condition and is masking the actual problem with the engine. Top speed may be sacrificed by doing so. Install Tach Senders and enable Active Synchronization with Function Code E7. c. Excessive back-lash in the push-pull c. Remove the excessive back-lash or install cable(s) or linkage. Tach Senders and enable Active Synchronization with Function Code E7. d. Excessive bends in the push-pull cable(s). d. Reroute the push-pull cable(s) or install Tach Sender and enable Active Synchronization with Function Code E7. Page B11-1 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B11-16: Servo Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions Symptom 2. One or both of the engines continually changes RPM (hunts). Will not synchronize properly 3. Will not synchronize. Causes a. A Control Head’s Command Signal is varying. Solutions a. Scroll to the Diagnostic Menu Function Code H0. Go to the appropriate Station A/D Count’s display. The Value should not change by more than +/- 1 A/D Count. If so, check the connections and if good, replace the Control Head. b. The push-pull cable’s travel from Idle to b. Lengthen the Governor or Carburetor’s Full is too short. selector lever and attach the push-pull cable to a point where the travel is in excess of 2.00 inches (50,8mm). a. Excessive bends in the push-pull cable(s). a. Reroute the push-pull cable(s) or install Tach Sender and enable Active Synchronization with Function Code E7. B11-1.3Servo Clutch Troubleshooting Table B11-17: Servo Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions Symptom 1. Will not synchronize. Causes a. The Processor(s) think Astern is being commanded. Solutions a. Place both the Port and Starboard Processors into Warm-up Mode by pressing the transfer button while moving the Control Head levers to the Ahead detent. Both red LED’s on the Control Head should be blinking. If not, reverse the wires at pins 5 and 7 at the Control Head. Change the Clutch direction with Function Code C5. B11-2ACTIVE SYNCHRONIZATION B11-2.1Basic Troubleshooting Table B11-18: Basic Problem Causes and Solutions System Causes 1. The green LED is lit a. The Tach Sender signal has been lost by solid, though the Engine one or both Processors. RPM’s differ by a significant amount. 2. Will not synchronize. a. b. c. D. Solutions a. Scroll to Function Code H0. Go to the Value for the Tach Sender’s input frequency. If the frequency displayed is 0000, the signal has been lost and the system diverted to Equal Throttle Synch. Correct the wiring or replace the Sender. Synchronization is Disabled a. At the Station-in-Command, move both Control Head levers to more than 5% of the speed range. Press and hold the transfer button for 5 seconds. If synch is disabled, the green LED will light as long as the button is pressed. If synch was enabled, the green LED would have blinked twice. The Serial Communication Harness is not b. Plug the Serial Communication Harness plugged into both Processors. into both Processors. The Port and Starboard Processors have c. On the Port Processor, scroll to Function the same ID number. Code A0 and enter a Value of 01. On the Starboard Processor, scroll to Function Code A0 and enter a Value of 02. The Port and Starboard Processors are not d. Scroll to Function Code A1, on the Port set up for twin screw operation. and Starboard Processor. Enter a Value of 02 into both Processors. Page B11-2 TROUBLESHOOTING B11-2.2Servo Throttle Troubleshooting System Table B11-19: Servo Throttle Problem Causes and Solutions Causes 1. One or both of the a. A Control Head’s Command Signal is vary- a. engines continually ing. changes RPM. Will not synchronize properly. b. The engine(s) is not running smoothly. c. Defective Tach Sender Solutions Scroll to the Diagnostic Menu Function Code H0. Go to the appropriate Station A/ D Count’s display. The Value should not change by more than +/- 1 A/D Count. If so, check the connections and if good, replace the Control Head. b. Increase the engines’ RPM’s in Warm-up Mode. Scroll to Function Code H0 and display the Tach Sender’s input frequency. If the frequency is varying, check the pushpull cable for movement. If the push-pull cable is not moving, swap the Port and Starboard Tach Senders. If the frequency still varies on the same side, the engine needs servicing. c. Same procedure as b. However, if the frequency variations move to the opposite side, replace that Tach Sender. B11-2.3Servo Clutch Troubleshooting System 1. Will not synchronize. Table B11-20: Servo Clutch Problem Causes and Solutions Causes a. The Processor(s) think Astern is being commanded. Page B11-3 Solutions a. Place both the Port and Starboard Processors into Warm-up Mode by pressing the transfer button while moving the Control Head levers to the Ahead detent. Both red LED’s on the Control Head should be blinking. If not, reverse the wires at pins 5 and 7 at the Control Head. Change the Clutch direction with Function Code C5. TROUBLESHOOTING B11-3ELECTRONIC EQUAL THROTTLE SYNCHRONIZATION Table B11-21: Electronic Throttle - Equal Throttle Synch Problem Causes and Solutions System Causes Solutions 1. The green LED is lit a. Function Code E7 is set to 00 and the a. Scroll to Function Codes E2 and E3 on solid, though the Engine Throttle Minimum and Throttle Maxiboth Processors and compare the Values. RPM’s differ by a signifimum VAlues differ between the Port and The Values of E2 and E3 must be the same cant amount. Starboard Processors. for both Processors. Adjust as necessary. b. The engines run at different RPM’s with b. Active Synchronization MUST be the same throttle command signals. Enabled. 2. One or both of the a. A Station-in-Command Control Head’s a. Scroll to the Diagnostic Menu Function engines continually Command Signal is varying. Code H0. Go to the appropriate Station changes RPM (hunts). A/D Count’s display. Refer to Section 56.5.1.1, page 5-40. The Value should not Will not synchronize properly change by more than +/- 1 A/D Count. If so, check the connections and if good, replace the Control Head. b. Scroll to Function Code H0 on both ProB. One or both of the Tach Signals isn’t being read intermittently. Function Code cessors and display the frequency of the E7 is set to a Value of 01 or 03. Tach Signal (refer to Section 5-6.5.1.1, page 5-40). If variations of the signal are measured, the cause must be determined 3. Synchronization does a. The Processors think Astern is being a. Place both the Port and Starboard Procesnot function. The Concommended when the Control Head sor into Warm-up Mode by pressing the trol Head’s green LED lever is positioned to the Ahead Detent. Transfer Button while moving the Control does not light. Head levers to the Ahead detent. Both Control Head’s red LEDs should be blinking. If not, the 7-conductor’s connections at pins 5 and 7 are reversed. b. The Serial Communication Harness is not b. Ensure the Serial Harness’ plugs are fully properly installed. inserted into the Port and Starboard Processor’s Pigtails. c. The Processors are not programmed for c. Scroll to Function Code A1 on both Protwin screw. cessors and verify that the Value of both is set to 02. d. Both Processors are set to the same ID d. Scroll to Function Code A0 and verify that number. the Port and Starboard Processors have different ID numbers. e. Function Code E7 Value is set to 02. e. Depending on the installation, change the Value of E7 to 00, 01, or 03. f. Function Code E7 is set to 03 and no f. Determine why there is no Tach Signal Tach Signal is present. present. Page B11-4 TROUBLESHOOTING B12 TROUBLESHOOTING CABLE HARNESSES The following Sections list the various Harnesses manufactured for use with the Processor. These tables are invaluable when troubleshooting a suspected interface problem or when manufacturing your own Harnesses. ASIC CONTROL SYSTEM HARNESSES B12-1B Table B12-1: Power, Start Interlock Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Conductor Color Pin 1 Yellow w/ Red Trace Pin 10 Pin 11 Pin 12 Red Black Yellow w/ Red Trace ENGINE and BATTERY Termination B Starter Solenoid Description Closed contact when In-command and at Neutral. Battery (+) +12 or 24VDC. Battery (-) - DC Return Starter Switch Closed contact when Wire at the In-command and at Starter Sole- Neutral. noid Figure B12-1: Power, Start Interlock Harness Pin Out Table B12-2: Power, Start Interlock, and Pressure Switch Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR ENGINE and BATTERY Termination A Pin 1 Pin 6 Pin 7 Pin 10 Pin 11 Pin 12 Conductor Color Termination B Description Yellow w/ Red Starter Solenoid Closed contact Trace when In-command and at Neutral. Light Blue Clutch Pressure Normally Open Switch contact that closes when transmission manufacturer’s minimum safe operating pressure is Figure B12-2: Power, Start Interlock, reached. Pressure Switch Harness Pin Out Light Blue Clutch Pressure Normally Open contact that closes when transmission manufacSwitch turer’s minimum safe operating pressure is reached. Red Battery (+) +12 or 24VDC. Black Battery (-) - DC Return Closed contact when In-command and at Neutral. Yellow w/ Red Starter Switch Trace Wire at the Starter Solenoid PageB12-1 TROUBLESHOOTING Table B12-3: Power, Start Interlock, Pressure Switch, and Alarm Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR ENGINE and BATTERY Termination A Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 6 Conductor Color Termination B Yellow w/ Red Starter SoleTrace noid Red External Alarm Circuit Black External Alarm Circuit Light Blue Clutch Pressure Switch Pin 7 Light Blue Pin 10 Pin 11 Pin 12 Red Black Yellow w/ Red Trace Description Closed contact when In-command and at Neutral. Normally Open contact opens with fault or loss of power. Normally Open contact opens with fault or loss of power. Normally Open contact that closes when transmission Figure B12-3: Power, Start Interlock, manufacturer’s minimum Pressure Switch, Alarm Harness Pin safe operating pressure is Out reached. Clutch Pres- Normally Open contact that closes when transmission manufacturer’s sure Switch minimum safe operating pressure is reached. Battery (+) +12 or 24VDC. Battery (-) - DC Return Closed contact when In-command and at Neutral. Starter Switch Wire at the Starter Solenoid Table B12-4: Serial Communication Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 6 Conductor Color Black Red Yellow/ Green Termination B Description Pin 1 CAN Low Pin 2 CAN High N/C Shield Figure B12-4: Serial Communication Harness Pin Out Table B12-5: Control Head Harness Pin-Out and Hard-Wire PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Pin 7 Pin 8 Conductor Color Green/ Yellow Brown Violet Orange Red Green Blue Black Termination B Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Pin 7 Pin 8 PIGTAIL (14261-X) Description Shield Red LED (+) Green LED (-) Transfer Button (+) Ground Lever Command Signal VREF (+5VDC) Tone (+) PageB12-2 Figure B12-5: Control Head Harness Plug Pin Out TROUBLESHOOTING Table B12-5: Control Head Harness Pin-Out and Hard-Wire TERMINAL STRIP PROCESSOR (13557-X) Termination A Conductor Color Termination B Pin 1 Green/ Yellow N/C Pin 2 Brown Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Pin 7 Violet Orange Red Green Blue Pin 8 Pin 4 Pin 3 Pin 6 Pin 5- Port Pin 7- Starboard Black Pin 1 STARBOARD- J UMPER PINS 3 TO 5 PORT - JUMPER PINS 3 TO 7 Pin 8 NOTE: Description Shield Red LED (+) Green LED (-) Transfer Button (+) Ground Lever Command Signal VREF (+5VDC) Figure B12-6: Control Head Port Terminal Strip Connections Tone (+) Figure B12-7: Control Head Starboard Terminal Strip Connections Table B12-6: Tachometer Sensor Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR TACHOMETER SENSOR Termination A Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Conductor Color Red Black Green/Yellow B12-2C LUTCH Termination B Pin B Pin C N/C Description Tachometer (+) Tachometer (-) Shield Figure B12-8: Tachometer Sensor Harness Pin Out ARNESSES H B12-2.1Ahead and Astern Table B12-7: Ahead and Astern Clutch Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 3 Conductor Color GEAR BOX Termination B Red Ahead Solenoid Pin 4 Black Ahead Solenoid Pin 5 Red Astern Solenoid Pin 6 Black Astern Solenoid Description + 24 VDC when Ahead Clutch Selected - VDC Return for Ahead Clutch + 24 VDC when Astern Clutch Selected - VDC Return for Astern Clutch PageB12-3 Figure B12-9: Clutch Ahead, and Astern Harness Pin Out TROUBLESHOOTING B12-2.2Ahead, Neutral, and Astern Table B12-8: Ahead, Neutral, and Astern Clutch Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Conductor Color Pin 3 Red Pin 4 Black Pin 5 Red Pin 6 Black Pin 7 Red Pin 8 Black B12-3C GEAR BOX Termination B Description Ahead Solenoid Ahead Clutch Solenoid Astern Clutch Solenoid +24 VDC when Ahead Clutch Selected -VDC Return for Ahead Clutch +24 VDC when Astern Clutch Selected Figure B12-10: Clutch, Ahead, Astern, and Neutral Harness Pin Out Astern Solenoid Neutral Solenoid Neutral Solenoid -VDC Return for Astern Clutch +24 VDC at all times -VDC Return for Neutral Solenoid LUTCH/TROLL HARNESSES B12-3.1Ahead, Astern, Troll On/Off & Troll Command Table B12-9: Ahead, Astern, Troll On/Off and Troll Command Clutch/Troll Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Conductor Color Pin 3 Red Pin 4 Black Pin 5 Red Pin 6 Black Pin 9 Red Pin 10 Black Pin 11 Red Pin 12 Black GEAR BOX Termination B Ahead Clutch Solenoid Ahead Clutch Solenoid Astern Clutch Solenoid Astern Clutch Solenoid Troll On/Off Solenoid Troll On/Off Solenoid Troll Command Solenoid Troll Command Solenoid Description +24 VDC when Ahead Clutch Selected -VDC Return for Ahead Clutch +24 VDC when Astern Clutch Selected Figure B12-11: -VDC Return for Astern Clutch Clutch/Troll Harness Pin Out +24 VDC when Troll is selected. -VDC Return for Troll On/Off Solenoid 0- 100% Duty Cycle @ 500Hz. for Controlling Proportional Solenoid Valve -VDC Return for Troll Command Solenoid HROTTLE HARNESSES B12-4T B12-4.1PWM Table B12-10: PWM Throttle Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 8 Conductor Color Black ENGINE Termination B Description Engine DC- Throttle Signal Return Bus Red ECM PWM Throttle Signal- 0100% Duty Cycle @ 500Hz. Green/ Yel- N/C N/A low PageB12-4 Figure B12-12: PWM Throttle Harness Pin Out TROUBLESHOOTING B12-4.2Voltage Table B12-11: Voltage Throttle Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 8 Conductor Color Black ENGINE Termination B Description Engine DC- Throttle Signal Return Bus Red ECM 0.00- 5.00 VDC Throttle Signal Green/ Yel- N/C N/A low Figure B12-13: Voltage Throttle Harness Pin Out B12-4.3Current, MAN Table B12-12: Current, MAN, Throttle Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 3 Pin 8 Conductor Color Black ENGINE Termination B Description Engine DC- Throttle Signal Return Bus Red ECM 0.00- 21.0 mA. Throttle Signal Green/ Yel- N/C N/A low Figure B12-14: Current Throttle Harness Pin Out B12-4.4Frequency Table B12-13: Frequency Throttle Harness Pin-Out PROCESSOR Termination A Pin 1 Pin 7 Pin 8 Conductor Color Black ENGINE Termination B Description Engine DC- Throttle Signal Return Bus Red ECM 120.64- 463.50 Hz. Throttle Signal Green/ Yel- N/C N/A low Figure B12-15: Frequency Throttle Harness Pin Out PageB12-5 TROUBLESHOOTING B13 PROCESSOR PIGTAILS The number and types of Pigtails used varies with the different Processors and their configurations. The basic off-the-shelf Processors are available with no Pigtails (hard-wired) or pre-wired for for up to a total of eight Pigtails when all five Remote Stations are being used. The following Tables describe the pin outs and functions of the conductors within the various Pigtails. ASIC PROCESSOR PIGTAILS B13-1B Table B13-1: Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Oil Pressure Switch, and Alarm Pigtail Pin-Out CIRCUIT BOARD PLUG Termination B Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Pin 7 Pin 10 Pin 11 Pin 12 1 - Yellow 12 - Red Description 2 - Brown 11 - Black 2-Conductor 3 - Black Cable 10 - Red 4 Orange Start Interlock 5 - White 7- Green Alarm (N.O.) 6 - Blue Alarm (Common) Figure B13-1: Power, Start Interlock, Back-up Ctrl (Ground) Clutch Oil Pressure, and Alarm Pigtail Back-up Ctrl Input Pin Out Clutch Pressure Switch Clutch Pressure Switch (Ground) DC Power (+) DC Power (-) Start Interlock 6 5 4 3 2 1 Conductor Color Yellow Brown Black Orange White Blue Green Red Black Red 12 11 10 9 8 7 Termination A PB2-2 TB6-6 TB6-5 TB6-2 TB6-1 TB6-3 TB6-4 PB1 (+) PB1 (-) PB2-1 Conductor Color White Green Red Black Black Termination B Pin 2 Pin 1 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 6 Description CAN High CAN Low CAN High CAN Low Shield 2- White 1- Green 4 5 6 Termination A TB7-6 TB7-7 TB7-8 TB7-9 TB7-10 1 2 3 Table B13-2: Serial Communication Pigtail Pin-Out CIRCUIT BOARD PLUG 4 - Red 5 - Black 6 - Black Figure B13-2: Serial Communication Pigtail Pin Out Termination B Description Pin 1 Shield Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Pin 7 Pin 6 Pin 8 8 - Black 7 - Blue 6 - Green 5 - Red 1 2 3 4 Termination A Conductor Color Frame Non-insulated to Green/ Yellow TB1 thru 5-2 Brown TB1 thru 5-8 Violet TB1 thru 5-4 Orange TB1 thru 5-3 Red TB1 thru 5-7 Blue TB1 thru 5-6 Green TB1 thru 5-1 Black 5 6 7 8 Table B13-3: Control Head Pigtail Pin-Out (Up to 5 Stations) CIRCUIT BOARD PLUG 1 - Green/Yellow 2 - Brown 3 - Violet 4 - Orange Red LED (+) Green LED (-) Transfer Button Figure B13-3: Control Head Pigtail Pin Out Ground VREF (+5VDC) Lever Command Signal Tone (+) Page B13-1 TROUBLESHOOTING LUTCH PIGTAIL TB11-1 TB11-2 TB11-5 TB11-6 Termination B Black Brown Yellow Green Pin 5 Pin 3 Pin 6 Pin 4 PLUG Description Astern Clutch (+) Ahead Clutch (+) Astern clutch ( - ) Ahead Clutch ( - ) 3 - Brown 4 - Green 5 - Black 6 - Yellow Figure B13-4: B13-3C 12 1110 9 8 7 CIRCUIT BOARD Termination A Conductor Color Table B13-4: Clutch Pigtail Pin-Out 6 5 4 3 2 1 B13-2C Clutch Pigtail Pin Out LUTCH/TROLL PIGTAIL Table B13-5: Clutch/Troll Pigtail Pin-Out PLUG Black Brown Red TB11-4 TB11-5 Orange Yellow Termination B Description Pin 5 Astern Clutch (+) Pin 3 Ahead Clutch (+) Pin 11 Troll Proportional Solenoid (+) Pin 9 Troll On/Off (+) Pin 6 Astern clutch ( - ) TB11-6 TB11-7 TB11-8 Green Blue White Pin 4 Pin 12 Pin 10 3 - Brown 4 - Green 5 - Black 6 - Yellow Figure B13-5: 6 5 4 3 2 1 TB11-1 TB11-2 TB11-3 12 1110 9 8 7 CIRCUIT BOARD Termination A Conductor Color 12 - Blue 11 - Red 10 - White 9- Orange Clutch/Troll Pigtail Pin Out Ahead Clutch ( - ) Troll Proportional Solenoid ( - ) Troll On/Off HROTTLE PIGTAIL B13-4T Table B13-6: Throttle Pigtail Pin-Out CIRCUIT BOARD Termination A TB8-3 TB8-4 TB8-5 TB8-6 TB8-7 P-Clamp to Frame Conductor Color Brown Red Orange White Black Green/Yellow Termination B Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 7 Pin 1 Pin 8 PLUG Description PWM (+) Current (+) VDC (+) Frequency (+) Signal Ground Shield Figure B13-6: Throttle Pigtail Pin Out Table B13-7: Tachometer Sensor Pigtail Pin-Out CIRCUIT BOARD PLUG Termination A Conductor Color Termination B Black Drain 2 TB9- 4 Grounding Screw Description Pin 1 Sensor Supply (+9VDC) 2 - Green 3 - Black Pin 2 AC Type Tach Input 1 - Red 4 - Shield/ Open Collector Tach Input (the green Drain wire is moved from TB9-2 to TB9-3 when an Open Collector Tach is used) Pin 3 Return for Tach Input Figure B13-7: Tachometer Sensor No.1 Pigtail Pin Out Pin 4 Shield 1 Red Green N/C Page B13-2 3 4 TB9- 1 TB9- 2 TB9- 3 ENG-143 Ver 1.0 4 -04 ClearCommand 9 000 Elect-Thr Sol-Shift Qualitative Failure Ana lysis & Design Verification Tes t Procedure ClearCommand 9000 Series Electronic Throttle – Solenoid Clutch Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure Document # ENG-143 Version: 1.0 AUTHOR CHECKED Tim Jones Jim D Smith APPROVED Robert Anderson ZF Mathers , LLC. 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo WA 98275 U.S.A. Tel: 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 DATE 4/19/04 Qualitative Failure Analysis The following qualitative failure analysis is provided to show compliance with: x Subchapter K Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 121.620 x Subchapter L Offshore Supply Vessels, 46 CFR 130.120 x Subchapter T Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 184.620: 121.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (b) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (c) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a) of this section, a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilot house control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (d) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. (e) All microprocessor or computer based systems must meet the requirements of part 62 in subchapter F of this chapter. 130.120 Propulsion control. (a) Each vessel must have-(1) A propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse; and (2) A means at each propulsion engine of readily disabling the propulsion-control system to permit local operation. (a) Each propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse must enable-(1) Control of the speed of each propulsion engine; (2) Control of the direction of propeller-shaft rotation; (3) Control of propeller pitch, if a controllable-pitch propeller is fitted; and (4) Shutdown of each propulsion engine. (a) The propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse may constitute the remote stopping-system required by Sec. 129.540 of this subchapter. (b) Each propulsion-control system, including one operable from the pilothouse, must be designed so that no one complete or partial failure of an easily replaceAppendix B-3 able component of the system allows the propulsion engine to overspeed or the pitch of the propeller to increase. 184.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (2) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (a) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a), a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilothouse control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (b) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. The ZF Mathers ClearCommand 9000 Series (electronic throttle, solenoid clutch version) marine engine controls offer single lever control of speed and direction. Each enclosure houses an independent Control Processor and requires separate power supplies. The system operates on 12 or 24VDC power and can have up to five remote stations depending on the application. The system sequences the operation of speed and shift in order to prevent an inexperienced operator from mishandling the engine or transmission. A standard feature is an alarm contact (normally open) to interface with the main alarm system of the vessel. This switch will open and activate the alarm system with a power loss or CPU failure. In addition, ZF Mathers provides audible tones at the Control Head locations to indicate system faults. ITEM NUMBER FAILED COMPONENT ALARM STATUS INITIAL RESULT FINAL OUTCOME 1 ZF MATHERS CONTROL HEAD AUDIBLE TONE WILL SOUND AT CONTROL HEAD THROTTLE RESETS TO IDLE NO INCREASE IN ENGINE RPM CLUTCH SHIFTS TO NEUTRAL THROTTLE RESETS TO IDLE NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED NO INCREASE IN ENGINE RPM CLUTCH SHIFTS TO NEUTRAL NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED 2 LOSS OF POWER SUPPLY ALARM CIRCUIT WILL OPEN Design Verification Test Procedure The ClearCommand 9000 Series (electronic throttle, solenoid clutch version) Propulsion Control System is compliant to the environmental design standards in 46 CFR 62.25-30. The following test procedure covers the 2 items included in the Qualitative Failure Analysis; 1) Control Head Potentiometer failure, and 2) Loss of power supply. Appendix B-4 1) Failure: Control Head Potentiometer failure. a) Results: The Processor will shift to Neutral (if needed) and throttle will go to Idle, (if needed). b) Test Procedure i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Locate the green wire coming from the Port Control Head in command, connecting to pin 6 of the respective terminal block on the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. Disconnect it from the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. (1) The Port Processor will shift to Neutral and throttle will go to Idle. (2) The Port Control Head will give an alarm tone indicating a faulty potentiometer. iv) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers back to Neutral. Reconnect the green wire. v) Repeat for Starboard side. 2) Failure: Power failure to ClearCommand 9000 Series (A power failure to the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board will have the same results as a failed microprocessor) a) Results i) Throttle signal to Idle and shift to Neutral. ii) LED at Control Heads will not be lit. iii) Opposite engine still under power has full control. b) Test Procedure. i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Turn power off to the Port side only. (1) Port side will go to Neutral Idle. (2) LED on the Port side of the Control Head in command will go off. (3) The Port Control Head will no longer have command of the engine and gear. (4) The Starboard Control Head will still have full command of the Starboard engine and gear. iv) Turn power on to the Port Processor. Take command of the Port side. (1) The Port Control Head will operate as usual-(Non-volatile memory) v) Repeat test for Starboard Processor. Appendix B-5 Appendix B-6 ENG-144 Ver 1.0 4 -04 ClearCommand 9 000 Elect-Thr Ser-Cl Qualitative Failure Analysis & Des ign Verification Tes t Procedure ClearCommand 9000 Series Electronic Throttle – Servo Clutch Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure Document # ENG-144 Version: 1.0 AUTHOR CHECKED Tim Jones Jim D Smith APPROVED Robert Anderson ZF Mathers , LLC. 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo WA 98275 U.S.A. Tel: 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 DATE 4-19-04 Qualitative Failure Analysis The following qualitative failure analysis is provided to show compliance with: x Subchapter K Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 121.620 x Subchapter L Offshore Supply Vessels, 46 CFR 130.120 x Subchapter T Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 184.620: 121.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (b) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (c) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a) of this section, a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilot house control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (d) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. (e) All microprocessor or computer based systems must meet the requirements of part 62 in subchapter F of this chapter. 130.120 Propulsion control. (a) Each vessel must have-(1) A propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse; and (2) A means at each propulsion engine of readily disabling the propulsion-control system to permit local operation. (a) Each propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse must enable-(1) Control of the speed of each propulsion engine; (2) Control of the direction of propeller-shaft rotation; (3) Control of propeller pitch, if a controllable-pitch propeller is fitted; and (4) Shutdown of each propulsion engine. (a) The propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse may constitute the remote stopping-system required by Sec. 129.540 of this subchapter. (b) Each propulsion-control system, including one operable from the pilothouse, must be designed so that no one complete or partial failure of an easily replaceAppendix B-7 able component of the system allows the propulsion engine to overspeed or the pitch of the propeller to increase. 184.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (2) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (a) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a), a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilothouse control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (b) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. The ZF Mathers ClearCommand 9000 Series (electronic throttle, servo clutch version) marine engine controls offer single lever control of speed and direction. Each enclosure houses an independent Control Processor and requires separate power supplies. The system operates on 12 or 24VDC power and can have up to five remote stations depending on the application. The system sequences the operation of speed and shift in order to prevent an inexperienced operator from mishandling the engine or transmission. A standard feature is an alarm contact (normally open) to interface with the main alarm system of the vessel. This switch will open and activate the alarm system with a power loss or CPU failure. In addition, ZF Mathers provides audible tones at the Control Head locations to indicate system faults. ITEM NUMBER FAILED COMPONENT ALARM STATUS INITIAL RESULT FINAL OUTCOME 1 ZF MATHERS CONTROL HEAD AUDIBLE TONE WILL SOUND AT CONTROL HEAD THROTTLE RESETS TO IDLE NO INCREASE IN ENGINE RPM CLUTCH SHIFTS TO NEUTRAL THROTTLE RESETS TO IDLE NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED NO INCREASE IN ENGINE RPM CLUTCH REMAINS AT LAST COMMANDED POSITION NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED 2 LOSS OF POWER SUPPLY ALARM CIRCUIT WILL OPEN Design Verification Test Procedure The ClearCommand 9000 Series (electronic throttle, servo clutch version) Propulsion Control System is compliant to the environmental design standards in 46 CFR 62.25-30. Appendix B-8 The following test procedure covers the 2 items included in the Qualitative Failure Analysis; 1) Control Head Potentiometer failure, and 2) Loss of power supply. 1) Failure: Control Head Potentiometer failure. a) Results: The Processor will shift to Neutral (if needed) and throttle will go to Idle, (if needed). b) Test Procedure i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Locate the green wire coming from the Port Control Head in command, connecting to pin 6 of the respective terminal block on the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. Disconnect it from the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. (1) The Port Processor will shift to Neutral and throttle will go to Idle. (2) The Port Control Head will give an alarm tone indicating a faulty potentiometer. iv) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers back to Neutral. Reconnect the green wire. v) Repeat for Starboard side. 2) Failure: Power failure to ClearCommand 9000 Series (A power failure to the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board will have the same results as a failed microprocessor) a) Results i) Throttle signal to Idle and clutch servo will remain at last commanded position. ii) LED at Control Heads will not be lit. iii) Opposite engine still under power has full control. b) Test Procedure. i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Turn power off to the Port side only. (1) Port side will go to Idle and clutch servo will remain at last commanded position. (2) LED on the Port side of the Control Head in command will go off. (3) The Port Control Head will no longer have command of the engine and gear. (4) The Starboard Control Head will still have full command of the Starboard engine and gear. iv) Turn power on to the Port Processor. Take command of the Port side. (1) The Port Control Head will operate as usual-(Non-volatile memory) v) Repeat test for Starboard Processor. Appendix B-9 Appendix B-10 ENG-145 Ver 1.0 4 -04 ClearCommand 9 000 Ser-Thr Sol-Cl Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Tes t P rocedure ClearCommand 9000 Series Servo Throttle – Solenoid Clutch Qualitative Failure Analysis & Design Verification Test Procedure Document # ENG-145 Version: 1.0 AUTHOR CHECKED Tim Jones Jim D Smith APPROVED Robert Anderson ZF Mathers , LLC. 12125 Harbour Reach Drive, Suite B Mukilteo WA 98275 U.S.A. Tel: 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 DATE 4-19-04 Qualitative Failure Analysis The following qualitative failure analysis is provided to show compliance with: x Subchapter K Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 121.620 x Subchapter L Offshore Supply Vessels, 46 CFR 130.120 x Subchapter T Small Passenger Vessels, 46 CFR 184.620: 121.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (b) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (c) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a) of this section, a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilot house control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (d) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. (e) All microprocessor or computer based systems must meet the requirements of part 62 in subchapter F of this chapter. 130.120 Propulsion control. (a) Each vessel must have-(1) A propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse; and (2) A means at each propulsion engine of readily disabling the propulsion-control system to permit local operation. (a) Each propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse must enable-(1) Control of the speed of each propulsion engine; (2) Control of the direction of propeller-shaft rotation; (3) Control of propeller pitch, if a controllable-pitch propeller is fitted; and (4) Shutdown of each propulsion engine. (a) The propulsion-control system operable from the pilothouse may constitute the remote stopping-system required by Sec. 129.540 of this subchapter. (b) Each propulsion-control system, including one operable from the pilothouse, must be designed so that no one complete or partial failure of an easily replaceAppendix B-11 able component of the system allows the propulsion engine to overspeed or the pitch of the propeller to increase. 184.620 Propulsion engine control systems. (a) A vessel must have two independent means of controlling each propulsion engine. Control must be provided for the engine speed, direction of shaft rotation, and engine shutdown. (1) One of the means may be the ability to readily disconnect the remote engine control linkage to permit local operation. (2) A multiple engine vessel with independent remote propulsion control for each engine need not have a second means of controlling each engine. (a) In addition to the requirements of paragraph (a), a vessel must have a reliable means for shutting down a propulsion engine, at the main pilothouse control station, which is independent of the engine's speed control. (b) A propulsion engine control system, including pilothouse control, must be designed so that a loss of power to the control system does not result in an increase in shaft speed or propeller pitch. The ZF Mathers ClearCommand 9000 Series (servo throttle, solenoid clutch version) marine engine controls offer single lever control of speed and direction. Each enclosure houses an independent Control Processor and requires separate power supplies. The system operates on 12 or 24VDC power and can have up to five remote stations depending on the application. The system sequences the operation of speed and shift in order to prevent an inexperienced operator from mishandling the engine or transmission. A standard feature is an alarm contact (normally open) to interface with the main alarm system of the vessel. This switch will open and activate the alarm system with a power loss or CPU failure. In addition, ZF Mathers provides audible tones at the Control Head locations to indicate system faults. ITEM NUMBER FAILED COMPONENT ALARM STATUS INITIAL RESULT FINAL OUTCOME 1 ZF MATHERS CONTROL HEAD AUDIBLE TONE WILL SOUND AT CONTROL HEAD THROTTLE RESETS TO IDLE NO INCREASE IN ENGINE RPM CLUTCH SHIFTS TO NEUTRAL THROTTLE REMAINS AT LAST COMMANDED POSITION NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED 2 LOSS OF POWER SUPPLY ALARM CIRCUIT WILL OPEN NO INCREASE IN SHAFT SPEED CLUTCH SHIFTS TO NEUTRAL Design Verification Test Procedure The ClearCommand 9000 Series (servo throttle, solenoid clutch version) Propulsion Control System is compliant to the environmental design standards in 46 CFR 62.25-30. Appendix B-12 The following test procedure covers the 2 items included in the Qualitative Failure Analysis; 1) Control Head Potentiometer failure, and 2) Loss of power supply. 1) Failure: Control Head Potentiometer failure. a) Results: The Processor will shift to Neutral (if needed) and throttle will go to Idle, (if needed). b) Test Procedure i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Locate the green wire coming from the Port Control Head in command, connecting to pin 6 of the respective terminal block on the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. Disconnect it from the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board. (1) The Port Processor will shift to Neutral and throttle will go to Idle. (2) The Port Control Head will give an alarm tone indicating a faulty potentiometer. iv) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers back to Neutral. Reconnect the green wire. v) Repeat for Starboard side. 2) Failure: Power failure to ClearCommand 9000 Series (A power failure to the ClearCommand 9000 Series circuit board will have the same results as a failed microprocessor) a) Results i) Throttle signal will remain at last commanded position to and clutch shifts to neutral. ii) LED at Control Heads will not be lit. iii) Opposite engine still under power has full control. b) Test Procedure. i) Turn power on to both Port and Starboard Processors. Take command at a Control Head. ii) Move the Port and Starboard Control Head levers to approximately ½ Ahead. iii) Turn power off to the Port side only. (1) Port side throttle will remain at last commanded position and clutch will shift to neutral. (2) LED on the Port side of the Control Head in command will go off. (3) The Port Control Head will no longer have command of the engine and gear. (4) The Starboard Control Head will still have full command of the Starboard engine and gear. iv) Turn power on to the Port Processor. Take command of the Port side. (1) The Port Control Head will operate as usual-(Non-volatile memory) v) Repeat test for Starboard Processor. Appendix B-13 Appendix B-14 MMC-1 72 Rev.Z-O 11/0 3 Factory Authorized Sales & Service Centers - International ZF Mathers, LLC 12125 Harbour Reach Drive Mukilteo, WA 98275 USA 800-546-5455 / 425-583-1900 Fax: 425-493-1569 MMC-172, Rev. Z-O 11-03 Factory Authorized Sales & Service Centers - International BRAZIL FRANCE Antonio Tucunduva T: 5515 235 2301 7000 ZF do Brazil S.A. Avenida Conda Zepplin, 1935 Sorocaba-sp, CEP 18103-000 BRAZIL F: 5515 235 2233 David Elderkin T: 33 494 08 68 20 3590 Vidal Diffusion Marine Z.I. Toulon -Est Toulon Cedex 9, FRANCE F: 33 494 08 26 59 [email protected] CHINA 6953 ZF Representative Office, Shanghai Room 6E, Yi-Dian Building No. 746 Zhaojiabang Road Xuhui District, Shanghai 200030 GERMANY Tang Zhou Qing T: 0086-21-6445 9745 F: 0086-21-6445 9748 M: 13901655780 Jan Hogenkamp T: +31 (0) 183 650000 7252 ADS Van Stigt Avelingen - West 30 NL-4202 MS Gorinchem, NETHERLANDS F: +31 (0) 183 650001 [email protected] [email protected] DENMARK GREECE Steen Rasmussen T: +45 (0) 43 436243 7257 ZF Danmark ApS Hesselager 21 - PO Box 97 Broenby, DK-2605 DENMARK F: +45 (0) 43 432643 Demetris Kyriazis T: 0030210 25 88 985 2386 Amaltheia 13 Papaflessa Str. 143 43 N. Halkidona Athens, F: 0030210 25 88 986 [email protected] www.zf-marine.com FINLAND ICELAND Vesa Saarinen, Mr. Ari Bragge T: 358-2-444 11 2737 AB Marinel Oy Konsantie 21260 Raisio, FINLAND F: 358-2-4372701 6525 Merkur Skutuvogur 12a 104 Reykjavik,, ICELAND Hrafn Sigurdasson, Johann Olafur Arsaelsson T: 354-568-1044 F: 354-568-9958 M: 354-863-0312 [email protected] www.seacompanion.com/fi/ab-marinel/index.htm [email protected] [email protected] FRANCE 2190 Seimi Z.I.P. Du Moulin Blanc Rue Alain Colas 29200 Brest, IRELAND Phillip Gerard T: 33 2 98 46 11 02 F: 33 2 98 43 37 49 7326 ZF Great Britain Abbeyfield Road Lenton, Nottingham NG7 2SX ENGLAND [email protected] www.seimi.com PageB-15 Adi Licence T: +44 1159 869211 F: +44 1159 869261 [email protected] ITALY NORWAY Alex Busetto T: +39 02 488 831 7093 SAIM S.p.A. Via Donizetti, 11 I-20090 Assago (MI), ITALY F: +39 02 4884 3260 jorgen Ahrberg, Bjorn Gulbrandsen T: +47 22884680 7029 KGK Norge AS Casper Storms Vei 19 Oslo, 0664 NORWAY F: +47 22720902 [email protected] www.zf-marine.com [email protected] www.zf-group.no JAPAN 7253 ZF Marine Japan Co. Ltd. Fujikoshi Bldg. 1-10-11 Iriya Taito-ku Tokyo, 110-0013 JAPAN RUSSIA T: +81 (0) 3 5808 4521 F: +81 (0) 3 5808 4531 7313 ZF Transmissia 37/1 Yushnoe Chassee St. Petersburg, 192241 RUSSIA T: 7 (812) 314-5448 F: 7 (812) 314-6815 www.zf-marine.com KOREA SCOTLAND M.G. Song T: 51-415-0591 T: 51-415-0592 F: 51-412-6361 1415 SE Jung Engineering #15, 2-G Namhang-Dong Yeongdo-Gu Pusan, 7326 ZF Great Britain Abbeyfield Road Lenton, Nottingham NG7 2SX ENGLAND [email protected] Adi Licence T: +44 1159 869211 F: +44 1159 869261 [email protected] SINGAPORE ZF Korea Co. Ltd. 422-2 Chonchon-dong Bupyong-Gu Incheon, Seoul 403-032 T: +82 (0) 32 505 1530 F: +82 (0) 32 505 1514 [email protected] www.zf-marine.com 157 Mammoth Enterprises Pte. Ltd. 6-A Waringin Park 416320, SINGAPORE Steven Wee T: 65 6 44-88266 F: 65 6 44-89800 [email protected] NETHERLANDS (Holland) Jan Hogenkamp T: +31 (0) 183 650000 7252 ADS Van Stigt Avelingen - West 30 NL-4202 MS Gorinchem, NETHERLANDS F: +31 (0) 183 650001 7045 ZF South East Asia Pte. 11 Tuas Drive 1 Singapore, 638678 Rep. of SINGAPORE T: +65 (0) 8 610177 F: +65 (0) 6861 9173 [email protected] NEW ZEALAND 6948 ZF Australia Pty. LTD (mail) Locked Bag 13 Seven Hills, N.S.W., 1730 AUSTRALIA (ship) 23 Foundry Road Seven Hills, N.S.W., 2147 AUSTRALIA [email protected] www.zf-marine.com SOUTH AFRICA T: +61 (0)2 9674 6222 F: +61 (0)2 9674 6445 New OE Sales:[email protected] Service Inquiries:[email protected] www.zf.com.au Page 7261 ZF South Africa (Pty) Ltd (mail) PO Box 2098 Kempton Park, 1620 SOUTH AFRICA (ship) C/O Barlows Power Systems Cnr. Peter Barlow and Kasselss Vlei Rd Bellville, Cape Town, SOUTH AFRICA T: 27 11 453 1818 F: 27 11 453 7506 SPAIN U.A.E. Oliver Baumgarten T: +34 (91) 4852696 5556 ZF Espana, S.A. Avda. Fuentermar, 11 Coslada (Madrid), 28820 SPAIN F: +34 (94) 485 00 36 M. Narasimhan (NARSI) T: 971-6-5691-141 7030 ZF Middle East, LLC PO Box 26093 Sharjah, U.A.E F: 971-6-5692-695 M: 971-50-6351-457 [email protected] www.zf-marine.com [email protected] www.zf-marine.com SWEDEN UNITED KINGDOM (England) Karl-Henry Pragsten T: +46 (0) 8 923 000 7234 KG Knutsson AB Transmissionsdivisionen Hammarbracken 8 S-191 81 Sollentuna, F: +46 (0) 8 929 599 [email protected] USA Rolf Heimgartner T: 41 1997 4090 F: 41 1997 4094 ZF Mathers, LLC 1415 Pacific Drive Burlington, WA 98233 USA [email protected] www.marineparts.ch TAIWAN Mike Ou T: 886 7 333 1191 5355 Asia Diesel Electric Corp. 20th Floor 34 Min Chuan 1st Road Kaohsuing, R.O.C. F: 44 1752 208811 [email protected] www.atlantismarine.co.uk SWITZERLAND 2419 Marine Parts Heimgartner Pffaffikerstr. 6 CH-8604 Volketswil Zurich, Richard Dix T: 44 1752 208810 6932 Atlantis Marine Power Ltd. Western Wood Way Langage Science Park Plympton,, Plymouth PL7 5BG F: 886 7 334 6808 T: 360-757-6265 F: 360-757-2500 www.zf-marine.com 6427 ZFI Marine - US Headquarters 3131 SW 42nd Street Fort Lauderdale, FL 33312 USA Kelly Friedenberg T: 954-581-4040 F: 954-581-4078 www.zf-marine.com THAILAND Reungpoj V T: +66 2 521 6520 2 7283 ZF Thailand Co. Ltd 159/33 Soi Vipavadee 64 Vipavadee-Rangsit Road Laksi, Bangkok 10210 6952 ZFI Marine - Gulf Coast Facility 161 James Drive West Suite 120 St. Rose, LA 70087 Randy Tredinich, Marc Kloor T: 504-443-0501 F: 504-443-0504 F: +66 2 521 6523 www.zf-marine.com [email protected] www.zf-marine.com TURKEY 6998 Niveko Makina Ticaret LTD (ZF) Takkeci Sok No. 3 Arnavutkoy-Istanbul, TR-80820 TURKEY 6597 ZFI Marine - West Coast 1095 Andover Park East Seattle, WA 98188 USA Kevin Zwicker, Keith Kaelberer T: 206-574-0375 F: 206-574-0868 Mr. Lorenz Weinstabl, Levent Ucdal T: 90 212 287 27 80 www.zf-marine.com F: 90 212 287 65 71 [email protected] [email protected] ZFI Marine - Annapolis 301 Pier One Road Suite 102 Stevensville, MD 21666 Stafford Barringer, Jeff Carter T: 410-604-3320 www.zf-marine.com PageB-17 USA Jimmy Wong, Steve Vu T: 847-478-6868 ZFI Marine - Chicago 777 Hickory Hill Drive Vernon Hills, IL 60061 USA F: 847-478-6789 www.zf-marine.com Phil Organ T: 252-504-3700 ZFI Marine - North Carolina 1350 Sensation Weigh Beaufort, NC 28516 USA F: 252-504-3773 www.zf-marine.com John Shea, Gil Bashaw T: 401-541-9014 ZFI Marine - Rhode Island 1 Mastead Drive Warwick, RI 02886 USA F: 401-541-7223 M: JS: 401-261-1964 www.zf-marine.com Page Service Field Test Unit Reference Manual MM13927 Rev.D 10/03 MM13927 Table of Contents MM13927 Table of Contents ..............................................................................................................TOC-1 Revision List .......................................................................................................................................TOC-2 1 INTRODUCTION - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1-1 Figure 1-1: Service Field Test Unit (Break-out Box) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 Figure 1-2: CruiseCommand Connector Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Figure 1-3: Example of ClearCommand Pigtail Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Table 1-1: 2 Connector/Pigtail Descriptions .............................................................................................1-2 PROCEDURE 2-1 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 2-1 Throttle Signal Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1.1 2-1 DC Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 Figure 2-4: Throttle Connection (DC Voltage) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1 2-1.2 Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 2-1.3 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with DC Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 2-1.4 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with Duty Cycle Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 2-1.5 Frequency (Hz.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 2-2 CLUTCH TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 2-5: Throttle Connection (Current mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Figure 2-6: Throttle Connection (PWM with DC Voltmeter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Figure 2-7: Throttle Connection (PWM with Duty Cycle Meter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Figure 2-8: Throttle Connection (Frequency Hz) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 2-2.1 2-6 Neutral Solenoid Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Figure 2-9: Clutch Connection (Neutral Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 2-2.2 Ahead Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 2-2.3 Astern Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 2-3 TROLL TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 2-10:Clutch Connection (Ahead Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Figure 2-11:Clutch Connection (Astern Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 2-3.1 2-9 Troll On/Off Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Figure 2-12:Troll Connection (ON/OFF Solenoid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 2-3.2 Troll Command (Proportional Solenoid) Testing with Amp Meter . . . . . . . 2-10 2-4 2-SPEED TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 2-13:Troll Connection (Proportional Solenoid with Amp Meter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 2-4.1 2-11 2nd Gear Disengaged. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 Figure 2-14:2-Speed Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 2-4.2 3 2nd Gear Engaged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11 Parts List Table 3-2: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 3-1 Parts List ...............................................................................................................................3-1 TOC-1 REVISIONS LIST Revision List Rev Date Revision Description A 11/02 Revised Section 1.0 Table 1 B 2/03 Revised manual to current ZF Mathers manual standards. Revised Section 3.0 C 4/03 Deleted Section 2.1.6 D 10/03 Revising to add 9000 Series and 2-Speed information PageTOC-2 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 1 INTRODUCTION Refer to Bulletin 02-008 for Service Field Test Unit (Part No. 13927) recommendations. Refer to Figure 1-1:for an example of the Test Unit and a Multimeter. Figure 1-1: Service Field Test Unit (Break-out Box) The Service Field Test Unit, hereafter referred to as the “Break-out Box”, is recommended for use with all CruiseCommand Processors (Part No. 785CE) and with ClearCommand Processors (Part No. 9XXX Series) that have pluggable (Pigtail) Throttle, Clutch or Troll Connections. The procedures for testing the various outputs of the ClearCommand and CruiseCommand Processors are similar, with the exception of where they connect to the respective Processor. Figure 1-2: indicates the location of the connectors on the CruiseCommand Processor and Figure 1-3: the typical pigtail plugs on a 9000 Series ClearCommand Processor. NOTE: OT ALL CLEARCOMMAND PROCESSORS HAVE ALL OF THE PIGTAILS SHOWN IN FIGURE 3. NLY THE PIGTAILS THAT ARE REQUIRED FOR A SPECIFIC APPLICATION ARE INSTALLED IN A CLEAR COMMAND PROCESSOR. N O MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 1-1 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 5 2 6 11339-Example 1 3 Figure 1-2: CruiseCommand Connector Locations Figure 1-3: Example of ClearCommand Pigtail Locations Table 1-1: Connector/Pigtail Descriptions 1 # Description Black 8 Pin 2 Black 12 Pin 3 Gray 12 Pin 4 Gray 8 Pin 5 Gray 6 Pin 6 Gray 4 Pin Harness Type Throttle Connector/Pigtail Harness Use The throttle signal is output from this connector/pigtail. The signal may be in the form of Pulse Width Modulation (PWM), Voltage, Current, or Frequency Power Connector/Pigtail This connector/pigtail contains the inputs and outputs for Main Processor Power, Start Interlock, Clutch Oil Pressure Interlock, and External Alarm Circuit. Clutch Connector/Pigtail The external connections for Clutch Power, Ahead, Astern, and Neutral Solenoids, Troll On/ Off, and Proportional Solenoids are made at this connector/ pigtail. Control Head Connector All the required connections for the Remote Control Stations are made at these connectors. Serial Communication Con- The Serial Communication connections between nector/Pigtail multiple Processors in applications with more than one Processor at this connector/pigtail Tachometer Sensor Connector/The input signal from a Tachometer or Shaft Speed Pigtail Sensor connects to this connector/pigtail. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 1-2 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 2 PROCEDURE The actual procedures for using the Break-out Box are the same for CruiseCommand and ClearCommand Processors. However, the adjustment within the Processor to obtain the correct output may differ. The appropriate Installation Manual must be referred to when making the adjustments. HROTTLE SIGNAL TESTING 2-1 NOTE: T Depending on which Processor is being tested, it may have the capability of sourcing one or all of the following: DC Voltage, Current, PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) or Frequency. T HE FOLLOWING PROCEDURES AND DRAWINGS PERTAIN TO BOTH THE CRUISECOMMAND AND LEARCOMMAND PROCESSORS. C 2-1.1 DC Voltage A) Ensure that power is removed from the Engine Electronics and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Throttle Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Throttle Harness as shown in Figure 24:. 1 1 Figure 2-4: Throttle Connection (DC Voltage) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure DC Volts and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box black socket labeled “-” and the red lead into the socket labeled “VDC”. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-1 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station. F) The appropriate Idle Voltage for the application should be measured at this time. G) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Throttle position while depressing the Transfer Button (Throttle Only Mode). H) The appropriate Full Throttle Voltage for the application should be measured at this time. 2-1.2 Current (mA) A) Ensure power is removed from both the Engine Electronics and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Throttle Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Throttle Harness as shown in Figure 25:. 1 1 Figure 2-5: Throttle Connection (Current mA) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure current (mA.) and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box black socket labeled “-“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “mA”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station. F) Depress and hold the Push-button Switch labeled “mA.” The appropriate Current (mA.) for the application should be measured. G) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Throttle position while depressing the Transfer Button (Throttle Only Mode). MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-2 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT H) Depress and hold the “mA.” Push-button. The appropriate Full Throttle Current (mA.) for the application should be measured at this time. 2-1.3 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with DC Voltmeter A) Ensure power is removed from both the Engine Electronics and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Throttle Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Throttle Harness as shown in Figure 26:. 1 1 Figure 2-6: Throttle Connection (PWM with DC Voltmeter) D) Set up the Multimeter to DC Volts and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box black socket labeled “-“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “PWM”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Caterpillar ECM (Electronic Control Module) Only. Do Not apply power to the Processor at this time. F) Depending on the type of Caterpillar ECM (PEEC or ADEMS), the measurement should be approximately 5.00 or 12.00 VDC. Record the measurement as shown in Drawing Figure 2-6:. G) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station. H) Record the DC Voltage at this time. The measurement should be 7- 9% of the voltage measured in step f). I) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Throttle position while depressing the Transfer Button (Throttle Only Mode). MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-3 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT J) The measurement should be 91- 93% of the voltage measured in step F) [e.g. Idle = 8% of 12 VDC reference or 0.96 VDC; Full Throttle = 92% of 12 VDC reference or 11.04 VDC. 2-1.4 PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) with Duty Cycle Meter A) Ensure power is removed from both the Engine electronics and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Throttle Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Throttle Harness as shown in Figure 27: 1 1 Figure 2-7: Throttle Connection (PWM with Duty Cycle Meter) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure Duty Cycle and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box black socket labeled “-“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “PWM”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Caterpillar ECM (Electronic Control Module) and to the Processor. F) The measurement should be approximately 8% duty Cycle. G) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Throttle position while depressing the Transfer Button (Throttle Only Mode). H) The measurement will increase from 8% to 91- 93%. 2-1.5 Frequency (Hz.) A) Ensure power is removed from both the Engine Electronics and the Processor. B) Disconnect the Throttle Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. 1 MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-4 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Throttle Harness as shown in Figure 28: 1 Figure 2-8: Throttle Connection (Frequency Hz) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure Frequency and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box black socket labeled “-“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “FREQ”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station. F) The appropriate Idle Frequency for the application should be measured at this time. G) Move the Control Head lever to the Full Throttle position while depressing the Transfer Button (Throttle Only Mode). H) The appropriate Full Throttle Frequency for the application should be measured at this time. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-5 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 2-2 CLUTCH TESTING 2-2.1 Neutral Solenoid Testing A) Ensure power is removed from both the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply. B) Disconnect the Clutch Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Clutch Harness as shown in Figure 2-9:. 3 3 Figure 2-9: Clutch Connection (Neutral Solenoid) D) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station with the Control Head lever in the Neutral/ Idle position. E) The measurement on the Neutral Test Point should be 12 or 24 VDC, depending on the Solenoid’s rating and the LED adjacent to the socket should be illuminated. F) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead Detent position. The voltage should drop to 0 VDC in CruiseCommand systems and remain at 12 or 24 VDC in ClearCommand systems. The adjacent LED should go out in CruiseCommand systems and stay on in ClearCommand systems. 2-2.2 Ahead Solenoid Testing A) Ensure power is removed from both the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply. B) Disconnect the Clutch Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. 3 MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-6 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Clutch Harness as shown in Figure 210:. 3 Figure 2-10: Clutch Connection (Ahead Solenoid) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure DC Volts and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box socket labeled “CLUTCH -“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “AHEAD”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station with the lever in the Neutral/Idle position. F) The measurement should be 0 VDC and the adjacent LED should not be lit. G) Position the Control Head lever into the Ahead detent. The measurement should be 12 or 24 VDC depending on the Ahead Solenoid’s rating. The LED adjacent to the Ahead plug on the Break-out Box should be lit. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/Idle position. 2-2.3 Astern Solenoid Testing A) Ensure power is removed from both the Processor and the Clutch Supply Power. B) Disconnect the Clutch Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Clutch Harness as shown in Figure 211:. 3 3 MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-7 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT Figure 2-11: Clutch Connection (Astern Solenoid) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure DC Volts and plug the black lead into the Break-out Box socket labeled “CLUTCH -“ and the red lead into the socket labeled “ASTERN”. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and take command at any Remote Station with the Control Head lever in the Neutral/ Idle position. F) The measurement should be 0 VDC and the adjacent LED should not be lit. G) Position the Control Head lever into the Astern detent. The measurement should be 12 or 24 VDC depending on the Astern Solenoid’s rating. The LED adjacent to the Astern plug on the Break-out Box should be lit. H) Return the Control Head lever to the Neutral/Idle position. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-8 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 2-3 TROLL TESTING 2-3.1 Troll On/Off Solenoid A) Ensure power is removed from both the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply. B) Disconnect the Clutch Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Clutch Harness as shown in Figure 212:. 3 3 Figure 2-12: Troll Connection (ON/OFF Solenoid) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure DC Volts and connect the black lead to the socket labeled “CLUTCH –“ and the red lead to the socket labeled “TROLL ON/OFF” as shown in Figure 212:. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply and take command at a Remote Station with the Control Head lever in the Neutral/Idle position. F) Depress the Transfer Button again for approximately 2 seconds until the red LED begins blinking at a fast rate (Troll Mode Indication). G) The measurement should be 0 VDC. H) Position the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. The measurement should now be 12 or 24 VDC, depending on the Solenoid’s rating. I) Position the Control Head lever further forward while monitoring the DC Voltmeter. The measurement should go from 12 or 24 VDC to 0 VDC at the same time the red LED on the Control Head becomes lit solid. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-9 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 2-3.2 Troll Command (Proportional Solenoid) Testing with Amp Meter A) Ensure power is removed from both the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply. B) Disconnect the Clutch Harness from the number Processor connector/pigtail. C) Insert the Break-out Box between the number Processor connector/pigtail and the Clutch Harness as shown in Figure 213:. 3 3 Figure 2-13: Troll Connection (Proportional Solenoid with Amp Meter) D) Set up the Multimeter to measure (mA.) and connect the black lead to black socket and the red lead to the red socket labeled “TROLL COMMAND” as shown in Figure 2-13:. E) Turn power ‘On’ to the Processor and the Clutch Power Supply and take command at a Remote Station with the Control Head lever in the Neutral/Idle position. F) Depress the Transfer Button again for approximately 2 seconds until the red LED on the Control Head begins blinking at a fast rate (Troll Mode Indication). G) Flip switch away from "Troll Command" to read current through meter. H) Move the Control Head lever to the Ahead detent. The current measurement should be the correct value for minimum clutch pressure (shaft rotations). This value varies depending on the type of Marine Gear. Refer to the Literature provided with the Trolling Valve and the Processor for specifics. I) Slowly advance the Control Head lever while monitoring the current. The current should increase or decrease, depending on the Gear type, in proportion with the Control Head lever movement. Once again, refer to the Literature provided with the Trolling Valve and the Processor for specific values. J) Continue to move the Control Head lever forward until the red LED stops blinking (lit steady). The current should drop to 0 mA. MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 2-10 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT 3 PARTS LIST Table 3-2: Parts List Part Name Service Field Test Unit Technical Manual Multimeter Test Control Head - Dual ZF Mathers Part No. 13927 MM13927 14000 MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 3-1 SERVICE FIELD TEST UNIT MM13927 RvD 10/03 Page 3-2 APPENDIX C Drawing 12284A-1 ClearCommand Diagram (all options) Appendix C-1 Appendix C-2 Drawing 12284A-2 ClearCommand Circuit Board Connections Appendix C-3 Appendix C-4 Drawing 12284A-3 ClearCommand Drawing Notes Page Appendix C-5 Appendix C-6